US20220024937A1 - 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists - Google Patents

3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20220024937A1
US20220024937A1 US17/491,676 US202117491676A US2022024937A1 US 20220024937 A1 US20220024937 A1 US 20220024937A1 US 202117491676 A US202117491676 A US 202117491676A US 2022024937 A1 US2022024937 A1 US 2022024937A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
ocf
alkyl
chemical entity
ring
optionally substituted
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Pending
Application number
US17/491,676
Inventor
Gideon Shapiro
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Rugen Holdings (cayman) Ltd
Original Assignee
Rugen Holdings (cayman) Ltd
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Rugen Holdings (cayman) Ltd filed Critical Rugen Holdings (cayman) Ltd
Priority to US17/491,676 priority Critical patent/US20220024937A1/en
Publication of US20220024937A1 publication Critical patent/US20220024937A1/en
Pending legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D487/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00
    • C07D487/02Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D487/04Ortho-condensed systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/4427Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof containing further heterocyclic ring systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/445Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/445Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine
    • A61K31/4523Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine containing further heterocyclic ring systems
    • A61K31/4545Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine containing further heterocyclic ring systems containing a six-membered ring with nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. pipamperone, anabasine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4965Non-condensed pyrazines
    • A61K31/497Non-condensed pyrazines containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4985Pyrazines or piperazines ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic ring systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/505Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim
    • A61K31/506Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim not condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/505Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim
    • A61K31/519Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/04Centrally acting analgesics, e.g. opioids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/06Antimigraine agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/08Antiepileptics; Anticonvulsants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/14Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abnormal movements, e.g. chorea, dyskinesia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/14Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abnormal movements, e.g. chorea, dyskinesia
    • A61P25/16Anti-Parkinson drugs
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/24Antidepressants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings
    • C07D401/12Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D471/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
    • C07D471/02Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D471/04Ortho-condensed systems

Definitions

  • Non-selective NMDA receptor antagonists originally developed in stroke and head trauma, have more recently shown clinical efficacy in treating depression.
  • the non-selective NMDA receptor antagonist, ketamine has been shown to have rapid onset and efficacy in depression resistant to standard monoamine reuptake inhibitor therapy (Mathews and Zarate, 2013 , J. Clin. Psychiatry 74:516-158).
  • non-selective NMDA receptor antagonists such as ketamine have a range of undesirable pharmacological activities which limit application in humans. In particular dissociative or psychogenic side effects are particularly prominent for non-selective NMDA receptor antagonists.
  • NR2B subtype selective NMDA receptor antagonists have demonstrated potential in a wide range of clinical indications.
  • NR2B antagonists have also demonstrated antidepressant activity in early stage clinical trials (Ibrahim et al., 2012 , J. Clin. Psychopharmacol. 32, 551-557; Preskorn et al., 2008 , J. Clin. Psychopharmacol. 28, 631-637).
  • selective NR2B antagonists have advantages over unselective NMDA receptor antagonists such as ketamine due to greatly diminished dissociative side effects.
  • NR2B antagonists described to date have generally exhibited drawbacks with regard to other drug properties which have limited potential use in human drug therapy.
  • NR2B subtype selective antagonists For broad scope of application and safe human use in a range of clinical indications including depression, improved NR2B subtype selective antagonists are needed.
  • the present invention addresses the need for NR2B receptor antagonists that are improved in one or more aspects exemplified by pharmacokinetic performance, oral activity, cardiovascular safety, and in vitro and in vivo therapeutic safety index measures.
  • the present invention encompasses the insight that chemical entities of Formula (I):
  • R 1 and Z are NR2B subtype selective receptor antagonists.
  • Chemical entities of Formula (I), and pharmaceutically acceptable compositions thereof, are useful for treating a variety of diseases and disorders associated with NR2B receptor antagonism. Such diseases and disorders include those described herein.
  • FIG. 1A shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.1 with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 1B shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.2 with compound E1-8.2 by i.p. administration.
  • FIG. 1C shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.3 with compound E1-21.26 by i.p. administration.
  • FIG. 1D shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.4 with compound E1-1.2 by oral (p.o.) administration.
  • FIG. 1E shows results of the Forced Swim Test in rats as described in Example 2.4.5 with compound E1-1.2 by i.p. administration.
  • FIG. 1F shows results of the Forced Swim Test in rats as described in Example 2.4.6 with compound E1-21.26 by p.o. administration.
  • FIG. 1G shows results of the Forced Swim Test as described in Example 2.4.7 with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 2 shows results of the Electroconvulsive Threshold Test (ECT) as described in Example 2.5.1 with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 3 shows results of the Electroconvulsive Threshold Test (ECT) as described in Example 2.5.2 with compound E1-8.2.
  • FIG. 4 shows results of the Electroconvulsive Threshold Test (ECT) as described in Example 2.5.3 with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 5A shows the number of animals showing clonic convulsions in the Pentylenetetrazole (PTZ) Seizure Test as described in Example 2.6.1 with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 5B shows the number of animals showing tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 5C shows number of dead animals in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 5D shows latency to clonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 5E shows latency to tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 5F shows latency to death in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 6A shows the number of animals showing clonic convulsions in the Pentylenetetrazole (PTZ) Seizure Test as described in Example 2.6.2 with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 6B shows the number of animals showing tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 6C shows number of dead animals in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 6D shows latency to clonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 6E shows latency to tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 6F shows latency to death in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 7A shows the forelimb clonus score in the 6 Hz Seizure Test as described in Example 2.7.1 for compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 7B shows the number of mice with Straub tail in the 6 Hz Seizure Test as described in Example 2.7.1 for compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 8A shows the results of the haloperidol-induced catalepsy model as described in Example 2.8.1 for compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 8B shows the results of the haloperidol-induced catalepsy model for amphetamine.
  • FIG. 8C shows the results of the haloperidol-induced catalepsy model as described in Example 2.8.2 for compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 9A shows the rat formalin model nociceptive behavior in phase I as described in Example 2.9 for compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 9B shows the rat formalin model nociceptive behavior in phase II as described in Example 2.9 for compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 10 shows the number of DC potentials for compound E1-1.2 in the cortical spreading depression (migraine) model as described in Example 2.10.
  • FIG. 11 shows a ball-and-stick diagram of intermediate (R)-XVIa showing the numbering scheme employed in Tables A-D.
  • the present invention provides chemical entities of Formula I:
  • a solid state form is an amorphous (i.e., non-crystalline) form; in some embodiments, a solid state form is a crystalline form. In some embodiments, a crystalline form (e.g., a polymorph, pseudohydrate, or hydrate). Similarly, the term encompasses the compound whether provided in solid form or otherwise. Unless otherwise specified, all statements made herein regarding “compounds” apply to the associated chemical entities, as defined.
  • the word “includes” (or any variation thereon, e.g., “include”, “including”, etc.) is intended to be open-ended.
  • “A includes 1, 2 and 3” means that A includes but is not limited to 1, 2 and 3.
  • a can be a halogen, such as chlorine or bromine means that A can be, but is not limited to, chlorine or bromine.
  • Chemical entities of this invention include those described generally above, and are further illustrated by the classes, subclasses, and species disclosed herein. As used herein, the following definitions shall apply unless otherwise indicated.
  • the chemical elements are identified in accordance with the Periodic Table of the Elements, CAS version, Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, 75 th Ed., inside cover, and specific functional groups are generally defined as described therein.
  • alkyl used alone or as part of a larger moiety, means a substituted or unsubstituted, linear or branched, univalent hydrocarbon chain that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation.
  • alkyl groups contain 1 to 7 carbon atoms (“C 1 -C 7 alkyl”).
  • alkyl groups contain 1 to 6 carbon atoms (“C 1 -C 6 alkyl”).
  • alkyl groups contain 1 to 5 carbon atoms (“C 1 -C 5 alkyl”).
  • alkyl groups contain 1 to 4 carbon atoms (“C 1 -C 4 alkyl”).
  • alkyl groups contain 3 to 7 carbon atoms (“C 3 -C 7 alkyl”).
  • saturated alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, i-butyl, s-butyl, homologs and isomers of, for example, n-pentyl, n-hexyl, n-heptyl, n-octyl, and the like.
  • An unsaturated alkyl group is one having one or more carbon-carbon double bonds or carbon-carbon triple bonds.
  • Examples of unsaturated alkyl groups include allyl, vinyl, 2-propenyl, crotyl, 2-isopentenyl, 2-(butadienyl), 2,4-pentadienyl, 3-(1,4-pentadienyl), ethynyl, 1- and 3-propynyl, 3-butynyl, and the like.
  • the term “lower alkyl” refers to alkyl groups having 1 to 4 (if saturated) or 2 to 4 (if unsaturated) carbon atoms.
  • Exemplary lower alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl, n-butyl, s-butyl, i-butyl, t-butyl and the like.
  • alkenyl refers to alkyl groups having at least two carbon atoms and at least one carbon-carbon double bond.
  • alkynyl refers to alkyl groups having at least two carbon atoms and at least one carbon-carbon triple bond.
  • cycloalkyl used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(cycloalkyl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent monocyclic hydrocarbon that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, but which is not aromatic; or bicyclo[2.2.1]heptanyl (also called norbornyl) or bicyclo[2.2.2]octanyl.
  • cycloalkyl groups contain 3 to 8 ring carbon atoms (“C 3 -C 8 cycloalkyl”).
  • cycloalkyl examples include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-cyclohexenyl, 3-cyclohexenyl, cycloheptyl, and the like, as well as bicyclo[2.2.1]heptanyl and bicyclo[2.2.2]octanyl.
  • alkoxy used alone or as part of a larger moiety, refers to the group —O-alkyl.
  • halogen or “halo”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, refers to fluoro, chloro, bromo or iodo.
  • aryl used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(aryl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent monocyclic or bicyclic carbocyclic aromatic ring system. Unless otherwise specified, aryl groups contain 6 or 10 ring members. Examples of aryl include phenyl, naphthyl, and the like.
  • heteroaryl used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(heteroaryl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent monocyclic or bicyclic group having 5 to 10 ring atoms, preferably 5, 6, 9 or 10 ring atoms, having 6, 10, or 14 T electrons shared in a cyclic array, and having, in addition to ring carbon atoms, from one to four ring heteroatoms.
  • heteroaryl groups include thienyl, furanyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyridazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, indolizinyl, purinyl, naphthyridinyl, pteridinyl, and the like.
  • heterocyclyl used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(heterocyclyl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent stable 5- to 7-membered monocyclic or 7- to 10-membered bicyclic heterocyclic moiety that is either saturated or partially unsaturated, and having, in addition to ring carbon atoms, one to four heteroatoms.
  • heterocycyl groups include tetrahydrofuranyl, pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, and the like.
  • the term “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” refers to those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art. For example, S. M. Berge et al., describe pharmaceutically acceptable salts in detail in J. Pharmaceutical Sciences, 1977, 66:1-19, incorporated herein by reference.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of this invention include those derived from suitable inorganic and organic acids and bases.
  • Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable, nontoxic acid addition salts are salts of an amino group formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid and perchloric acid or with organic acids such as acetic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, succinic acid or malonic acid or by using other methods used in the art such as ion exchange.
  • inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid and perchloric acid
  • organic acids such as acetic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, succinic acid or malonic acid or by using other methods used in the art such as ion exchange.
  • salts include adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate, benzoate, bisulfate, borate, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, formate, fumarate, glucoheptonate, glycerophosphate, gluconate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, lactobionate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, maleate, malonate, methanesulfonate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oleate, oxalate, palmitate, pamoate, pectinate,
  • Salts derived from appropriate bases include alkali metal, alkaline earth metal, ammonium and N + (C 1-4 alkyl) 4 salts.
  • Representative alkali or alkaline earth metal salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and the like.
  • Further pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, when appropriate, nontoxic ammonium, quaternary ammonium, and amine cations formed using counterions such as halide, hydroxide, carboxylate, sulfate, phosphate, nitrate, lower alkyl sulfonate and aryl sulfonate.
  • a subject includes a mammal (e.g., a human, in some embodiments including prenatal human forms).
  • a subject is suffering from a relevant disease, disorder or condition.
  • a subject is susceptible to a disease, disorder, or condition.
  • a subject displays one or more symptoms or characteristics of a disease, disorder or condition.
  • a subject does not display any symptom or characteristic of a disease, disorder, or condition.
  • a subject is someone with one or more features characteristic of susceptibility to or risk of a disease, disorder, or condition.
  • a subject is a patient.
  • a subject is an individual to whom diagnosis and/or therapy is and/or has been administered.
  • a subject is a fetus, an infant, a child, a teenager, an adult, or a senior citizen (i.e., the subject is of advanced age, such as older than 50).
  • a child refers to a human between two and 18 years of age.
  • an adult refers to a human eighteen years of age or older.
  • structures depicted herein are also meant to include all isomeric (e.g., enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational)) forms of the structure; for example, the R and S configurations for each asymmetric center, Z and E double bond isomers, and Z and E conformational isomers. Therefore, single stereochemical isomers as well as enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational) mixtures of the present compounds are within the scope of the invention. Unless otherwise stated, all tautomeric forms of the compounds of the invention are within the scope of the invention.
  • structures depicted herein are also meant to include compounds that differ only in the presence of one or more isotopically enriched atoms.
  • compounds having the present structures including the replacement hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, chlorine or fluorine with 2 H, 3 H, 11 C, 13 C, 14 C, 13 N 15 N, 17 O, 18 O, 36 Cl or 18 F, respectively, are within the scope of this invention.
  • Such compounds are useful, for example, as analytical tools, as probes in biological assays, or as therapeutic agents in accordance with the present invention.
  • incorporation of heavier isotopes such as deuterium ( 2 H) can afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater metabolic stability, for example, increase in vivo half-life, or reduced dosage requirements.
  • the present invention provides chemical entities of Formula (I):
  • R 1 and Z are as described above.
  • R 1 is optionally substituted alkyl.
  • R 1 is optionally substituted cycloalkyl or optionally substituted (cycloalkyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted cycloalkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted cyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is cyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4,4-difluorocyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-methylcyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-ethylcyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-cyclopropylcyclohexyl.
  • R 1 is optionally substituted norbornanyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted (cycloalkyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is bicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-2-ylmethyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted cyclohexylmethyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is cyclohexylmethyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is (4,4-difluorocyclohexyl)methyl.
  • R 1 is optionally substituted heterocyclyl or optionally substituted (heterocyclyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted heterocyclyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted tetrahydropyranyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is tetrahydropyran-4-yl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted (heterocyclyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted tetrahydropyranylmethyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is tetrahydropyran-4-ylmethyl.
  • R 1 is optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted (aryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted (aryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted benzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-methylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-ethylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-isopropylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-(2,2,2-tri-fluoroethyl)benzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-(1,1-difluoroethyl)benzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-t-butylbenzyl.
  • R 1 is 4-chlorobenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-fluorobenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-difluoromethylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-trifluoromethylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-difluoromethoxybenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-trifluoromethoxybenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-methylthiobenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-ethylthiobenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-methylsulfonylbenzyl. In some embodiments R 1 is 4-ethylsulfonylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is 4-trifluoromethyl-sulfonylbenzyl.
  • R 1 is optionally substituted heteroaryl or optionally substituted (heteroaryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted (heteroaryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted (pyridin-2-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally (5-chloro-pyridin-2-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally (5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is optionally substituted (pyridin-3-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R 1 is (5-methyl-pyridin-3-yl)methyl.
  • Z is 5- or 6-membered monocyclic or 9- or 10-membered bicyclic heteroaryl having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-3 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S, which is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 R x groups and optionally substituted with 1 R a group, wherein each R x is attached to a ring carbon atom and R a is attached to a ring nitrogen atom.
  • Z is 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteroaromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-3 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen heteroatom and 1 oxygen ring heteroatom.
  • Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
  • Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 3 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
  • Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 4 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
  • Z is a 5- or 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-2 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • Z is a 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0 or 1 additional ring nitrogen atoms.
  • Z is pyridyl.
  • Z is pyrimidinyl.
  • Z is pyridazinyl.
  • Z is a 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms. In some embodiments, Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is substituted with 1 or 2 R x groups. In certain embodiments, Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is substituted with 1 R x group.
  • Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is monosubstituted with R x .
  • Z is pyridyl monosubstituted with R x .
  • Z is pyrimidinyl monosubstituted with R x .
  • Z is pyridazinyl monosubstituted with R x .
  • Z is a 5-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-2 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • Z is a 5-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0 or 1 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • Z is imidazolyl or thiazolyl.
  • Z is imidazolyl.
  • Z is thiazolyl.
  • Z is a 5-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-2 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • Z is triazolyl, oxadiazolyl or thiadiazolyl.
  • Z is triazolyl.
  • Z is oxadiazolyl.
  • Z is thiadiazolyl.
  • Z is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 R x groups and optionally substituted with 1 R a group, wherein each R x is attached to a ring carbon atom and R a is attached to a ring nitrogen atom.
  • each R x is independently selected from —F, —Cl, —CH 3 , —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H, —CF 3 , —OH, —OCH 3 , —OCF 3 or —CN.
  • R x is —F or —Cl.
  • R x is —F, —Cl or —CN.
  • R x is —CH 3 , —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H or —CF 3 . In some such embodiments, R x is —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H or —CF 3 . In some embodiments, R x is —CH 3 or —CF 3 . In some embodiments, R x is —OH, —OCH 3 or —OCF 3 .
  • each R a is independently selected from C 1-4 alkyl, C 3-4 cycloalkyl or —S(O) 2 —C 1-4 alkyl. In some embodiments, R a is C 1-4 alkyl or C 3-4 cycloalkyl. In some embodiments, R a is C 1-4 alkyl. In some embodiments, R a is —S(O) 2 —C 1-4 alkyl.
  • Z is one of Formulas Z1-Z36, wherein Z is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 R x groups, wherein each R x is attached to a ring carbon atom:
  • Z is Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, Z5, Z6, Z7, Z8, Z9, Z10, Z11, Z12, Z13, Z14, Z15, Z16, Z17, Z18, Z19, Z20, Z21, Z22, Z23, Z24, Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z29, Z30, Z31, Z32, Z33, Z34, Z35 or Z36.
  • Z is Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, Z5, Z6, Z7, Z8, Z9, Z10, Z11, Z12, Z13, Z14, Z15, Z16, Z17, Z18, Z19, or Z20.
  • Z is Z1, Z2, Z5, Z6, Z8, Z17 or Z19. In some embodiments, Z is Z1 or Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z1. In some embodiments, Z is Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z6 or Z8. In some embodiments, Z is Z6. In some embodiments, Z is Z8.
  • Z is Z3, Z4, Z7, Z9, Z10, Z11, Z12, Z13, Z14 or Z18. In some embodiments, Z is Z7 or Z9. In some embodiments, Z is Z7. In some embodiments, Z is Z9.
  • Z is Z15, Z16 or Z20. In some embodiments, Z is Z15 or Z16. In some embodiments, Z is Z15. In some embodiments, Z is Z16. In some embodiments, Z is 20.
  • Z is Z21, Z22, Z23, Z24, Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z29, Z30, Z31, Z32, Z33, Z34, Z35 or Z36. In some embodiments, Z is Z21, Z22, Z23 or Z24. In some embodiments, Z is Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z29, Z30, Z31, Z32, Z33, Z34, Z35 or Z36.
  • Z is Z23.
  • Z is Z21, Z22, Z24, Z29, Z30, Z35 or Z36. In some embodiments, Z is Z21, Z22, Z24, Z35 or Z36. In some embodiments, Z is Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z21. In some embodiments, Z is Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z29 or Z30.
  • Z is Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z31, Z32, Z33 or Z34. In some embodiments, Z is Z25 or Z26. In some embodiments, Z is Z25. In some embodiments, Z is Z26. In some embodiments, Z is Z27, Z31 or Z32. In some embodiments, Z is Z28, Z33 or Z34.
  • Z is Z27, Z29, Z30, Z31 or Z32. In some embodiments, Z is Z29 or Z30. In some embodiments, Z is Z27, Z31 or Z32.
  • Z is Z28, Z33 or Z34. In some embodiments, Z is Z28.
  • each instance of R x independently is —F, —Cl, —CH 3 , —CF 3 or —CN. In some embodiments, each instance of R x independently is —CH 3 or —CF 3 .
  • R a is —CH 3 .
  • a chemical entity of Formula (I) is a chemical entity of Formula (II):
  • R 5 , R 6 and R 7 independently are —H, —F, —Cl, C 1 -C 4 alkyl, cyclopropyl, —C ⁇ CH, —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H, —CF 3 , —CF 2 CH 3 , —CH 2 CF 3 , C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, —OCFH 2 , —OCF 2 H, —OCF 3 , —CN, —N(R 2 )(R 3 ), —NO 2 , C 1 -C 4 alkylthio, C 1 -C 4 alkylsulfonyl or —S(O) 2 CF 3 ;
  • Z is selected from formulas Z1-Z36, wherein: R x and R a are as described in embodiments of formulas Z1-Z36, supra, or described in embodiments herein, both singly and in combination.
  • a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R 5 , R 6 and R 7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH 3 , —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H, —CF 3 , —CH 2 CH 3 , —CF 2 CH 3 , —CH 2 CF 3 , isopropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopropyl, —OCF 3 , —OCF 2 H, —SCH 3 , —SCH 2 CH 3 , —S(O) 2 CH 3 , —S(O) 2 CH 2 CH 3 , —S(O) 2 CF 3 or —C ⁇ CH.
  • a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R 5 , R 6 and R 7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH 3 , —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H, —CF 3 , —CH 2 CH 3 , —CF 2 CH 3 , —CH 2 CF 3 , cyclopropyl, —OCF 3 , —OCF 2 H, —SCH 3 , —S(O) 2 CH 3 or —C ⁇ CH.
  • a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein:
  • a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R 5 , R 6 and R 7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH 3 , —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H, —CF 3 , —CH 2 CH 3 , —CF 2 CH 3 , —CH 2 CF 3 , isopropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopropyl, —OCF 3 , —OCF 2 H, —SCH 3 , —SCH 2 CH 3 , —S(O) 2 CH 3 , —S(O) 2 CH 2 CH 3 , —S(O) 2 CF 3 or —C ⁇ CH; and Z is Z1, Z2, Z6, Z7, Z8, Z9, Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z1, Z2, Z8, Z9, Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z1 or Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z1.
  • a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R 5 , R 6 and R 7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH 3 , —CFH 2 , —CF 2 H, —CF 3 , —CH 2 CH 3 , —CF 2 CH 3 , —CH 2 CF 3 , cyclopropyl, —OCF 3 , —OCF 2 H, —SCH 3 , —S(O) 2 CH 3 or —C ⁇ CH; and Z is Z1, Z2, Z8, Z9, Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z1 or Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z1. In some embodiments, Z is Z2.
  • a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein:
  • Designation of the stereocenter as R indicates that the R isomer is present in greater amount than the corresponding S isomer.
  • the R isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the S isomer.
  • the R isomer can be present in a diastereomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the S isomer.
  • Designation of the stereocenter as S indicates that the S isomer is present in greater amount than the corresponding R isomer.
  • the S isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the R isomer.
  • the S isomer can be present in a diastereomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the R isomer.
  • Designation of the optical rotation of a chemical entity indicates that the indicated enantiomer is present in greater amount than the opposite enantiomer.
  • the ( ⁇ ) isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the (+) isomer.
  • the (+) isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the ( ⁇ ) isomer.
  • Glutamate is a fundamental excitatory neurotransmitter in the mammalian brain and central nervous system (CNS).
  • the effects of this endogenous neurotransmitter are mediated through binding to and activation of GLU to glutamate receptors (GLURs), which are broadly classified into metabotropic G-protein coupled (mGluRs) and ligand gated ion channels or ionotropic GluRs.
  • GLURs glutamate receptors
  • the ionotropic GLURs are pharmacologically classified into three main types based on the actions of selective receptor agonists: NMDA (N-methyl D-aspartate selective), KA (kainic acid selective) and AMPA ( ⁇ -amino-3-hydroxy-5-methyl-4-isoxazolepropionic acid) receptors whose structure and pharmacological function has been recently reviewed in detail (S. F. Traynelis et al. Pharmacology Reviews, 2010, 62, 405-496). Electrophysiology studies have demonstrated NMDARs to be cation ion channels that are subject to voltage-dependent channel block by endogenous Mg 2+ .
  • NMDARs Activation of NMDARs by glutamate in the presence of glycine as a co-agonist results in opening of the receptor ion channel. This in turn allows for the flow of Na + and Ca 2+ into the cell generating excitatory postsynaptic potentials (EPSPs) and Ca 2+ activated second messenger signaling pathways in neurons.
  • EBPs excitatory postsynaptic potentials
  • Ca 2+ activated second messenger signaling pathways in neurons.
  • EBPs excitatory postsynaptic potentials
  • NMDA receptors By virtue of their permeability to Ca 2+ , activation of NMDA receptors regulates long-term changes in neuronal communication such as learning and memory and synaptic plasticity.
  • NMDARs are heterotetramers comprised of two NR1 subunits and two NR2 subunits.
  • NR1 subunits contain the binding site for the glycine co-agonist while NR2 subunits contain the binding site for glutamate.
  • NR2A, NR2B, NR2C and NR2D The existence of multiple splice variants for NR1 and four isoforms of NR2 (NR2A, NR2B, NR2C and NR2D) from different genes results in a diverse molecular array and of NMDARs.
  • the pharmacological and electrophysiological properties of NMDARs vary depending on the particular NR1 isoform and NR2 subtype composition.
  • the NR2 subtype isoforms are differentially expressed across cell types and brain regions.
  • compounds that interact selectivity with NR2 subunits can exert specific pharmacological effects in particular brain regions and have potential to treat CNS diseases with a high degree of specificity and selectivity (e.g. vz side effects).
  • the low expression of the NR2B subtype in the cerebellum relative to other brain structures indicated lower motor side effects for this subtype.
  • NMDA receptor antagonism has been extensively investigated for its potential to treat a variety of CNS diseases including stroke, epilepsy, pain, depression Parkinson's Disease and Alzheimer's disease (Paoletti et al., Nat. Rev. Neurosci 14:383-400; Sancora, 2008 , Nature Rev. Drug Disc., 7, 426-437).
  • the NMDA receptor offers a number of pharmacological entry points for developing receptor inhibitors.
  • Direct blockers of the NMDAR ion channel pore represent one family of antagonist compounds for which efficacy could be demonstrated in diverse in vitro and in vivo CNS disease models including, epilepsy, pain and neurodegeneration/stroke.
  • compounds from this class as exemplified by phencyclidine (PCP), MK-801, and ketamine, are generally categorized as unselective across the diversity of NMDA receptor subtypes.
  • ketamine an intravenous drug originally approved for use in anesthesia (Haas et. al, 1992 , Anesthesia Prog., 39, 61-68) has more recently demonstrated clinical efficacy as an antidepressant therapy (Katalinic et al. 2013 , Aust. N. Z. J. Psychiatry, 47, 710-727).
  • the antidepressant action of acute ketamine therapy has an essentially immediate onset compared to approximately six weeks required for standard serotonin reuptake inhibitor (SSRI) drug therapy.
  • SSRI serotonin reuptake inhibitor
  • ketamine therapy is of limited utility and restricted to acute or intermittent administration. To have broader scope of application and utility as a therapy for depression and other CNS diseases, orally active selective NMDA antagonists with reduced side effects are needed that can be administered chronically.
  • Ifenprodil a vasodilator ⁇ 1 -adrenergic antagonist drug, was determined to have a novel allosteric modulator mechanism of action at the NR2B NMDA receptor subtype (Reynolds et al. 1989 , Mol. Pharmacol., 36, 758-765). This new mechanism held promise for a new class of NMDA antagonist drugs having therapeutic efficacy without the limiting side effects of subtype unselective ion channel blockers. Following this discovery, NR2B selective antagonist analogs of ifenprodil (Borza et al., 2006 , Current Topics in Medicinal Chemistry, 6, 687-695; Layton et al.
  • CP-101,606 has suboptimal pharmacokinetic properties and requires limiting intravenous administration.
  • a slow intravenous infusion protocol was required for optimal results in the aforementioned antidepressant clinical study (Preskorn et al. 2008 , Journal of Clinical Psychopharmacology, 28, 631-637).
  • NR2B antagonists which have been described as reviewed by B. Ruppa et al. (K. B. Ruppa et al., Annual Reports in Medicinal Chemistry 2012, 47:89-103) include MK0657 (J. A. McCauley et al., 3 rd Anglo - Swedish Medicinal Chemistry Symposium , Are, Sweden, Mar. 11-14, 2007; L. Mony et al., British J. of Pharmacology 2009, 157:1301-1317; see also Intl. Appl. Publ. No. WO 2004/108705; U.S. Pat. No. 7,592,360) and compounds of formula LX (Intl. Appl. Publ. No. WO 2006/113471), below, including the specific analog LX-1 depicted below.
  • Compound inhibition of human metabolic cytochrome P-450 enzymes including CYP2D6 represents a risk with regard to human drug safety due to drug-drug interactions ( Drug Metabolism Handbook: Concepts and Applications, ed . Ala F. Nassar copyright 2009 Wiley & Sons, Hoboken, N.J.).
  • Drug Metabolism Handbook Concepts and Applications, ed . Ala F. Nassar copyright 2009 Wiley & Sons, Hoboken, N.J.
  • the clearance of drugs that are substrates of CYP2D6 can be reduced by compounds that inhibit CYP2D6.
  • the result can be toxic or side effect overload due to accumulation of the given CYP2D6 drug substrate.
  • CNS drugs including antidepressant drugs feature prominently among the established CYP2D6 substrates.
  • CYP2D6 inhibition is highly undesirable for an NR2B antagonist drug especially given the common application of comedications or polypharmacy in CNS indications including depression.
  • CY2D6 substrates include antidepressants from the SSRI class such as fluoxetine, paroxetine, and fluvoxamine, duloxetine, an antidepressants from the SSNI class, numerous antipsychotics including haloperidol, risperidone and aripiperazole, numerous beta-blocker antihypertensives including metaprolol, propranolol, timolol and alprenolol and the Alzheimer's disease anticholinesterase inhibitor drug donepezil (Flockhart D A (2007). “Drug Interactions: Cytochrome P450 Drug Interaction Table”, Indiana University School of Medicine, accessed at ⁇ http://medicine.iupui.edu/clinpharm/ddis/>> on May 28, 2014).
  • MK0657 and closely related analogs represent an improved generation of NR2B antagonists with respect to human oral bioavailability.
  • drug-related systolic as well as diastolic blood pressure elevation cardiovascular side effects for MK0657 after oral dosing have been described in a published clinical efficacy trial study in patients with Parkinson's Disease (Addy et al., J. Clin. Pharm. 2009, v49:856-864). Similar blood pressure effects were reported to have also been observed after single doses of MK0657 in safety studies with healthy subjects.
  • Compound LX-1 demonstrates oral bioavailability in animals and lacks a phenolic group which can compromise oral bioavailability in humans.
  • compound LX-1 which has a basic piperidine nitrogen atom, notwithstanding the basicity-attenuating vicinal difluoro moiety beta to this nitrogen exhibits human hERG channel inhibition with an IC 50 ⁇ 10 ⁇ M ( ⁇ 4.5 ⁇ M), and exhibits human CYP2D6 metabolic enzyme inhibition activity (IC 50 ⁇ 1.0 ⁇ M).
  • NR2B selective antagonists are needed, as also noted in K. B. Ruppa et al., Annual Reports in Medicinal Chemistry 2012, 47:89-103.
  • NR2B antagonist compounds which are improved in one or more aspects exemplified by pharmacokinetic, absorption, metabolism, excretion (ADME, e.g., oral activity), improved efficacy, off-target activity, improved therapeutic safety index relative and compatibility with chronic oral therapy.
  • NR2B receptor Provided chemical entities are antagonists of the NR2B receptor and have technical advantages with regard to one or more pharmaceutical drug properties, such as oral bioavailability, pharmacokinetic parameters, ADME properties (e.g., CYP inhibition, metabolite formation), in vivo and/or in vitro pharmacological safety.
  • pharmaceutical drug properties such as oral bioavailability, pharmacokinetic parameters, ADME properties (e.g., CYP inhibition, metabolite formation), in vivo and/or in vitro pharmacological safety.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B functional NMDA receptor selectivity versus NR2A (“NR2B selectivity”, determined as the ratio NR2A IC 50 /NR2B IC 50 , in which the IC 50 values are measured according to the procedure of Example 2.1) ⁇ 400.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ⁇ 300.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ⁇ 200.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ⁇ 100.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ⁇ 50.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ⁇ 20.
  • a provided chemical entity has hERG activity (determined as hERG IC 50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.2) ⁇ 5 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC 50 10 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC 50 ⁇ 15 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC 50 ⁇ 20 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC 50 ⁇ 25 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC 50 ⁇ 30 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC 50 ⁇ 40 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B functional antagonist activity (determined as NR2B IC 50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.1) ⁇ 200 nM and hERG activity (determined as hERG IC 50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.2) ⁇ 5 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 10 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 15 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 20 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 25 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 30 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 40 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 5 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 10 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 5 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and hERG IC 50 ⁇ 10 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B functional antagonist activity (determined as NR2B IC 50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.1) ⁇ 200 nM and CYP2D6 inhibition (measured as CYP2D6 IC 50 determined according to the procedure of Example 2.3) ⁇ 2 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 3 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 4 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 5 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 of about 5-10 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 200 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 10 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 2 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 3 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 4 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 5 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 of about 5-10 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 100 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 10 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 2 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 3 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 4 ⁇ M.
  • a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 5 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 of about 5-10 ⁇ M. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC 50 ⁇ 50 nM and CYP2D6 IC 50 ⁇ 10 ⁇ M.
  • the invention provides a composition comprising a chemical entity of the invention or a pharmaceutically acceptable derivative thereof and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle.
  • the amount of chemical entity in compositions of this invention is such that is effective to measurably inhibit NR2B, in a biological sample or in a patient.
  • the amount of chemical entity in compositions of this invention is such that is effective to measurably inhibit NR2B, in a biological sample or in a patient.
  • a composition of this invention is formulated for administration to a patient in need of such composition.
  • a composition of this invention is formulated for oral administration to a patient.
  • patient means an animal, preferably a mammal, and most preferably a human.
  • compositions of this invention refers to a non-toxic carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle that does not destroy the pharmacological activity of the chemical entity with which it is formulated.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, adjuvants or vehicles that may be used in the compositions of this invention include ion exchangers, alumina, aluminum stearate, lecithin, serum proteins, such as human serum albumin, buffer substances such as phosphates, glycine, sorbic acid, potassium sorbate, partial glyceride mixtures of saturated vegetable fatty acids, water, salts or electrolytes, such as protamine sulfate, disodium hydrogen phosphate, potassium hydrogen phosphate, sodium chloride, zinc salts, colloidal silica, magnesium trisilicate, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, cellulose-based substances, polyethylene glycol, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, polyacrylates, waxes, polyethylene-polyoxypropylene-block polymers, polyethylene glycol, glycine, sorb
  • a “pharmaceutically acceptable derivative” means any non-toxic ester, salt of an ester or other derivative of a chemical entity of this invention (e.g., a prodrug) that, upon administration to a recipient, is capable of providing, either directly or indirectly, a chemical entity of this invention or an inhibitorily active metabolite or residue thereof.
  • the term “inhibitorily active metabolite or residue thereof” means that a metabolite or residue thereof is also an inhibitor of NR2B.
  • compositions of the present invention may be administered orally, parenterally, by inhalation spray, topically, rectally, nasally, buccally, vaginally or via an implanted reservoir.
  • parenteral as used herein includes subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, intra-articular, intra-synovial, intrasternal, intrathecal, intrahepatic, intralesional and intracranial injection or infusion techniques.
  • the compositions are administered orally, intraperitoneally or intravenously.
  • Sterile injectable forms of the compositions of this invention may be aqueous or oleaginous suspension. These suspensions may be formulated according to techniques known in the art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents.
  • the sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution or suspension in a non-toxic parenterally acceptable diluent or solvent, for example as a solution in 1,3-butanediol.
  • a non-toxic parenterally acceptable diluent or solvent for example as a solution in 1,3-butanediol.
  • acceptable vehicles and solvents that may be employed are water, Ringer's solution and isotonic sodium chloride solution.
  • sterile, fixed oils are conventionally employed as a solvent or suspending medium.
  • any bland fixed oil may be employed including synthetic mono- or di-glycerides.
  • Fatty acids such as oleic acid and its glyceride derivatives are useful in the preparation of injectables, as are natural pharmaceutically-acceptable oils, such as olive oil or castor oil, especially in their polyoxyethylated versions.
  • These oil solutions or suspensions may also contain a long-chain alcohol diluent or dispersant, such as carboxymethyl cellulose or similar dispersing agents that are commonly used in the formulation of pharmaceutically acceptable dosage forms including emulsions and suspensions.
  • Other commonly used surfactants such as Tweens, Spans and other emulsifying agents or bioavailability enhancers which are commonly used in the manufacture of pharmaceutically acceptable solid, liquid, or other dosage forms may also be used for the purposes of formulation.
  • compositions of this invention may be orally administered in any orally acceptable dosage form including capsules, tablets, aqueous suspensions or solutions.
  • carriers commonly used include lactose and corn starch.
  • Lubricating agents such as magnesium stearate, are also typically added.
  • useful diluents include lactose and dried cornstarch.
  • aqueous suspensions are required for oral use, the active ingredient is combined with emulsifying and suspending agents. If desired, certain sweetening, flavoring or coloring agents may also be added.
  • compositions of this invention may be administered in the form of suppositories for rectal administration.
  • suppositories for rectal administration.
  • suppositories can be prepared by mixing the agent with a suitable non-irritating excipient that is solid at room temperature but liquid at rectal temperature and therefore will melt in the rectum to release the drug.
  • suitable non-irritating excipient include cocoa butter, beeswax and polyethylene glycols.
  • compositions of this invention may also be administered topically, especially when the target of treatment includes areas or organs readily accessible by topical application, including diseases of the eye, the skin, or the lower intestinal tract. Suitable topical formulations are readily prepared for each of these areas or organs.
  • Topical application for the lower intestinal tract can be effected in a rectal suppository formulation (see above) or in a suitable enema formulation. Topically-transdermal patches may also be used.
  • compositions may be formulated in a suitable ointment containing the active component suspended or dissolved in one or more carriers.
  • Carriers for topical administration of compounds of this invention include mineral oil, liquid petrolatum, white petrolatum, propylene glycol, polyoxyethylene, polyoxypropylene compound, emulsifying wax and water.
  • provided pharmaceutically acceptable compositions can be formulated in a suitable lotion or cream containing the active components suspended or dissolved in one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
  • Suitable carriers include mineral oil, sorbitan monostearate, polysorbate 60, cetyl esters wax, cetearyl alcohol, 2-octyldodecanol, benzyl alcohol and water.
  • compositions may be formulated as micronized suspensions in isotonic, pH adjusted sterile saline, or, preferably, as solutions in isotonic, pH adjusted sterile saline, either with or without a preservative such as benzylalkonium chloride.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable compositions may be formulated in an ointment such as petrolatum.
  • compositions of this invention may also be administered by nasal aerosol or inhalation.
  • Such compositions are prepared according to techniques well-known in the art of pharmaceutical formulation and may be prepared as solutions in saline, employing benzyl alcohol or other suitable preservatives, absorption promoters to enhance bioavailability, fluorocarbons, and/or other conventional solubilizing or dispersing agents.
  • compositions of this invention are formulated for oral administration. Such formulations may be administered with or without food. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention are administered without food. In other embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention are administered with food.
  • compositions should be formulated so that a dosage of between 0.01-100 mg/kg body weight/day of the inhibitor can be administered to a patient receiving these compositions.
  • a specific dosage and treatment regimen for any particular patient will depend upon a variety of factors, including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health, sex, diet, time of administration, rate of excretion, drug combination, and the judgment of the treating physician and the severity of the particular disease being treated.
  • the amount of a compound of the present invention in the composition will also depend upon the particular compound in the composition.
  • Traynelis et al. S. F. Traynelis et al., Pharmacology Reviews, 2010, 62:405-496
  • Beinat et al. C. Beinat et al., Current Medicinal Chemistry, 2010, 17:4166-4190
  • Mony et al. L. Mony et al., British J. of Pharmacology, 2009, 157:1301-1317.
  • Antagonism of NR2B can be useful in the treatment of diseases and disorders including depression, pain, Parkinson's disease, Huntington's disease, Alzheimer's disease, cerebral ischaemia, traumatic brain injury, seizure disorders (e.g., epilepsy) and migraine.
  • diseases and disorders including depression, pain, Parkinson's disease, Huntington's disease, Alzheimer's disease, cerebral ischaemia, traumatic brain injury, seizure disorders (e.g., epilepsy) and migraine.
  • the activity of a chemical entity utilized in this invention as an antagonist of NR2B or a treatment for a disease or disorder of the central nervous system (CNS) may be assayed in vitro or in vivo.
  • An in vivo assessment of the efficacy of the compounds of the invention may be made using an animal model of a disease or disorder of the CNS, e.g., a rodent or primate model.
  • Cell-based assays may be performed using, e.g., a cell line isolated from a tissue that expresses NR2B, or a cell line that recombinantly expresses NR2B.
  • biochemical or mechanism-based assays e.g., measuring cAMP or cGMP levels, Northern blot, RT-PCR, etc.
  • In vitro assays include assays that determine cell morphology, protein expression, and/or the cytotoxicity, enzyme inhibitory activity, and/or the subsequent functional consequences of treatment of cells with chemical entities of the invention.
  • Alternate in vitro assays quantify the ability of the inhibitor to bind to protein or nucleic acid molecules within the cell. Inhibitor binding may be measured by radiolabelling the inhibitor prior to binding, isolating the inhibitor/target molecule complex and determining the amount of radiolabel bound.
  • inhibitor binding may be determined by running a competition experiment where new inhibitors are incubated with purified proteins or nucleic acids bound to known radioligands.
  • Detailed conditions for assaying a compound utilized in this invention as an antagonist of NR2B are set forth in the Examples below.
  • the aforementioned assays are exemplary and not intended to limit the scope of the invention. A person skilled in the art can appreciate that modifications can be made to conventional assays to develop equivalent assays that obtain the same result.
  • animal models do not always accurately recapitulate human experience. (Bezard et al. Neuroscience 211:1, 2012). Among other things, animal models are often developed to mimic one or more symptoms of a particular human condition, but it is not always feasible to ensure that, or possibly even determine whether, symptoms observed in the animal result from or are attributable to the same mechanism as that which causes the symptom(s) in humans.
  • the haloperidol-induced catalepsy (HIC) model has been used to characterize therapeutic agents for treating certain neurological conditions and/or symptoms.
  • the HIC model has been particularly recommended for use in characterizing therapeutic agents for their potential utility in protection against catalepsy associated with PD.
  • the HIC model has been used for characterizing antidepressants, and has been reported to be able to reveal differing activities among antidepressants that may have performed comparably in one or more other assays such as, for example, in forced swim tests. (Khisti et al. Indian J. Exp. Biol. 35:1297, 1997).
  • the 6 Hz seizure test assay described herein uses a current of 44 mA which typically results in most antiepileptic drugs losing their efficacy. Accordingly, the 6 Hz seizure test has been suggested to be a useful model of therapy-resistant limbic seizures. (Barton et al. Epilepsy Res. 47(3):217-27, 2001).
  • the PTZ test is thought to be predictive of anticonvulsant drug activity against nonconvulsive (absence or myoclonic) epileptic seizures.
  • various antiepileptic drugs that protect against nonconvulsive seizures in epilepsy patients failed in the PTZ test. (Löscher W. Seizure 20:359-368, 2011). Therefore, inconclusive or negative data resulting from the PTZ test does not necessarily mean that the tested therapy (e.g., compound) will be ineffective in epilepsy patients. Further, such compounds could be effective in a different animal model of epilepsy.
  • an antiepileptic drug may fail in the 6 Hz seizure test (electrically induced seizures) but prove efficacious in the PTZ test (chemically induced seizures).
  • any effect observed in a specific animal model test can be significant.
  • use of multiple and various animal models of diseases can be beneficial to characterize the efficacy of a particular agent or treatment.
  • treatment refers to reversing, alleviating, delaying the onset of, or inhibiting the progress of a disease or disorder, or one or more symptoms thereof, as described herein.
  • treatment may be administered after one or more symptoms have developed.
  • treatment may be administered in the absence of symptoms.
  • treatment may be administered to a susceptible individual prior to the onset of symptoms (e.g., in light of a history of symptoms and/or in light of genetic or other susceptibility factors). Treatment may also be continued after symptoms have resolved, for example to prevent or delay their recurrence.
  • the chemical entities and compositions, according to the method of the present invention may be administered using any amount and any route of administration effective for treating or lessening the severity of a CNS disease or disorder.
  • the chemical entities and compositions, according to the method of the present invention may be administered using any amount and any route of administration effective for treating or lessening the severity of a disease or disorder associated with NR2B.
  • the chemical entities and compositions, according to the method of the present invention may be administered using any amount and any route of administration effective for treating or lessening the severity of a CNS disease or disorder.
  • the disease or disorder is depression with or without concomitant anxiety disorder, e.g., single episode and recurrent depressive disorder, dysthymic disorder, major depressive disorder, psychotic depression, premenstrual dysphoric disorder, postpartum depression, seasonal affective disorder (SAD), mood disorder, treatment-resistant depression (TRD, i.e., major depressive disorder that has not responded to other drug therapies), depression caused by a chronic medical condition such as cancer or chronic pain, chemotherapy, chronic stress, and post traumatic stress disorders.
  • concomitant anxiety disorder e.g., single episode and recurrent depressive disorder, dysthymic disorder, major depressive disorder, psychotic depression, premenstrual dysphoric disorder, postpartum depression, seasonal affective disorder (SAD), mood disorder, treatment-resistant depression (TRD, i.e., major depressive disorder that has not responded to other drug therapies
  • depression caused by a chronic medical condition such as cancer or chronic pain, chemotherapy, chronic stress, and post traumatic stress disorders.
  • the disease or disorder is an acute affective disorder, e.g., selected from bipolar disorders including bipolar I and bipolar II manic disorders.
  • the present invention provides a method of treating substance abuse disorders, wherein treatment results in decreased tolerance and/or dependence to opioid treatment of pain, and/or by treating withdrawal syndrome of e.g., alcohol, opioids, heroin, and cocaine.
  • substance abuse disorders includes substance dependence or abuse with or without physiological dependence.
  • the substances associated with these disorders include: alcohol, amphetamines (or amphetamine-like substances), caffeine, cannabis, cocaine, hallucinogens, inhalants, marijuana, nicotine, opioids, phencyclidine (or phencyclidine-like compounds), sedative-hypnotics or benzodiazepines, and other (or unknown) substances and combinations of all of the above.
  • a substance abuse disorder includes drug withdrawal disorders such as alcohol withdrawal with or without perceptual disturbances; alcohol withdrawal delirium; amphetamine withdrawal; cocaine withdrawal; nicotine withdrawal; opioid withdrawal; sedative, hypnotic or anxiolytic withdrawal with or without perceptual disturbances; sedative, hypnotic or anxiolytic withdrawal delirium; and withdrawal symptoms due to other substances. It will be appreciated that reference to treatment of nicotine withdrawal includes the treatment of symptoms associated with smoking cessation.
  • Other substance abuse disorders include substance-induced anxiety disorder with onset during withdrawal; substance-induced mood disorder with onset during withdrawal; and substance-induced sleep disorder with onset during withdrawal.
  • the disease or disorder is pain, e.g., selected from pain states arising from a variety of sources including neuropathic pain (such as post herpetic neuralgia, nerve injury/damage, the “dynias”, e.g., vulvodynia, phantom limb pain, root avulsions, painful diabetic neuropathy, compressive mononeuropathy, ischemic neuropathy, painful traumatic mononeuropathy, or painful polyneuropathy), central pain syndromes (potentially caused by virtually any lesion at any level of the nervous system), and postsurgical pain syndromes (e.g., postmastectomy syndrome, postthoracotomy syndrome, stump pain), bone and joint pain (osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis), repetitive motion pain, carpal tunnel syndrome, dental pain, cancer pain, myofascial pain (muscular injury, fibromyalgia), perioperative pain (general surgery, gyn
  • the disease or disorder is associated with intractable pain, such as migraine, fibromyalgia, and trigeminal neuralgia.
  • the disease or disorder is a migraine disorder.
  • Migraine is among the most common neurological disorders with a prevalence of 10-15% worldwide.
  • a third of patients with migraine also suffer from transient focal neurological symptoms, termed aura.
  • Aura typically begins minutes to hours prior to the headache, but may occur during the headache phase or even in the absence of headache.
  • the most interesting aspects of aura are the ‘spreading’ character, suggesting an underlying mechanism that propagates slowly along adjacent brain tissue.
  • SD spreading depression
  • CSD cortical spreading depression
  • SCD cortical spreading depression
  • SD is the electrophysiological substrate of migraine aura and a potential trigger for headache.
  • an aura can occur with little or no headache following it.
  • SD takes place in a number of major neurological disorders besides migraine with aura, for example stroke and brain trauma.
  • SD is capable of activating central and peripheral trigeminovascular nociceptive pathways with a latency matching that occurs between aura and headache in migraineurs.
  • migraine prophylactic drugs have been shown to suppress SD, suggesting that SD is a relevant pharmacological target in migraine. (Shatillo et al. Neuropharm. 2015, 93:164-170).
  • SD is an intense depolarization of neuronal and glial membranes that propagates in brain tissue at a rate of approximately 3 mm/min.
  • the depolarization wave will be recognized by DC (direct current) recording on cortex in anesthetized rats.
  • DC direct current
  • CBF Cerebral blood flow
  • increase on dura can be measured indicating the vasodilatation of dural veins.
  • SD can be evoked pharmacologically by application of glutamate, K + and Na + /K + -pump inhibitors, by electrical stimulation and by tissue injury, such as trauma, hemorrhage or ischemia.
  • tissue injury such as trauma, hemorrhage or ischemia.
  • Direct evidence for the occurrence of SD in human brain in situ has been obtained using subdural electrophysiological recordings and intracortical multiparametric electrodes. (Ayata et al. Ann. Neurol. 2006, 59:652-61).
  • the disease or disorder is a migraine without aura. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a migraine with aura. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a migraine with typical aura. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder includes migraine with brainstem aura, hemiplegic migraine, retinal migraine, and/or chronic migraine.
  • a migraine may be a stress migraine, silent or acephalgic migraine, sinus migraine, ocular migraine, seasonal migraine, cyclic migraine syndrome, gastric stasis migraine, and/or tension migraine.
  • the disease or disorder is a primary headache disorder characterized by recurrent headaches that are moderate to severe. A headache can affect one half of the head and last from one hour to several days. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a tension headache and/or trigeminal autonomic cephalagias.
  • the disease or disorder is cluster headache.
  • Cluster headache is a type of headache that recurs over a period of time. Generally, patients who suffer from cluster headaches experience an episode one to three times per day during a period of time (the cluster period), which may last from two weeks to three months. A cluster headache typically awakens a person from sleep one to two hours after going to bed. Cluster headaches may disappear or go into remission for months or years, only to recur without any warning. In some embodiments, the cluster headache is chronic (e.g., the cluster period is measured by months or years, rather than weeks). In certain embodiments, the cluster headache is episodic.
  • a headache may result in symptoms comprising nausea, vomiting, and sensitivity to light, sound, or smell.
  • a migraine may result in symptoms comprising nausea, vomiting, and sensitivity to light, sound, or smell.
  • complications of migraine include status migrainosus, persistent aura without infarction, migrainosus infarction, and/or migraine aura-triggered seizure.
  • the disease or disorder is selected from sleep disorders and their sequelae including insomnia, narcolepsy and idiopathic hypersomnia.
  • the disease or disorder is selected from CNS disorders characterized by neuronal hyperexcitablity, such as epilepsy, convulsions, seizures, partial seizure disorders, generalized seizure disorders such as absence seizures, atonic, myoclonic, tonic, tonic-clonic or “grand-mal” seizures, status epilepticus, cortical spreading depression, migraine headaches, cerebral palsy, Ohtahara Syndrome, Fragile X Syndrome, pediatric or genetic seizures such as West syndrome, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome and Angleman syndrome, tuberosclerosis, intracranial hypertension, central nervous system edema, neuronal toxicity, such as toxicity induced by alcohol exposure, pathophysiological effects of head trauma, stroke, ischemia, hypoxia and other conditions resulting from or producing ionic imbalances in the central nervous system, or synchronized discharges of neuronal populations.
  • CNS disorders characterized by neuronal hyperexcitablity such as epilepsy, convulsions, seizures, partial seizure disorders, generalized
  • the disease or disorder is characterized by the occurrence of a seizure.
  • Seizures are a result of uncontrolled discharges of electrical activity in the brain.
  • a seizure typically manifests as sudden, involuntary, disruptive, and often destructive sensory, motor, and cognitive phenomena. Seizures are frequently associated with physical harm to the body (e.g., tongue biting, limb breakage, and burns), a complete loss of consciousness, and incontinence.
  • a typical seizure for example, might begin as spontaneous shaking of an arm or leg and progress over seconds or minutes to rhythmic movement of the entire body, loss of consciousness, and voiding of urine or stool. There are both convulsive and non-convulsive seizures.
  • Convulsive seizures can be generalized seizures or partial seizures. There are six main types of generalized seizures: tonic-clonic, tonic, clonic, myoclonic, absence, and atonic seizures.
  • a non-convulsive seizure for example an absence seizure, presents as a decreased level of consciousness and usually lasts about 10 seconds.
  • the disease or disorder is epilepsy.
  • Epilepsy is a disorder of the brain characterized by an enduring predisposition to generate epileptic seizures and by the neurobiologic, cognitive, psychological, and social consequences of this condition. (R. S. Fisher et al., Epilepsia, 2005, 46(4):470-472).
  • Epilepsy can be the occurrence of at least one epileptic seizure.
  • An epileptic seizure is a transient occurrence of signs and/or symptoms due to abnormal excessive or synchronous neuronal activity in the brain.
  • Epilepsy affects people of all ages; however, epilepsy most often occurs in childhood and older adulthood (Institute of Medicine 2012). The exact cause of epilepsy is uncertain.
  • Some known causes of epilepsy include head trauma, stroke, tumors, infection, or abnormalities of the brain.
  • Epilepsy is categorized as idiopathic (genetic cause) or symptomatic (cause unknown), and is further grouped into either generalized, affecting both hemispheres of the brain, or partial epilepsy, which affects one hemisphere of the brain.
  • idiopathic generalized epilepsy include childhood absence epilepsy, juvenile myoclonic epilepsy and epilepsy with grand mal seizures.
  • idiopathic partial epilepsy include benign focal epilepsy of childhood.
  • Symptomatic generalized epilepsy includes West syndrome, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome and others.
  • Symptomatic partial epilepsy includes temporal lobe epilepsy, frontal lobe epilepsy and others.
  • the seizure disorder is a pediatric seizure disorder.
  • the ability to categorize a case of a seizure disorder, e.g. epilepsy, into a specific syndrome occurs more often with children since the onset of seizures is commonly early. Less serious examples are benign rolandic epilepsy, childhood absence epilepsy and juvenile myoclonic epilepsy (A. Neligan et al., Handbook of clinical neurology 2012, 107:113-33). Other examples of pediatric seizures include febrile seizures, infantile spasms and neonatal seizures.
  • the seizure disorder is frontal lobe epilepsy, juvenile myoclonic epilepsy, myoclonic epilepsy, absence epilepsy, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome, Landau-Kleffner syndrome, Dravet syndrome, progressive myoclonus epilepsies, reflex epilepsy, Rasmussen's syndrome, temporal lobe epilepsy, limbic epilepsy, status epilepticus, abdominal epilepsy, massive bilateral myoclonus, catamenial epilepsy, Jacksonian seizure disorder, Lafora disease or photosensitive epilepsy, or a combination of one or more of these.
  • Antiepileptic drugs generally suppress neural activity by a variety of mechanisms, including altering the activity of cell membrane ion channels and the propensity of action potentials or bursts of action potentials to be generated. These desired therapeutic effects are often accompanied by the undesired side effect of sedation.
  • Other medications have significant non-neurological side effects, such as gingival hyperplasia, a cosmetically undesirable overgrowth of the gums, and/or a thickening of the skull, as occurs with phenytoin.
  • the seizure disorder is refractory to treatment.
  • Severe syndromes with diffuse brain dysfunction also referred to as epileptic encephalopathies
  • Epileptic encephalopathies constitute a group of disorders in which the epileptic activity itself is considered to contribute to severe cognitive impairment or decline above and beyond what might be expected from the underlying pathology alone.
  • the refractory seizure disorder is a disorder associated with neuronal migration, such as human microgyria. (S. Bandyopadhyay et al., Epilepsy Research, 2006, 72:127-139). Another important disturbance in a subgroup of patients surgically treated for intractable seizures is focal dysplasia of the cerebral cortex.
  • the seizure disorder involves cortical hyperexcitability in focal cortical dysplasia (malformations).
  • the seizure or epilepsy disorder is caused by a genetic abnormality. Genetics is believed to play an important role in epilepsies by a number of mechanisms. Simple and complex modes of inheritance have been identified for some of them. Recent exome and genome sequencing studies have begun to reveal a number of de novo gene mutations that are responsible for some epileptic encephalopathies, including CHD2 and SYNGAP1 and DMN1, GABBR2, FASN and RYR3. Patients with the epileptic encephalopathie, West syndrome, present distinct clinical electrophysiological features usually manifesting between 3 and 12 months as clusters of infantile spasms (IS) and a characteristic electroencephalogram (EEG) pattern called hypsarrhythmia.
  • IS infantile spasms
  • EEG characteristic electroencephalogram
  • West syndrome has been associated with mutations in ARX, CDKL5, STXBP1, and ST3GAL3 as well as various copy number variations (CNVs).
  • CNVs copy number variations
  • Mutations in GRIN2A and GRIN2B encoding the NR2A and NR2B of the NMDA receptor are associated with several neurodevelopmental disorders. Mutations in GRIN2A have recently been detected in idiopathic focal epilepsy with rolandic spikes and related epileptic encephalopathies, that is, in Landau-Kleffner syndrome, epilepsy with continuous spike-and-waves during slow sleep syndrome, and nonsyndromic epilepsy associated with intellectual disability.
  • GRIN2B has not been described as an epilepsy gene to date but has repeatedly been considered as a putative candidate gene for seizures, and mutations were detected in patients with ID and schizophrenia.
  • the disease or disorder is a movement disorder.
  • Movement disorders include Parkinson's disease, dyskinesias (including the side effects accompanying normal doses of L-Dopa), tardive dyskinesia, drug-induced parkinsonism, postencephalitic parkinsonism, progressive supranuclear palsy, multiple system atrophy, corticobasal degeneration, parkinsonian-ALS dementia complex, basal ganglia calcification, akinesia, akinetic-rigid syndrome, bradykinesia, dystonia, medication-induced parkinsonian, Gilles de la Tourette syndrome, Huntingon's disease, tremor, chorea, myoclonus, tick disorder and dystonia.
  • the movement disorder is one or more of akinesias and akinetic-rigid syndromes, dyskinesias and medication-induced parkinsonism (such as neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism, neuroleptic malignant syndrome, neuroleptic-induced acute dystonia, neuroleptic-induced acute akathisia, neuroleptic-induced tardive dyskinesia and medication-induced postural tremor).
  • akinetic-rigid syndromes include Parkinson's disease, drug-induced parkinsonism, postencephalitic parkinsonism, progressive supranuclear palsy, multiple system atrophy, corticobasal degeneration, parkinsonism-ALS dementia complex and basal ganglia calcification.
  • dyskinesias include tremor (including rest tremor, postural tremor and intention tremor), chorea (such as Sydenham's chorea, Huntington's disease, benign hereditary chorea, neuroacanthocytosis, symptomatic chorea, drug-induced chorea and hemiballism), myoclonus (including generalized myoclonus and focal myoclonus), tics (including simple tics, complex tics and symptomatic tics), and dystonia (including generalised dystonia such as iodiopathic dystonia, drug-induced dystonia, symptomatic dystonia and paroxymal dystonia, and focal dystonia such as blepharospasm, oromandibular dystonia, spasmodic dysphonia, spasmodic torticollis, axial dystonia, dystonic writer's cramp and hemiplegic dystonia).
  • chorea such as Sydenham's chorea, Huntington's disease, benign
  • the disease or disorder is Parkinson's disease.
  • the disease or disorder is Huntington's disease.
  • the disease or disorder is cognitive dysfunction associated with disorders including schizophrenia, Alzheimer's disease, fronto-temporal dementia, Pick's disease, Lewy body disease, and other senile dementias (e.g., vascular dementia).
  • disorders including schizophrenia, Alzheimer's disease, fronto-temporal dementia, Pick's disease, Lewy body disease, and other senile dementias (e.g., vascular dementia).
  • the present invention provides a method of treating a disorder described herein, comprising administering a chemical entity of the invention in conjunction with one or more pharmaceutical agents.
  • Suitable pharmaceutical agents that may be used in combination with the chemical entities of the present invention include selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors (SSRIs), e.g., in the treatment of depression; dopamine replacement therapy regimens and dopamine agonists, e.g., in the treatment of Parkinson's disease; typical antipsychotics; atypical antipsychotics; anticonvulsants; stimulants; Alzheimer's disease therapies; anti-migraine agents; and anxiolytic agents.
  • SSRIs selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors
  • Suitable SSRIs include citalopram, dapoxetine, escitalopram, fluoxetine, fluvoxamine, indalpine, paroxetine, sertraline, vilazodone and zimelidine.
  • Suitable dopamine replacement therapy regimens include replacement of L-DOPA with a DOPA decarboxylase inhibitor such as carbidopa.
  • Suitable dopamine receptor agonists include aplindore, apomorphine, bromocriptine, cabergoline, ciladopa, dihydroergocryptine, lisuride, pardoprunox, pergolide, piribedil, pramipexole, ropinirole and rotigotine.
  • Suitable typical antipsychotics include chlorpromazine, thioridazine, mesoridazine, levomepromazine, loxapine, molindone, perphenazine, thiothixene, trifluoperazine, haloperidol, fluphenazine, droperidol, zuclopenthixol, flupentixol and prochlorperazine.
  • Suitable atypical antipsychotics include amisulpride, aripiprazole, asenapine, blonanserin, clotiapine, clozapine, iloperidone, Ilurasidone, mosapramine, olanzapine, paliperidone, perospirone, quetiapine, remoxipride, risperidone, sertindole, sulpiride, ziprasidone, zotepine, bifeprunox, pimavanserin and vabicaserin.
  • Suitable anticonvulsants include phenytoin, carbamazepine, barbiturates, phenobarbital, phenobarbital, mephobarbital, trimethadione, mephenytoin, paramethadione, phenthenylate, phenacemide, metharbital, benzchlorpropamide, phensuximide, priraidone, methsuximide, ethotoin, aminoglutethinide, diazepam, clonazepam, clorazepate, fosphenytoin, ethosuximide, valproate, felbamate, gabapentin, lamotrigine, topiramate, vigrabatrin, tiagabine, ziamide, clobazam, thiopental, midazolam, propofol, levetiracetam, oxcarbazepine, CCPene, and GYKI 52466.
  • Suitable stimulants include Adderall (amphetamine, dextroamphetamine mixed salts), methylphenidate, dextroamphetamine, dexmethylphenidate and lisdexamfetamine.
  • Suitable Alzheimer's disease therapies include acetylcholinesterase inhibitors such as rivastigmine, donepezil, galanthamine and huperazine; alpha-7 nicotinic agonists such as encenicline; and drugs that reduce AP42 such as BACE inhibitors, gamma secretase modulators and beta amyloid peptide antibodies.
  • acetylcholinesterase inhibitors such as rivastigmine, donepezil, galanthamine and huperazine
  • alpha-7 nicotinic agonists such as encenicline
  • drugs that reduce AP42 such as BACE inhibitors, gamma secretase modulators and beta amyloid peptide antibodies.
  • Suitable anti-migraine drugs include Ergot alkaloids (e.g., ergotamine and dihydroergotamine mesylate).
  • Other suitable anti-migraine drugs include 5-HT1D agonist triptans such as sumitriptan, almotriptan, eletriptan, frovatriptan, naratriptan, rizatriptan, and zolmitriptan.
  • Suitable agents for use in treating or preventing headache(s) or migraine include pain medication (e.g., aspirin, naproxen, ibuprofen, and acetaminophen), medication for nasuea, caffeine, antihistamines, isometheptene mucate, divalproex sodium/sodium valproate, topiramate, metoprolol, propranolol, timolol, lisinopril, candesartan, atenolol, nadolol, diltiazem, nimodipine, verapamil, amitriptyline, nortriptyline, imipramine, doxepin, protriptyline, paroxetine, fluoxetine, sertraline, topiramate, gabapentin, and divalproex sodium.
  • pain medication e.g., aspirin, naproxen, ibuprofen, and acetaminophen
  • one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat a headache. In some embodiments, one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat a migraine. In some embodiments, one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat a migraine with aura.
  • one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat cluster headache.
  • Blood pressure lowering medications have been shown to treat cluster headache.
  • a chemical entity of the invention can be combined with, for example, verapamil, lithium, divalproex sodium, prednisone, ergotamine tartrate, melatonin, a triptan (e.g., sumatriptan), oxygen, intranasal lidocaine, or any other suitable agent to prevent and/or treat cluster headache.
  • Suitable anxiolytic drugs include benzodiazepine receptor modulators such as diazepam, alprazolam, lorazepam and clonazepam.
  • Suitable agents for use in conjunction with a chemical entity of the invention include memantine and modafinil.
  • the exact amount required will vary from subject to subject, depending on the species, age, and general condition of the subject, the severity of the infection, the particular agent, its mode of administration, and the like.
  • the chemical entities of the invention are preferably formulated in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage.
  • dosage unit form refers to a physically discrete unit of agent appropriate for the patient to be treated. It will be understood, however, that the total daily usage of the chemical entities and compositions of the present invention will be decided by the attending physician within the scope of sound medical judgment.
  • the specific effective dose level for any particular patient or organism will depend upon a variety of factors including the disorder being treated and the severity of the disorder; the activity of the specific chemical entity employed; the specific composition employed; the age, body weight, general health, sex and diet of the patient; the time of administration, route of administration, and rate of excretion of the specific chemical entity employed; the duration of the treatment; drugs used in combination or coincidental with the specific chemical entity employed, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
  • patient means an animal, preferably a mammal, and most preferably a human.
  • administration may involve dosing that is intermittent (e.g., a plurality (i.e., at least two) of doses separated in time) and/or periodic (e.g., individual doses separated by a common period of time) dosing.
  • a dosing regimen for a particular active agent may involve intermittent or continuous administration, for example to achieve a particular desired pharmacokinetic profile or other pattern of exposure in one or more tissues or fluids of interest in the subject receiving therapy.
  • intermittent dosing may include dosing that occurs once a day, once every other day, once a week, once every two weeks, or once a month.
  • administration may involve dosing that is titrated over time in order to reach a target dosage.
  • increases in dosing amount and/or schedule can occur at weekly intervals based on the subject's clinical response and tolerability.
  • one or more features of a dosing regimen may be modified over time (e.g., increasing or decreasing amount of active in any individual dose, increasing or decreasing time intervals between doses, etc.), for example in order to optimize a desired therapeutic effect or response.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered once a week. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered once a day. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered twice a day. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered three times a day. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered with or without regard to food.
  • compositions of the present invention can be administered to treat acute conditions.
  • Acute conditions may be sudden in onset. Acute condition symptoms may appear and change or worsen rapidly.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered to treat chronic conditions.
  • Chronic conditions may be long-developing conditions. A chronic condition may develop and worsen over an extended period of time.
  • compositions of the present invention can be administered prior to a seizure. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered after a seizure. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered to a patient at risk of seizure.
  • compositions of this invention can be administered to humans and other animals orally, rectally, parenterally, intracisternally, intravaginally, intraperitoneally, topically (as by powders, ointments, or drops), bucally, as an oral or nasal spray, or the like, depending on the severity of the infection being treated.
  • the chemical entities of the invention may be administered orally or parenterally at dosage levels of about 0.01 mg/kg to about 50 mg/kg and preferably from about 1 mg/kg to about 25 mg/kg, of subject body weight per day, one or more times a day, to obtain the desired therapeutic effect.
  • Liquid dosage forms for oral administration include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs.
  • the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art such as water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, dimethylformamide, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor, and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof.
  • the oral compositions can also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and
  • sterile injectable aqueous or oleaginous suspensions may be formulated according to the known art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents.
  • the sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution, suspension or emulsion in a nontoxic parenterally acceptable diluent or solvent, for example, as a solution in 1,3-butanediol.
  • acceptable vehicles and solvents that may be employed are water, Ringer's solution, U.S.P. and isotonic sodium chloride solution.
  • sterile, fixed oils are conventionally employed as a solvent or suspending medium.
  • any bland fixed oil can be employed including synthetic mono- or diglycerides.
  • fatty acids such as oleic acid are used in the preparation of injectables.
  • the injectable formulations can be sterilized, for example, by filtration through a bacterial-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved or dispersed in sterile water or other sterile injectable medium prior to use.
  • the rate of chemical entity release can be controlled.
  • biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides).
  • Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the chemical entity in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissues.
  • compositions for rectal or vaginal administration are preferably suppositories which can be prepared by mixing the chemical entities of this invention with suitable non-irritating excipients or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax which are solid at ambient temperature but liquid at body temperature and therefore melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active chemical entity.
  • suitable non-irritating excipients or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax which are solid at ambient temperature but liquid at body temperature and therefore melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active chemical entity.
  • Solid dosage forms for oral administration include capsules, tablets, pills, powders, and granules.
  • the active chemical entity is mixed with at least one inert, pharmaceutically acceptable carrier such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate and/or a) fillers or extenders such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and silicic acid, b) binders such as carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinylpyrrolidinone, sucrose, and acacia, c) humectants such as glycerol, d) disintegrating agents such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate, e) solution retarding agents such as paraffin, f) absorption accelerators such as quaternary ammonium compounds, g) wetting agents such as cetyl alcohol and glycerol monostearate, h) absorb
  • Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like.
  • the solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills, and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and can also be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes. Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polethylene glycols and the like.
  • the active chemical entities can also be in micro-encapsulated form with one or more excipients as noted above.
  • the solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills, and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings, release controlling coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical formulating art.
  • the active chemical entity may be admixed with at least one inert diluent such as sucrose, lactose or starch.
  • Such dosage forms may also comprise, as is normal practice, additional substances other than inert diluents, e.g., tableting lubricants and other tableting aids such a magnesium stearate and microcrystalline cellulose.
  • the dosage forms may also comprise buffering agents. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and can also be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner.
  • buffering agents include polymeric substances and waxes.
  • Dosage forms for topical or transdermal administration of a chemical entity of the invention include ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, powders, solutions, sprays, inhalants or patches.
  • the active chemical entity is admixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and any needed preservatives or buffers as may be required.
  • Ophthalmic formulation, ear drops, and eye drops are also contemplated as being within the scope of the invention.
  • the present invention contemplates the use of transdermal patches, which have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of a chemical entity to the body.
  • Such dosage forms can be made by dissolving or dispensing the chemical entity in the proper medium.
  • Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the chemical entity across the skin. The rate can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or by dispersing the chemical entity in a polymer matrix or gel.
  • the term “combination,” “combined,” and related terms refers to the simultaneous or sequential administration of therapeutic agents in accordance with this invention.
  • a chemical entity of the present invention may be administered with another therapeutic agent simultaneously or sequentially in separate unit dosage forms or together in a single unit dosage form.
  • the present invention provides a single unit dosage form comprising a chemical entity of Formula (I), an additional therapeutic agent, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle.
  • different agents administered in combination may be administered via different routes of delivery and/or according to different schedules.
  • one or more doses of a first active agent is administered substantially simultaneously with, and in some embodiments via a common route and/or as part of a single composition with, one or more other active agents.
  • compositions of this invention should be formulated so that a dosage of between 0.01-100 mg/kg body weight/day of a provided chemical entity can be administered.
  • compositions which comprise an additional therapeutic agent that additional therapeutic agent and the chemical entity of this invention may act synergistically. Therefore, the amount of additional therapeutic agent in such compositions will be less than that required in a monotherapy utilizing only that therapeutic agent. In such compositions a dosage of between 0.01-100 ⁇ g/kg body weight/day of the additional therapeutic agent can be administered.
  • the amount of additional therapeutic agent present in the compositions of this invention will be no more than the amount that would normally be administered in a composition comprising that therapeutic agent as the only active agent.
  • the amount of additional therapeutic agent in the presently disclosed compositions will range from about 50% to 100% of the amount normally present in a composition comprising that agent as the only therapeutically active agent.
  • the present invention provides a medicament comprising at least one chemical entity of Formula (I) and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant or vehicle.
  • the present invention provides the use of a chemical entity of Formula (I) in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a CNS disease or disorder.
  • the Z is a heterocyclic group as defined above and LG is a suitable group for the coupling reaction such as chlorine or bromine.
  • the coupling reaction can be conducted as a base mediated nucleophilic aromatic substitution reaction.
  • the coupling reaction can be conducted as a Buchwald reaction mediated by palladium catalysis.
  • Aromatic substitution coupling reactions can be conducted in suitable protic (e.g., isopropanol, n-butanol) or aprotic (e.g., CH 2 Cl 2 , DMF, DMSO, CH 3 CN) solvents at temperatures from ambient to 160° C., for example, between 50° C. and 120° C. with intermediates of formula Z—Cl in the presence of a suitable base (e.g., triethylamine, diisopropylethylamine). Buchwald coupling reactions (Buchwald, S.; Muci, A. Top. Curr. Chem.
  • Suitable organic solvents e.g., t-butanol, toluene, DMF, DMSO, CH 3 CN
  • suitable palladium catalyst and phosphine ligand system e.g., Brettphos/Brettphos precatalyst, BINAP/Pd 2 (dba) 3
  • a suitable palladium catalyst and phosphine ligand system e.g., Brettphos/Brettphos precatalyst, BINAP/Pd 2 (dba) 3
  • a suitable base e.g., Cs 2 CO 3
  • inert e.g., nitrogen
  • R 1′ R 1
  • compounds of formula XII are equivalent to compounds of formula I.
  • R 1′ is a protecting group
  • intermediate compounds of formula XII can be converted to intermediate compounds of formula XIII using deprotection conditions known in the art.
  • R 1′ is a t-butyl group (i.e., where the R 1′ —OC(O)— moiety is a Boc group)
  • intermediate compounds of formula XII can be converted to intermediate compounds of formula XIII using a number of known methods.
  • Boc deprotection is conducted under acidic conditions using either HCl (e.g., 1-4N HCl in ether or dioxane in a suitable organic solvent, e.g., dichloromethane, methanol or THF) at temperatures between 0° C. and 50° C., or using trifluoroacetic acid in an aprotic solvent (e.g., dichloromethane) at temperatures between 0° C. and room temperature.
  • HCl e.g., 1-4N HCl in ether or dioxane in a suitable organic solvent, e.g., dichloromethane, methanol or THF
  • aprotic solvent e.g., dichloromethane
  • Intermediate compounds of formula XIII can be can be converted to compounds of formula I by carbamoylation reaction with a carbamoylating reagent of formula R 1 OC(O)X wherein X is a suitable leaving group (e.g., Cl, imidazolyl, hydroxysuccinyl).
  • Reagents of formula R 1 OC(O)X may be implemented in isolated form or generated in situ.
  • an alcohol of formula R 1 OH can be treated with carbonyldiimidazole in an aprotic organic solvent at between 0° C. and room temperature to first form the R 1 OC(O)imidazolyl carbamoylating reagent.
  • heteroaryl chloride or bromide coupling reagents Z-LG are either commercially available, can be prepared according to known literature procedures for the exact compound or can be prepared using methods known in the art for synthesizing heteroaryl chlorides and bromides.
  • the heteroaryl compound Z—H can be brominated or chlorinated using methods known in the art (e.g. by treatment with bromine or N-bromosuccinimide or another brominating reagent or treatment with a chlorinating reagent such as sulfurylchloride) the desired Z—Br or Z—Cl heteroaryl coupling reagent can then be isolated by the appropriate procedure (e.g. by chromatography as needed to separate regioisomers).
  • Heteroaryl coupling reagents Z—Cl wherein the chloro group is part of an iminochloride substructure can be prepared under standard conditions (e.g., using phosphorus oxychloride at elevated temperature as solvent itself or in a suitable aprotic organic solvent) from the corresponding Z—OH starting material which has the corresponding amido tautomeric substructure.
  • Other heteroaryl coupling reagents can be prepared from the corresponding Z—NH 2 starting material under Sandmeyer reaction-type conditions which are well established in the art (i.e., diazotization reaction followed by chlorination or bromination with CuCl or CuBr).
  • the required Z—H, Z—OH or Z—NH 2 starting materials can be prepared using methods known in the art for synthesizing heteroaryl compounds.
  • Chemical entities of Formula (I) can be obtained as individual enantiomers from racemic mixtures using methods known in the art such as chiral chromatography or recrystallization of diastereomeric acid addition salts.
  • chemical entities of Formula (I) can be obtained as individual enantiomers by asymmetric synthesis or from the corresponding individual enantiomer intermediates.
  • the individual enantiomers of chemical entities of Formula (I) can be prepared from enantiomers of the intermediates of formula X having the corresponding absolute stereochemical configuration at C-4 of the piperidine ring system.
  • Intermediates of formula X can in turn be prepared by an asymmetric synthesis process as depicted in Scheme 2.
  • Pure enantiomers of formula X may also be prepared from enantiomerically enriched or racemic mixtures by chiral acid addition salt formation and recrystallization (e.g., using a chirally pure tartaric acid) methods standard in the art.
  • chiral catalysts comprising a chiral phosphine ligand (e.g., Waldphos ligands) and a transition metal (e.g., Ir, Rh or Ru) can be employed in asymmetric catalytic hydrogenation conditions at elevated temperature and pressure to give simple ester intermediates XVI of high enantiomeric purity.
  • the latter can be converted to pure enantiomers of X using standard methods in the art such as those described above.
  • Pure enantiomer intermediates for synthesizing enantiomers of compounds of Formula I may also be prepared by variants of the above methods using intermediates with alternative protecting groups or double bond isomers as exemplified in Scheme 3.
  • the benzyl group can be removed and exchanged for another protecting group (e.g., Boc) or the CO 2 R 1 group present in the compound of Formula I.
  • the same reaction scheme can be implemented via asymmetric hydrogenation of the double bond isomer starting material XXX.
  • chemical entities are prepared according to the following procedures. It will be appreciated that, although the general methods depict the synthesis of certain chemical entities of the present invention, the following methods, and other methods known to persons skilled in the art, can be applied to all chemical entities and subclasses and species of each of these chemical entities, as described herein.
  • Step 1 tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4,4-dihydroxypiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-(2-methoxy-2-oxoethylidene)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 4 tert-butyl (R)-4-(2-(4-benzyl-2-oxooxazolidin-3-yl)-2-oxoethylidene)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 5 R-tert-butyl 4-(2-((R)-4-benzyl-2-oxooxazolidin-3-yl)-2-oxoethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 6 R-2-(1-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)acetic acid
  • the reaction mixture was treated with 1M Na 2 SO 3 solution (40 mL) and then extracted with ethyl acetate (2 ⁇ 100 mL) to remove the chiral auxiliary.
  • the combined ethyl acetate phases were dried over Na 2 SO 4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was recrystallized from ethyl acetate/hexane (5 mL/50 mL) to afford the title compound as a white powder (3.70 g, 79%).
  • Step 7 R-tert-butyl 4-((benzyloxycarbonylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 8 ( ⁇ )-R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • the title compound can be prepared in an analogous manner to ( ⁇ )-R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate as described in Example 1.A., but using (S)-4-benzyl-3-lithio-2-oxazolidinone (prepared from (S)-4-benzyl-2-oxazolidinone and n-BuLi) in place of the corresponding reagent having the (R) configuration.
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine trifluoroacetate
  • (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)-methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (1.8 g, 4.32 mmol) in 30 mL DCM/MeOH (1/1) was added methanesulfonic acid (420 mg, 4.32 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. The solvent was evaporated, and the solid thus obtained was triturated with ether (25 mL) to give the title compound as a white solid (1.90 g, 86%).
  • Step 3 4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-(2-methoxy-2-oxoethyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 4 2-(3,3-difluoro-1-((4-methylbenzyloxy)carbonyl)piperidin-4-yl)acetic acid
  • Step 5 4-methylbenzyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 6 ( ⁇ )-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-amine trifluoroacetate
  • Step 3 R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyridin-2-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-amine hydrochloride
  • N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine trifluoroacetate salt (280 mg, 0.73 mmol) in MeCN (2 mL) and TEA (0.3 mL, 2.2 mmol) were added and the resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hour at room temperature. The mixture was then diluted with ethyl acetate (5 mL) and the organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous Na 2 SO 4 and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • Triethylamine (1.0 mL, 7.1 mmol) was then added followed by R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine TFA salt (780 mg, 2.14 mmol) in acetonitrile (3 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hr at room temperature and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate and the organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na 2 SO 4 , and concentrated in vacuo.
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrimidin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl) piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)-piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)-methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-amine trifluoroacetate
  • Step 2 R-4-fluorobenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-amine dihydrochloride salt
  • Step 3 R-4-methylbenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 1 R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Step 2 R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-amine trifluoroacetate
  • Step 3 R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • the asymmetric unit contains a single fully ordered molecule of (R)-XVIa.
  • Anisotropic atomic displacement ellipsoids for the non-hydrogen atoms are shown at the 50% probability level. Hydrogen atoms are displayed with an arbitrarily small radius ( FIG. 11 ).
  • the Flack parameter ⁇ 0.04(6) (Parsons and Flack, Acta Cryst. 2004, A60, s61).
  • the Flack parameter 1.04(6). Determination of the absolute structure using Bayesian statistics on Bijvoet differences (Hooft et al., J. Appl.
  • HEK293 cell lines stably expressing cloned human NR1/NR2B and NR1/NR2A, respectively, were established according to standard previously described methods (Hansen et al., Comb. Chem High Throughput Screen. 11:304, 2008).
  • Activation of the NR2A or NR2B subtype of NMDA receptor with glutamate as an agonist and glycine co-agonist on these cells results in calcium influx, which can be monitored with fluorescent indicator Fluo-4.
  • a cell based assay has been implemented to evaluate the effect of a compound on NR2A and NR2B receptors by measuring the fluorescent changes (Hansen et al., Comb. Chem High Throughput Screen. 11:304, 2008).
  • HEK293 cells stably expressing NR2A or NR2B receptors were cultured at 37° C. in a humidified CO 2 incubator in DMEM supplemented with 10% fetal bovine serum (FBS) (Hyclone), 10 ⁇ M MK801 (Sigma-Aldrich) and 50 ⁇ M AP-5 (Tocris).
  • FBS fetal bovine serum
  • MK801 10 ⁇ M MK801
  • Tocris 50 ⁇ M AP-5
  • the cells were seeded onto poly-D-lysine-coated 96-well black plates with clear bottom (Corning) at a density of ⁇ 50,000 cells/well. After overnight culture, the growth medium was removed from the wells and the cells were incubated at 37° C.
  • Amplitude Max Amplitude/(1+(IC 50 /[antagonist]) n ).
  • This example describes NMDA receptor binding assays using two different radioligands, [ 3 H] MK-801 and [ 3 H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine (see below).
  • An established binding assay using the non-selective NMDA receptor ligand [ 3 H] MK-801 serves as a measure of total NMDA receptor binding activity across all NMD receptor subtypes in native rat brain receptors.
  • the binding assay method using the NR2B selective receptor ligand [ 3 H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine was adapted from a previously described cellular human NR2B cloned receptor assay (Kiss et al., Neurochemistry International.
  • This assay serves as a selective measure of NR2B receptor binding activity in native rat brain receptors. Briefly, the brains of Male Wistar rats were homogenized (Polytron) before centrifugation at 40,000 ⁇ g for 15 minutes at 4° C. After 2 washes, the final pellet was homogenized and stored at ⁇ 80° C. The protein concentration was determined by Bradford assay.
  • MK-801 was used at one concentration, 2 nM, with 400 ⁇ g of membrane proteins.
  • Non-specific binding (NS) was assessed in presence of excess (10 ⁇ M) unlabelled MK-801. A single binding site was observed with a K 1 value of 5.75 nM.
  • [ 3 H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine was used at 2 different concentrations, 0.5 and 30 nM, with 30 ⁇ g of membrane proteins.
  • Non-specific binding (NS) was assessed in presence of excess (10 ⁇ M) (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine.
  • a high affinity site was identified, for which a K i value of 0.18 nM was determined for (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine.
  • [ 3 H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine as the NR2B receptor radioligand (Kiss et al., Neurochemistry International.
  • Test compounds were solubilized at 10 mM in DMSO. Then the dilutions were performed with a constant solvent concentration (1% DMSO) in the assay.
  • Compound E1-1.2 exhibited only a partial effect (40%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E2-1.2 exhibited only a partial effect (36%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E1-1.3 exhibited only a partial effect (41%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E1-1.4 exhibited only a partial effect (32%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E1-1.5 exhibited only a partial effect (48%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E1-8.2 exhibited only a partial effect (33%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E1-9.2 exhibited only a partial effect (34%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E1-21.2 exhibited only a partial effect (49%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • Compound E1-21.26 exhibited only a partial effect (41%) on [ 3 H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype.
  • the assay was performed on hERG channel stably expressed in HEK293 cells.
  • the cells were cultured at 37° C. in a humidified CO 2 incubator in the growth medium consisting of DMEM, 10% fetal bovine serum and antibiotics. Prior to the assay, the cells were seeded onto a 12 mm PDL-coated glass coverslip and cultured in a 35 mm Petri dish.
  • the cover slip was transferred into the chamber of OctaFlow perfusion system (ALA Instrument) and under a constant flow of extracellular solution (140 mM NaCl, 4 mM KCl, 1 mM MgCl 2 , 2 mM CaCl 2 , 10 mM HEPES, 10 mM D-glucose, pH 7.35, osmolarity 290).
  • CYP isoforms and their corresponding probe substrates are as follows: CYP1A2 (phenacetin, 30 ⁇ M), CYP2C9 (tolutamide, 100 ⁇ M), CYP2C19 (S-mephenytoin, 40 ⁇ M), CYP2D6 (dextromethorphan, 5 ⁇ M) and CYP3A4 (midazolam, 1 ⁇ M). All probe substrates were used at concentrations near or below their K ms .
  • a reaction mixture of test compound at 10 ⁇ M or in serial dilution, CYP probe substrate described above and 0.2 mg/mL pooled HLM in phosphate buffer, pH 7.4 in a final volume of 200 ⁇ L was pre-incubated at 37° C. for 10 minutes in triplicate.
  • the reaction was initiated by addition of NADPH at final concentration of 1 mM.
  • the reaction was terminated after 10 minutes (CYP1A2, CYP2D6 and CYP3A4) or 30 minutes (CYP2C9 and CYP2C19) by addition of 100 ⁇ L ice-cold acetonitrile with internal standard (IS).
  • the samples were then centrifuged at 13,000 rpm and the supernatants were injected to LC-MS/MS (Agilent Technologies) to quantify the concentration of the specific metabolites of the probe substrates formed by individual CYP450 isoforms.
  • the inhibition ratio is calculated as:
  • M t and M 0 represent the concentrations of the specific probe substrate metabolite, which was formed by individual CYP450 isoform, at the beginning and end of the reaction in the presence of test compound; while M water represents the concentration of the specific metabolite at the end of the reaction in the absence of test compound.
  • Test compound concentration-dependent response data experiments performed in triplicate. Mean CYP2D6 IC 50 values were derived from non-linear, least-squares fitting of dose-dependent response data to a standard logistic equation (Prism, GraphPad Software, Inc) to generate the CYP2D6 IC 50 results shown in Table 2.3
  • the forced swim test also known at the behavioural despair test was used to evaluate antidepressant activity (Porsolt et al., 1977 Arch. Int. Pharmacodyn. 229: 327-336, Porsolt et al., 1977 , Eur. J. Pharmacol. 47:379-391).
  • Drugs with antidepressant activity, such as imipramine reduce the amount of time spent in the immobile state.
  • the amount of immobility time during a test conducted after drug administration represents a useful indicator of antidepressant activity (Lucki et al 2001 Psychopharmacology 155:315-322; Porsolt et al., 1977 , Nature 266:730-732).
  • Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base).
  • Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • mice were evaluated in a single swimming test session of 6 minutes. Mice were placed in a transparent plastic cylinder 24 cm high with a diameter of 13 cm containing 10 cm of water with ambient temperature control generally from 22 ⁇ 2° C. Mice were placed in the water for 6 minutes and the duration of immobility during the last 4 minutes was measured.
  • Rats Male Wistar rats weighing 197-251 g were used for the rat test. Rats were evaluated according to a two-session procedure with a swimming session of 15 minutes on the first day of the experiment (Session 1) followed 24 hours later by a 5-minute swimming test (Session 2). Rats were individually forced to swim inside 40 cm ⁇ 18 cm vertical transparent plexiglass cylinders containing 15 cm of water maintained at 25° C. (Session 1). After 15 min in the water, the rats were removed and allowed to dry for 15 min in a heated enclosure (32° C.) before being returned to their cages. Rats were placed in the water 24 h later for 5 minutes (Session 2) and the duration of immobility was measured.
  • test compounds were administered in one or more doses by either oral gavage (p.o.) or by intraperitoneal injection (i.p.) dosing routes after dissolving in 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle.
  • Test compound doses ranged from 1 to 30 milligrams per kilogram (expressed in the accompanying Figures either as mpk or mg/kg).
  • Imipramine control compound was dissolved in physiological saline solution. Imipramine was dosed as indicated in the particular Examples.
  • Test compound dose solutions and vehicle control solutions were administered 20 minutes before placing the animals in the water cylinder for both oral and intraperitoneal experiments.
  • Imipramine was dosed as indicated in the particular Examples below.
  • mice Male mice (strain NLMN) weighing 25-35 g were used for testing. All animals were housed in a temperature (22-24° C.) and humidity (50-60%) controlled environment with free access to food and water on a 12-hour light-dark cycle. Test compounds were dissolved in 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water to generate the appropriate dosing solution. Drugs were administered by intraperitoneal injection at a dose volume of 10 mL/kg. Testing was initiated 20-60 minutes after dosing. Testing for antidepressant activity was conducted as described by Darci et al. (Darci et al., 2004, Eur. J. Pharmacol. 499:135-146).
  • mice were placed in a white plastic cylinder 20 cm high with a diameter of 21 cm containing 10 cm of water at 25 ⁇ 2° C. The mice were videotaped for 6 minutes, and the last 4 minutes of video were analyzed by a blinded observer off-line. The observer judged the animal to be immobile when it ceased all activity (struggling, swimming, jumping etc.) and floated passively atop the water. The amount of time each animal spent in the immobile state was recorded and used for statistical analysis of compound effect. Group differences were evaluated by student's t-test or one-way ANOVA followed by post-hoc Dunnett's test.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1B . Bars represent the mean ⁇ SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p ⁇ 0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).
  • the positive control compound imipramine (32 mpk i.p.) administered once 30 min before the test, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1C . Bars represent the mean ⁇ SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p ⁇ 0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).
  • the positive control compound imipramine (32 mpk i.p.) administered once 30 min before the test, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1D . Bars represent the mean ⁇ SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p ⁇ 0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).
  • the positive control compound imipramine (64 mpk p.o.) administered once 60 min before the test, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1E . Bars represent the mean ⁇ SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p ⁇ 0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).).
  • the positive control compound imipramine (32 mpk i.p.) administered 3 times: at 24 h, 4 h and 30 min before the test (Session 2), showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1F . Bars represent the mean ⁇ SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p ⁇ 0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).
  • the positive control compound imipramine (64 mpk p.o.) administered 3 times: at 24 h, 4 h and 60 min before the test (Session 2), showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • the compound was evaluated at 2 doses (3 and 10 mg/kg), administered either acutely p.o. 20 minutes before the test on Day 7 or daily during 7 days with the last administration 20 minutes before the test on Day 7, and compared with a vehicle control group. Vehicle was administered daily when a drug was not due. Imipramine (128 mg/kg p.o.), administered once 60 minutes before the test on Day 7, was used as reference substance.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1G . Bars represent the mean ⁇ SEM immobility time for each dose group (**/***: different from vehicle group, p ⁇ 0.01/p ⁇ 0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).
  • the positive control compound imipramine (128 mpk p.o.) administered once 60 minutes before the test on Day 7, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • the Electroconvulsive Threshold Test which detects proconvulsant or anticonvulsant activity, was generally conducted as described by Swinyard et al., ( J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 106, 319-330, 1952).
  • Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base).
  • Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • Rats were administered ECS (rectangular current: 0.6 ms pulse width, 1.5 s duration, 200 Hz) via earclip electrodes connected to a constant current shock generator (Ugo Basile: type 7801). Test compounds were administered by oral gavage (p.o.) 1 hour before the test at a dose volume of 5 m L/kg.
  • ECS ECS Treatment groups of 20 rats were exposed to ECS as follows: The first animal was exposed to 30 mA of ECS. If this animal did not convulse (tonic convulsions) within 5 seconds maximum, animal n° 2 is exposed to 35 mA, etc. . . . (increases of 5 mA) until the first tonic convulsion was observed. Once the first tonic convulsion was observed, the intensity of ECS was decreased by 2 mA for the next animal and then decreased or increased by 2 mA from animal to animal depending on whether the previous animal convulsed or not. If the first animal did convulse (tonic convulsions) within 5 seconds, animal n° 2 is exposed to 25 mA, etc. . . .
  • test substance was evaluated at 4 doses, typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle, and administered p.o. 60 minutes before ECS, and compared with a vehicle control group.
  • Diazepam (16 mg/kg p.o.), administered under the same experimental conditions, was used as reference substance.
  • the experiment included 6 groups. Data with the test substance was analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using one-way ANOVA followed by Dunnett's t tests.
  • Example 2.5.1 the anticonvulsant positive control compound diazepam (16 mpk p.o.) showed the expected anticonvulsant activity.
  • Example 2.5.2 only the anticonvulsant positive control was included in the study.
  • Compound E1-1.2 showed robust anticonvulsant activity at doses tested, 3, 10 and 30 mpk.
  • Compound E1-8.2 showed modest proconvulsant activity after administration of 0.5 and 2 mpk, and anticonvulsant activity at 10 and 20 mpk doses.
  • Compound E1-21.26 showed anticonvulsant activity at 3 and 10 mpk doses.
  • the method which detects proconvulsant or anticonvulsant activity related to a GABAergic mechanism, follows that described by Krall (Epilepsia, 19, 409-428, 1978). Rats, placed in individual macrolon cages (25 ⁇ 19 ⁇ 13 cm), were injected with pentylenetetrazole (PTZ) (100 mg/kg s.c.). The occurrence and latency of clonic and tonic convulsions and death were noted over a 30 minute period. 15 rats were studied per group. The test was performed blind.
  • PTZ pentylenetetrazole
  • Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base).
  • Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • FIG. 5A , FIG. 5B , FIG. 5C , FIG. 5D , FIG. 5E , and FIG. 5F The results are shown in FIG. 5A , FIG. 5B , FIG. 5C , FIG. 5D , FIG. 5E , and FIG. 5F .
  • Compound E1-1.2 at a 10 mg/kg p.o. dose decreased the number of rats showing tonic convulsions ( ⁇ 82%, p ⁇ 0.01) and the number of deaths ( ⁇ 91%, p ⁇ 0.001) as compared with vehicle controls.
  • Compound E1-1.2 also increased the latencies to induce clonic and tonic convulsions and the latency to death (+72%, p ⁇ 0.05; +39%, p ⁇ 0.01 and +35%, p ⁇ 0.001, respectively).
  • FIG. 6A , FIG. 6B , FIG. 6C , FIG. 6D , FIG. 6E , and FIG. 6F The results are shown in FIG. 6A , FIG. 6B , FIG. 6C , FIG. 6D , FIG. 6E , and FIG. 6F .
  • Compound E1-21.26 at a 10 mg/kg p.o. dose decreased the number of rats showing tonic convulsions ( ⁇ 82%, p ⁇ 0.01) and the number of deaths ( ⁇ 82%, p ⁇ 0.01) as compared with vehicle controls.
  • Compound E1-21.26 also increased the latencies to induce clonic and tonic convulsions and the latency to death (+45%, p ⁇ 0.05; +40%, p ⁇ 0.01 and +31%, p ⁇ 0.01, respectively). These results confirm the anticonvulsant activity for compound E1-21.26 at 10 mg/kg p.o. in the Pentylenetetrazole Seizure Test in the rat.
  • mice were administered a rectangular current (44 mA, rectangular pulse: 0.2 ms pulse width, 3 s duration, 6 Hz) via corneal electrodes connected to a constant current shock generator (Ugo Basile: type 7801).
  • the results for the number of seizures as reflected by forelimb clonus were recorded during the first minute following current administration. Forelimb clonus was scored as absent (0), mild (1) and strong (2). 15 mice were studied per group.
  • Test compound vs vehicle The test was performed partially blind (test substance vs vehicle). Test substances were administered typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle p.o. 30 minutes before the test and compared with a vehicle control group. Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base). Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • Diazepam administered 60 minutes before the test, was used as a positive control reference substance.
  • Quantitative data (scores) with the test substance was analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using Kruskall-Wallis test followed by Mann-Whitney U tests.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 7A . Bars represent the mean ⁇ SEM forelimb clonus score (arbitrary units) for each dose group (*/**/***: different from vehicle group, p ⁇ 0.05/0.01/0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). Doses are given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of diazepam was 8 mpk (p.o.). Compound E1-1.2 showed a dose-response reduction in forelimb clonus. (10 and 30 mg/kg), administered p.o. 30 minutes before the test, significantly and dose-dependently decreased the forelimb seizure score, as compared with vehicle control ( ⁇ 50%, p ⁇ 0.05 and ⁇ 70%, p ⁇ 0.01, respectively). It also dose-dependently decreased the number of mice with Straub tail with a significant effect observed at 30 mg/kg (10 mg/kg: ⁇ 13%, NS and 30 mg/kg: ⁇ 40%, p ⁇ 0.05) ( FIG. 7B ).
  • the Haloperidol-induced Catalepsy (HIC) model detects antipsychotic activity and the action of NR2B selective antagonists (Steece-Collier et al. Exp. Neurol. 163: 239, 2000) and was based on methods described by Chermat and Simon ( J. Pharmacol., 6, 493-496, 1975).
  • the capacity to induce catalepsy serves as an index of the liability of a test substance to induce extrapyramidal side-effects, in particular Parkinsonism.
  • Antagonism of antipsychotic-induced catalepsy can thus serve to detect anti-Parkinson potential.
  • Rats were injected with haloperidol (1 mg/kg i.p.) and were examined for catalepsy at 30 minute intervals up to 360 minutes. Presence (+) or absence ( ⁇ ) of catalepsy was assessed by three procedures: 1) imposed crossing of the ipsilateral fore- and hind-limbs; 2) placing the animal in the Buddha position; 3) the tilting board, an automatic device that, 5 seconds after positioning the rat, displaces the rat from a horizontal to vertical position and back while it clings to a wire grid with its front paws. Akinesia and catalepsy were assessed depending on whether or not the animal moves before (akinesia) or during operation of the board (catalepsy).
  • Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base).
  • Amphetamine (8 mg/kg p.o.), administered 60 minutes before the test (i.e. 90 minutes before the first measurement), was used as reference substance. Data with the test substances were analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using Kruskal-Wallis Test followed by Mann-Whitney U tests at each time and for cumulated score. Data with the reference substance were analyzed using Mann-Whitney U tests.
  • FIG. 8A The results are shown in FIG. 8A . Doses were given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of amphetamine was 8 mpk ( FIG. 8B ).
  • the positive control compound amphetamine (8 mg/kg p.o.) showed the expected robust anticataleptic activity ( FIG. 8B ).
  • Compound E1-1.2 significantly decreased the cumulated score of catalepsy over 360 mins, as compared with vehicle controls (2.0, p ⁇ 0.01).
  • Catalepsy was observed between 4 and 6 hours at 10 mg/kg.
  • the rat formalin model is a tonic model of continuous pain resulting from formalin-induced spontaneous nociceptive behaviors.
  • Intra-paw injection of formalin is a commonly used model to measure spontaneous nociceptive behaviors in rodents (Dubuisson, D. and Dennis, S. G. Pain 4:161, 1977).
  • Subcutaneous plantar injection of formalin causes a bi-phasic nocifensive behavioral response in rodents.
  • the early phase (phase-1) lasts for about 5-10 min following which an interphase occurs without any discernible nociceptive reactions after which the late phase (phase-II) nociceptive reaction ensues continuing from about 20-60 min following formalin injection.
  • Formalin model is a model of tonic, persistent pain, and is widely used for rapid screening of novel analgesic compounds.
  • the model encompasses inflammatory, neurogenic and central mechanisms of nociception, and the late phase in particular is considered as a pharmacodynamic surrogate of central sensitization.
  • effects of test item were assessed in 0-5 minutes from the early phase (phase-1) and 20-35 minutes from the late phase (phase-II) of formalin-induced nociceptive behavior. 20 mins before injection of formalin, the animals were administered with vehicle, test compound (10, 30, 60 mpk i.p.) typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle and positive control Duloxetine (30 mpk).
  • mice were acclimated to the observation chamber for 15 minutes immediately prior to formalin injection. All animals received an intraplantar subcutaneous injection of 50 ⁇ L of 5% formalin into the left hind paw and then placed immediately into an observation chamber and formalin-evoked spontaneous nociceptive behaviors in the rats were continuously recorded for 0-60 min using a commercial camcorder.
  • Scoring from the recorded video files was performed off-line using a PC by an observer who was validated to score such nociceptive behavior in rodents.
  • the total time spent in a 5 min bin was recorded using a stop-watch for the following nociceptive behavior: flinching, shaking, biting and licking of the injected paw.
  • Test compound E1-1.2 was administered as a mesylate salt (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base).
  • phase-1 Effects of the test compound was assessed in the following bins: 0-5 minutes from early phase (phase-1) and 20-35 minutes from late phase (phase-II).
  • Compound E1-1.2 decreased the cumulative time spent on nociceptive behavior in phase I (0-5 mins) ( FIG. 9A ) and phase II (20-35 mins) ( FIG. 9B ).
  • cortical spreading depression model is utilized to investigate whether treatment with compounds of the present invention affect electrophysiological and hemodynamic events in a rat model of migraine.
  • Rats were anesthetized with 5% isoflurane (in 70% N 2 O and 30% O 2 ; flow 300 ml/min) and placed in a stereotactic frame. During the operation and CSD the concentration of anesthetic was reduced to 1-1.5%. The rectal temperature was maintained at 37.0 ⁇ 1.0° C. with a homeothermic blanket system. The skin was opened by a medial incision and retracted laterally.
  • Three burr holes were drilled under saline cooling over the right hemisphere at the following coordinates (mm from bregma): (1) posterior 4.5, lateral, 2.0 (occipital cortex): KCl application site; (2) posterior 0.5, lateral 2.0 (parietal cortex): LDF recording site; (3) anterior 2, lateral 2 (frontal cortex): DC potential recording site.
  • a laser-Doppler flow probe (Oxyflow, Oxford Optronics, UK) to monitor CBF and an invasive Ag/AgCl electrode for measuring direct current (DC) potential shifts were placed in the parietal and frontal cortex burr holes on the intact dura and in the cortex, respectively.
  • the laser-Doppler flow probe was positioned in an area free of large pial and dural vessels to minimize a large-vessel contribution to the signal.
  • a reference electrode was fixed in the neck.
  • Dura overlying the occipital cortex was gently removed and care was taken to avoid bleeding.
  • the cortex was allowed to recover for 15 minutes under saline irrigation.
  • a cotton ball (2 mm diameter) soaked with 1M KCl was placed on the pial surface and kept moist by placing 5 ⁇ l of KCl solution every 15 minutes.
  • Test compound or vehicle was administered ten (10) minutes prior to CSD initiation.
  • Positive control MK-801 was administrated 30 min prior to CSD initiation.
  • the number of KCl-induced CSDs was counted for 2 hours.
  • the CBF and DC-potentials were monitored continuously starting from 5 minutes before KCl exposure.
  • Test compound E1-1.2 was administered as a mesylate salt (mpk based on molecular weight of the mesylate salt).
  • the data was collected in Windaq acquisition software (Dataq Instruments, USA) at 20 kHz.
  • the raw data was analyzed in Clampfit program (Axon Instruments, USA).
  • the signals were low pass filtered (cut off range 5-10000 Hz) that CSD episodes in DC and CBF could be confirmed.
  • the following parameters were analyzed: i) the number, duration and amplitude of DC-potentials, and ii) the number and amplitude of CBF events.
  • the results for number of DC potentials is shown in FIG. 10 .
  • Doses were given as milligram per kilogram (mpk).
  • Statistical analysis was performed using StatsDirect statistical software. Differences between groups were analyzed by using 1-way ANOVA and Dunnett's post hoc test.
  • Amplitude of DC potentials for compound E1-1.2 at various doses and MK-801 was not statistically different compared to vehicle (not shown). Duration of DC potentials for compound E1-1.2 at various doses was not statistically different compared to vehicle (not shown). Duration of DC potentials for MK-801 was increased compared to vehicle (p ⁇ 0.05, not shown).
  • the magnitude of CBF was unchanged for compound E1-1.2 compared to vehicle.
  • the number of CBF events was decreased for compound E1-1.2 at 10 mg/kg and for MK-801 at 1.25 mg/kg with a statistically significant difference from vehicle (* p ⁇ 0.05 vs vehicle group) (not shown).
  • Compound E1-1.2 (at 3 mpk, 10 mpk and 30 mpk) significantly decreased the number of DC potentials when compared to the vehicle group (* p ⁇ 0.05 for all doses vs vehicle group, data presented as mean ⁇ SEM). The present data demonstrate that compound E1-1.2 was effective in a model of migraine.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Neurology (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Neurosurgery (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Psychiatry (AREA)
  • Psychology (AREA)
  • Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Nitrogen Condensed Heterocyclic Rings (AREA)
  • Plural Heterocyclic Compounds (AREA)
  • Organic Low-Molecular-Weight Compounds And Preparation Thereof (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)

Abstract

Disclosed are chemical entities of Formula (I), wherein R1 and Z are defined herein, as NR2B subtype selective receptor antagonists. Also disclosed are pharmaceutical compositions comprising a chemical entity of Formula (I), and methods of treating various diseases and disorders associated with NR2B antagonism, e.g., diseases and disorders of the CNS, such as depression, by administering a chemical entity of Formula (I).

Description

    BACKGROUND
  • Non-selective NMDA receptor antagonists, originally developed in stroke and head trauma, have more recently shown clinical efficacy in treating depression. The non-selective NMDA receptor antagonist, ketamine, has been shown to have rapid onset and efficacy in depression resistant to standard monoamine reuptake inhibitor therapy (Mathews and Zarate, 2013, J. Clin. Psychiatry 74:516-158). However, non-selective NMDA receptor antagonists such as ketamine have a range of undesirable pharmacological activities which limit application in humans. In particular dissociative or psychogenic side effects are particularly prominent for non-selective NMDA receptor antagonists. More recently, NR2B subtype selective NMDA receptor antagonists have demonstrated potential in a wide range of clinical indications. In particular, NR2B antagonists have also demonstrated antidepressant activity in early stage clinical trials (Ibrahim et al., 2012, J. Clin. Psychopharmacol. 32, 551-557; Preskorn et al., 2008, J. Clin. Psychopharmacol. 28, 631-637). Furthermore, selective NR2B antagonists have advantages over unselective NMDA receptor antagonists such as ketamine due to greatly diminished dissociative side effects. However, NR2B antagonists described to date have generally exhibited drawbacks with regard to other drug properties which have limited potential use in human drug therapy.
  • SUMMARY
  • For broad scope of application and safe human use in a range of clinical indications including depression, improved NR2B subtype selective antagonists are needed. The present invention, among other things, addresses the need for NR2B receptor antagonists that are improved in one or more aspects exemplified by pharmacokinetic performance, oral activity, cardiovascular safety, and in vitro and in vivo therapeutic safety index measures.
  • In some embodiments, the present invention encompasses the insight that chemical entities of Formula (I):
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00002
  • wherein R1 and Z are defined herein, are NR2B subtype selective receptor antagonists. Chemical entities of Formula (I), and pharmaceutically acceptable compositions thereof, are useful for treating a variety of diseases and disorders associated with NR2B receptor antagonism. Such diseases and disorders include those described herein.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWING
  • FIG. 1A shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.1 with compound E1-1.2. FIG. 1B shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.2 with compound E1-8.2 by i.p. administration. FIG. 1C shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.3 with compound E1-21.26 by i.p. administration. FIG. 1D shows results of the Forced Swim Test in mice as described in Example 2.4.4 with compound E1-1.2 by oral (p.o.) administration. FIG. 1E shows results of the Forced Swim Test in rats as described in Example 2.4.5 with compound E1-1.2 by i.p. administration. FIG. 1F shows results of the Forced Swim Test in rats as described in Example 2.4.6 with compound E1-21.26 by p.o. administration. FIG. 1G shows results of the Forced Swim Test as described in Example 2.4.7 with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 2 shows results of the Electroconvulsive Threshold Test (ECT) as described in Example 2.5.1 with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 3 shows results of the Electroconvulsive Threshold Test (ECT) as described in Example 2.5.2 with compound E1-8.2.
  • FIG. 4 shows results of the Electroconvulsive Threshold Test (ECT) as described in Example 2.5.3 with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 5A shows the number of animals showing clonic convulsions in the Pentylenetetrazole (PTZ) Seizure Test as described in Example 2.6.1 with compound E1-1.2. FIG. 5B shows the number of animals showing tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2. FIG. 5C shows number of dead animals in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2. FIG. 5D shows latency to clonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2. FIG. 5E shows latency to tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2. FIG. 5F shows latency to death in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 6A shows the number of animals showing clonic convulsions in the Pentylenetetrazole (PTZ) Seizure Test as described in Example 2.6.2 with compound E1-21.26. FIG. 6B shows the number of animals showing tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26. FIG. 6C shows number of dead animals in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26. FIG. 6D shows latency to clonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26. FIG. 6E shows latency to tonic convulsions in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26. FIG. 6F shows latency to death in the PTZ Seizure Test with compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 7A shows the forelimb clonus score in the 6 Hz Seizure Test as described in Example 2.7.1 for compound E1-1.2. FIG. 7B shows the number of mice with Straub tail in the 6 Hz Seizure Test as described in Example 2.7.1 for compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 8A shows the results of the haloperidol-induced catalepsy model as described in Example 2.8.1 for compound E1-1.2. FIG. 8B shows the results of the haloperidol-induced catalepsy model for amphetamine. FIG. 8C shows the results of the haloperidol-induced catalepsy model as described in Example 2.8.2 for compound E1-21.26.
  • FIG. 9A shows the rat formalin model nociceptive behavior in phase I as described in Example 2.9 for compound E1-1.2. FIG. 9B shows the rat formalin model nociceptive behavior in phase II as described in Example 2.9 for compound E1-1.2.
  • FIG. 10 shows the number of DC potentials for compound E1-1.2 in the cortical spreading depression (migraine) model as described in Example 2.10.
  • FIG. 11 shows a ball-and-stick diagram of intermediate (R)-XVIa showing the numbering scheme employed in Tables A-D.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF CERTAIN EMBODIMENTS General Description of Chemical Entities
  • In some embodiments, the present invention provides chemical entities of Formula I:
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00003
  • wherein:
    • R1 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, (cycloalkyl)alkyl, heterocyclyl, (heterocyclyl)alkyl, aryl, (aryl)alkyl, heteroaryl or (heteroaryl)alkyl,
      • wherein each of cycloalkyl, (cycloalkyl)alkyl, heterocyclyl, (heterocyclyl)alkyl, aryl, (aryl)alkyl, heteroaryl and (heteroaryl)alkyl is independently optionally substituted with 1 to 3 groups independently selected from —F, —Cl, C1-C4 alkyl, cyclopropyl, —C≡CH, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, C1-C4 alkoxy, —OCFH2, —OCF2H, —OCF3, —CN, —N(R2)(R3), —NO2, C1-C4 alkylthio, C1-C4alkylsulfonyl and —S(O)2CF3;
        • wherein each instance of R2 and R3 independently is —H or C1-C4 alkyl, or —N(R2)(R3) is
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00004
    • Z is 5- or 6-membered monocyclic or 9- or 10-membered bicyclic heteroaryl having ring carbon atoms, 1 nitrogen ring atom and 0-3 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S, which is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups and optionally substituted with 1 Ra group, wherein each Rx is attached to a ring carbon atom and Ra is attached to a ring nitrogen atom;
      • wherein:
        • each instance of Rx independently is —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —OH, —OCH3, —OCF3 or —CN; and
        • Ra is C14 alkyl, C3-4 cycloalkyl or —S(O)2—C14 alkyl.
  • Unless otherwise specified or clear from context, the term “chemical entity” refers to a compound having the indicated structure, whether in its “free” form (e.g., “free compound” or “free base” or “free acid” form, as applicable), or in a salt form, particularly a pharmaceutically acceptable salt form, and furthermore whether in solid state form or otherwise. In some embodiments, a solid state form is an amorphous (i.e., non-crystalline) form; in some embodiments, a solid state form is a crystalline form. In some embodiments, a crystalline form (e.g., a polymorph, pseudohydrate, or hydrate). Similarly, the term encompasses the compound whether provided in solid form or otherwise. Unless otherwise specified, all statements made herein regarding “compounds” apply to the associated chemical entities, as defined.
  • Chemical Entities and Definitions
  • Unless otherwise specified, the word “includes” (or any variation thereon, e.g., “include”, “including”, etc.) is intended to be open-ended. For example, “A includes 1, 2 and 3” means that A includes but is not limited to 1, 2 and 3.
  • Unless otherwise specified, the phrase “such as” is intended to be open-ended. For example, “A can be a halogen, such as chlorine or bromine” means that A can be, but is not limited to, chlorine or bromine.
  • Chemical entities of this invention include those described generally above, and are further illustrated by the classes, subclasses, and species disclosed herein. As used herein, the following definitions shall apply unless otherwise indicated. For purposes of this invention, the chemical elements are identified in accordance with the Periodic Table of the Elements, CAS version, Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, 75th Ed., inside cover, and specific functional groups are generally defined as described therein. Additionally, general principles of organic chemistry, as well as specific functional moieties and reactivity, are described in Thomas Sorrell, Organic Chemistry, University Science Books, Sausalito, 1999; Smith and March, March's Advanced Organic Chemistry, 5th Edition, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, 2001; Larock, Comprehensive Organic Transformations, VCH Publishers, Inc., New York, 1989; and Carruthers, Some Modern Methods of Organic Synthesis, 3rd Edition, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 1987.
  • The term “alkyl”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, means a substituted or unsubstituted, linear or branched, univalent hydrocarbon chain that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation. Unless otherwise specified, alkyl groups contain 1 to 7 carbon atoms (“C1-C7 alkyl”). In some embodiments, alkyl groups contain 1 to 6 carbon atoms (“C1-C6 alkyl”). In some embodiments, alkyl groups contain 1 to 5 carbon atoms (“C1-C5 alkyl”). In some embodiments, alkyl groups contain 1 to 4 carbon atoms (“C1-C4 alkyl”). In some embodiments, alkyl groups contain 3 to 7 carbon atoms (“C3-C7 alkyl”). Examples of saturated alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, i-butyl, s-butyl, homologs and isomers of, for example, n-pentyl, n-hexyl, n-heptyl, n-octyl, and the like. An unsaturated alkyl group is one having one or more carbon-carbon double bonds or carbon-carbon triple bonds. Examples of unsaturated alkyl groups include allyl, vinyl, 2-propenyl, crotyl, 2-isopentenyl, 2-(butadienyl), 2,4-pentadienyl, 3-(1,4-pentadienyl), ethynyl, 1- and 3-propynyl, 3-butynyl, and the like. The term “lower alkyl” refers to alkyl groups having 1 to 4 (if saturated) or 2 to 4 (if unsaturated) carbon atoms. Exemplary lower alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl, n-butyl, s-butyl, i-butyl, t-butyl and the like. The term “alkenyl” refers to alkyl groups having at least two carbon atoms and at least one carbon-carbon double bond. The term “alkynyl” refers to alkyl groups having at least two carbon atoms and at least one carbon-carbon triple bond.
  • The term “cycloalkyl”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(cycloalkyl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent monocyclic hydrocarbon that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, but which is not aromatic; or bicyclo[2.2.1]heptanyl (also called norbornyl) or bicyclo[2.2.2]octanyl. In some embodiments, cycloalkyl groups contain 3 to 8 ring carbon atoms (“C3-C8 cycloalkyl”). Examples of cycloalkyl include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-cyclohexenyl, 3-cyclohexenyl, cycloheptyl, and the like, as well as bicyclo[2.2.1]heptanyl and bicyclo[2.2.2]octanyl.
  • The term “alkoxy”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, refers to the group —O-alkyl.
  • The term “halogen” or “halo”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, refers to fluoro, chloro, bromo or iodo.
  • The term “aryl”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(aryl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent monocyclic or bicyclic carbocyclic aromatic ring system. Unless otherwise specified, aryl groups contain 6 or 10 ring members. Examples of aryl include phenyl, naphthyl, and the like.
  • The term “heteroaryl”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(heteroaryl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent monocyclic or bicyclic group having 5 to 10 ring atoms, preferably 5, 6, 9 or 10 ring atoms, having 6, 10, or 14 T electrons shared in a cyclic array, and having, in addition to ring carbon atoms, from one to four ring heteroatoms. Examples of heteroaryl groups include thienyl, furanyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyridazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, indolizinyl, purinyl, naphthyridinyl, pteridinyl, and the like.
  • The term “heterocyclyl”, used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., “(heterocyclyl)alkyl”, refers to a univalent stable 5- to 7-membered monocyclic or 7- to 10-membered bicyclic heterocyclic moiety that is either saturated or partially unsaturated, and having, in addition to ring carbon atoms, one to four heteroatoms. Examples of heterocycyl groups include tetrahydrofuranyl, pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, and the like.
  • As used herein, the term “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” refers to those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art. For example, S. M. Berge et al., describe pharmaceutically acceptable salts in detail in J. Pharmaceutical Sciences, 1977, 66:1-19, incorporated herein by reference. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of this invention include those derived from suitable inorganic and organic acids and bases. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable, nontoxic acid addition salts are salts of an amino group formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid and perchloric acid or with organic acids such as acetic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, succinic acid or malonic acid or by using other methods used in the art such as ion exchange. Other pharmaceutically acceptable salts include adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate, benzoate, bisulfate, borate, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, formate, fumarate, glucoheptonate, glycerophosphate, gluconate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, lactobionate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, maleate, malonate, methanesulfonate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oleate, oxalate, palmitate, pamoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenylpropionate, phosphate, pivalate, propionate, stearate, succinate, sulfate, tartrate, thiocyanate, p-toluenesulfonate, undecanoate, valerate salts, and the like.
  • Salts derived from appropriate bases include alkali metal, alkaline earth metal, ammonium and N+(C1-4 alkyl)4 salts. Representative alkali or alkaline earth metal salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and the like. Further pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, when appropriate, nontoxic ammonium, quaternary ammonium, and amine cations formed using counterions such as halide, hydroxide, carboxylate, sulfate, phosphate, nitrate, lower alkyl sulfonate and aryl sulfonate.
  • As used herein, the term “subject” includes a mammal (e.g., a human, in some embodiments including prenatal human forms). In some embodiments, a subject is suffering from a relevant disease, disorder or condition. In some embodiments, a subject is susceptible to a disease, disorder, or condition. In some embodiments, a subject displays one or more symptoms or characteristics of a disease, disorder or condition. In some embodiments, a subject does not display any symptom or characteristic of a disease, disorder, or condition. In some embodiments, a subject is someone with one or more features characteristic of susceptibility to or risk of a disease, disorder, or condition. In some embodiments, a subject is a patient. In some embodiments, a subject is an individual to whom diagnosis and/or therapy is and/or has been administered. In some embodiments, a subject is a fetus, an infant, a child, a teenager, an adult, or a senior citizen (i.e., the subject is of advanced age, such as older than 50). In some embodiments, a child refers to a human between two and 18 years of age. In some embodiments, an adult refers to a human eighteen years of age or older.
  • Unless otherwise stated, structures depicted herein are also meant to include all isomeric (e.g., enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational)) forms of the structure; for example, the R and S configurations for each asymmetric center, Z and E double bond isomers, and Z and E conformational isomers. Therefore, single stereochemical isomers as well as enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational) mixtures of the present compounds are within the scope of the invention. Unless otherwise stated, all tautomeric forms of the compounds of the invention are within the scope of the invention. Additionally, unless otherwise stated, structures depicted herein are also meant to include compounds that differ only in the presence of one or more isotopically enriched atoms. For example, compounds having the present structures including the replacement hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, chlorine or fluorine with 2H, 3H, 11C, 13C, 14C, 13N 15N, 17O, 18O, 36Cl or 18F, respectively, are within the scope of this invention. Such compounds are useful, for example, as analytical tools, as probes in biological assays, or as therapeutic agents in accordance with the present invention. Additionally, incorporation of heavier isotopes such as deuterium (2H) can afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater metabolic stability, for example, increase in vivo half-life, or reduced dosage requirements.
  • Diastereomeric excess is expressed as % de, i.e., for diastereomers X and Y, the diastereomeric excess of X=((x−y)/(x+y))*100, where x and y are the fractions of X and Y, respectively.
  • Enantiomeric excess is expressed as % ee, i.e., for enantiomers X and Y, the entiomeric excess ofX=((x−y)/(x+y))*100, where x and y are the fractions of X and Y, respectively.
  • Exemplary Embodiments of Chemical Entities
  • In some embodiments, the present invention provides chemical entities of Formula (I):
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00005
  • wherein R1 and Z are as described above.
  • In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted alkyl.
  • In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted cycloalkyl or optionally substituted (cycloalkyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted cycloalkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted cyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R1 is cyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4,4-difluorocyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-methylcyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-ethylcyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-cyclopropylcyclohexyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted norbornanyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted (cycloalkyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is bicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-2-ylmethyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted cyclohexylmethyl. In some embodiments, R1 is cyclohexylmethyl. In some embodiments, R1 is (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl. In some embodiments, R1 is (4,4-difluorocyclohexyl)methyl.
  • In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted heterocyclyl or optionally substituted (heterocyclyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted heterocyclyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted tetrahydropyranyl. In some embodiments, R1 is tetrahydropyran-4-yl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted (heterocyclyl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted tetrahydropyranylmethyl. In some embodiments, R1 is tetrahydropyran-4-ylmethyl.
  • In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted (aryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted (aryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted benzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-methylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-ethylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-isopropylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-(2,2,2-tri-fluoroethyl)benzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-(1,1-difluoroethyl)benzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-t-butylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-chlorobenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-fluorobenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-difluoromethylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-trifluoromethylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-difluoromethoxybenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-trifluoromethoxybenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-methylthiobenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-ethylthiobenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-methylsulfonylbenzyl. In some embodiments R1 is 4-ethylsulfonylbenzyl. In some embodiments, R1 is 4-trifluoromethyl-sulfonylbenzyl.
  • In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted heteroaryl or optionally substituted (heteroaryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted (heteroaryl)alkyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted (pyridin-2-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally (5-chloro-pyridin-2-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally (5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R1 is optionally substituted (pyridin-3-yl)methyl. In some embodiments, R1 is (5-methyl-pyridin-3-yl)methyl.
  • In some embodiments, Z is 5- or 6-membered monocyclic or 9- or 10-membered bicyclic heteroaryl having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-3 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S, which is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups and optionally substituted with 1 Ra group, wherein each Rx is attached to a ring carbon atom and Ra is attached to a ring nitrogen atom.
  • In some embodiments, Z is 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteroaromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-3 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen heteroatom and 1 oxygen ring heteroatom.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 3 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 4 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 5- or 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-2 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0 or 1 additional ring nitrogen atoms. In some embodiments, Z is pyridyl. In some embodiments, Z is pyrimidinyl. In some embodiments, Z is pyridazinyl.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms. In some embodiments, Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups. In certain embodiments, Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is substituted with 1 Rx group. Thus, in some embodiments, Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is monosubstituted with Rx. In some embodiments, Z is pyridyl monosubstituted with Rx. In some embodiments, Z is pyrimidinyl monosubstituted with Rx. In some embodiments, Z is pyridazinyl monosubstituted with Rx. In some embodiments, Z is a 5-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-2 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 5-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0 or 1 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S. In some embodiments, Z is imidazolyl or thiazolyl. In some embodiments, Z is imidazolyl. In some embodiments, Z is thiazolyl.
  • In some embodiments, Z is a 5-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0-2 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S. In some embodiments, Z is triazolyl, oxadiazolyl or thiadiazolyl. In some embodiments, Z is triazolyl. In some embodiments, Z is oxadiazolyl. In some embodiments, Z is thiadiazolyl.
  • In some embodiments, Z is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups and optionally substituted with 1 Ra group, wherein each Rx is attached to a ring carbon atom and Ra is attached to a ring nitrogen atom. In some embodiments, each Rx is independently selected from —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —OH, —OCH3, —OCF3 or —CN. In some embodiments, Rx is —F or —Cl. In some embodiments, Rx is —F, —Cl or —CN. In some embodiments, Rx is —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H or —CF3. In some such embodiments, Rx is —CFH2, —CF2H or —CF3. In some embodiments, Rx is —CH3 or —CF3. In some embodiments, Rx is —OH, —OCH3 or —OCF3.
  • In some embodiments, each Ra is independently selected from C1-4 alkyl, C3-4 cycloalkyl or —S(O)2—C1-4 alkyl. In some embodiments, Ra is C1-4 alkyl or C3-4 cycloalkyl. In some embodiments, Ra is C1-4 alkyl. In some embodiments, Ra is —S(O)2—C1-4 alkyl.
  • In some embodiments Z is one of Formulas Z1-Z36, wherein Z is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups, wherein each Rx is attached to a ring carbon atom:
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00006
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00007
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00008
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00009
  • wherein:
      • each instance of Rx independently is —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —OH, —OCH3, —OCF3 or —CN; and
      • Ra is C1-4 alkyl, C3-4 cycloalkyl or —S(O)2—C1-4 alkyl.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, Z5, Z6, Z7, Z8, Z9, Z10, Z11, Z12, Z13, Z14, Z15, Z16, Z17, Z18, Z19, Z20, Z21, Z22, Z23, Z24, Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z29, Z30, Z31, Z32, Z33, Z34, Z35 or Z36.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, Z5, Z6, Z7, Z8, Z9, Z10, Z11, Z12, Z13, Z14, Z15, Z16, Z17, Z18, Z19, or Z20.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z1, Z2, Z5, Z6, Z8, Z17 or Z19. In some embodiments, Z is Z1 or Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z1. In some embodiments, Z is Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z6 or Z8. In some embodiments, Z is Z6. In some embodiments, Z is Z8.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z3, Z4, Z7, Z9, Z10, Z11, Z12, Z13, Z14 or Z18. In some embodiments, Z is Z7 or Z9. In some embodiments, Z is Z7. In some embodiments, Z is Z9.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z15, Z16 or Z20. In some embodiments, Z is Z15 or Z16. In some embodiments, Z is Z15. In some embodiments, Z is Z16. In some embodiments, Z is 20.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z21, Z22, Z23, Z24, Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z29, Z30, Z31, Z32, Z33, Z34, Z35 or Z36. In some embodiments, Z is Z21, Z22, Z23 or Z24. In some embodiments, Z is Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z29, Z30, Z31, Z32, Z33, Z34, Z35 or Z36.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z23.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z21, Z22, Z24, Z29, Z30, Z35 or Z36. In some embodiments, Z is Z21, Z22, Z24, Z35 or Z36. In some embodiments, Z is Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z21. In some embodiments, Z is Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z29 or Z30.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z31, Z32, Z33 or Z34. In some embodiments, Z is Z25 or Z26. In some embodiments, Z is Z25. In some embodiments, Z is Z26. In some embodiments, Z is Z27, Z31 or Z32. In some embodiments, Z is Z28, Z33 or Z34.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z27, Z29, Z30, Z31 or Z32. In some embodiments, Z is Z29 or Z30. In some embodiments, Z is Z27, Z31 or Z32.
  • In some embodiments, Z is Z28, Z33 or Z34. In some embodiments, Z is Z28.
  • In some embodiments, each instance of Rx independently is —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CF3 or —CN. In some embodiments, each instance of Rx independently is —CH3 or —CF3.
  • In some embodiments, Ra is —CH3.
  • In some embodiments, a chemical entity of Formula (I) is a chemical entity of Formula (II):
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00010
  • wherein Z is as described in embodiments of Formula (I), supra, or described in embodiments herein, both singly and in combination; and wherein R5, R6 and R7 independently are —H, —F, —Cl, C1-C4 alkyl, cyclopropyl, —C≡CH, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, C1-C4 alkoxy, —OCFH2, —OCF2H, —OCF3, —CN, —N(R2)(R3), —NO2, C1-C4 alkylthio, C1-C4alkylsulfonyl or —S(O)2CF3;
      • wherein each instance of R2 and R3 independently is —H or C1-C4 alkyl, or —N(R2)(R3) is
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00011
  • In some embodiments, Z is selected from formulas Z1-Z36, wherein: Rx and Ra are as described in embodiments of formulas Z1-Z36, supra, or described in embodiments herein, both singly and in combination.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R5, R6 and R7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, isopropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —SCH2CH3, —S(O)2CH3, —S(O)2CH2CH3, —S(O)2CF3 or —C≡CH.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R5, R6 and R7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —S(O)2CH3 or —C≡CH.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein:
    • R5 is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —S(O)2CH3 or —C≡CH;
    • R6 is —H or —F; and
    • R7 is —H, —F, —Cl or —CH3.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R5, R6 and R7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, isopropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —SCH2CH3, —S(O)2CH3, —S(O)2CH2CH3, —S(O)2CF3 or —C≡CH; and Z is Z1, Z2, Z6, Z7, Z8, Z9, Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z1, Z2, Z8, Z9, Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z1 or Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z1. In some embodiments, Z is Z2.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein each of R5, R6 and R7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —S(O)2CH3 or —C≡CH; and Z is Z1, Z2, Z8, Z9, Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z1 or Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z1. In some embodiments, Z is Z2.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity is a chemical entity of Formula (II), wherein:
    • R5 is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —S(O)2CH3 or —C≡CH;
    • R6 is —H or —F;
    • R7 is —H, —F, —Cl or —CH3; and
    • Z is Z1, Z2, Z8, Z9, Z21 or Z22. In some embodiments, Z is Z1 or Z2. In some embodiments, Z is Z1. In some embodiments, Z is Z2.
  • Designation of the stereocenter as R indicates that the R isomer is present in greater amount than the corresponding S isomer. For example, the R isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the S isomer. Similarly, in synthetic intermediates in which more than one stereocenter may be indicated, the R isomer can be present in a diastereomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the S isomer.
  • Designation of the stereocenter as S indicates that the S isomer is present in greater amount than the corresponding R isomer. For example, the S isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the R isomer. Similarly, in synthetic intermediates in which more than one stereocenter may be indicated, the S isomer can be present in a diastereomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the R isomer.
  • Designation of the optical rotation of a chemical entity indicates that the indicated enantiomer is present in greater amount than the opposite enantiomer. For example, the (−) isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the (+) isomer. Similarly, the (+) isomer can be present in an enantiomeric excess of 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 92%, 94%, 96% or 98% relative to the (−) isomer.
  • Exemplary chemical entities of Formula (I) are shown in Tables 1.C, 1.E1 and 1.E2, below.
  • TABLE 1.C
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00012
    compound Z R5 R6 R7
    C-1.1 Z1 H H H
    C-1.2 Z1 CH3 H H
    C-1.3 Z1 Cl H H
    C-1.4 Z1 F H H
    C-1.5 Z1 CH2CH3 H H
    C-1.6 Z1 CF2H H H
    C-1.7 Z1 CH2F H H
    C-1.8 Z1 CF3 H H
    C-1.9 Z1 CF2CH3 H H
    C-1.10 Z1 CH2CF3 H H
    C-1.11 Z1 cyclopropyl H H
    C-1.12 Z1 OCF3 H H
    C-1.13 Z1 OCF2H H H
    C-1.14 Z1 Cl H F
    C-1.15 Z1 CH3 H F
    C-1.16 Z1 CH3 F H
    C-1.17 Z1 Cl F H
    C-1.18 Z1 F F H
    C-1.19 Z1 F H F
    C-1.20 Z1 F H Cl
    C-1.21 Z1 F H CH3
    C-1.22 Z1 Cl H CH3
    C-1.23 Z1 SCH3 H H
    C-1.24 Z1 SO2CH3 H H
    C-1.25 Z1 ethynyl H H
    C-2.1 Z2 H H H
    C-2.2 Z2 CH3 H H
    C-2.3 Z2 Cl H H
    C-2.4 Z2 F H H
    C-2.5 Z2 CH2CH3 H H
    C-2.6 Z2 CF2H H H
    C-2.7 Z2 CH2F H H
    C-2.8 Z2 CF3 H H
    C-2.9 Z2 CF2CH3 H H
    C-2.10 Z2 CH2CF3 H H
    C-2.11 Z2 cyclopropyl H H
    C-2.12 Z2 OCF3 H H
    C-2.13 Z2 OCF2H H H
    C-2.14 Z2 Cl H F
    C-2.15 Z2 CH3 H F
    C-2.16 Z2 CH3 F H
    C-2.17 Z2 Cl F H
    C-2.18 Z2 F F H
    C-2.19 Z2 F H F
    C-2.20 Z2 F H Cl
    C-2.21 Z2 F H CH3
    C-2.22 Z2 Cl H CH3
    C-2.23 Z2 SCH3 H H
    C-2.24 Z2 SO2CH3 H H
    C-2.25 Z2 ethynyl H H
    C-3.1 Z3 H H H
    C-3.2 Z3 CH3 H H
    C-3.3 Z3 Cl H H
    C-3.4 Z3 F H H
    C-3.5 Z3 CH2CH3 H H
    C-3.6 Z3 CF2H H H
    C-3.7 Z3 CH2F H H
    C-3.8 Z3 CF3 H H
    C-3.9 Z3 CF2CH3 H H
    C-3.10 Z3 CH2CF3 H H
    C-3.11 Z3 cyclopropyl H H
    C-3.12 Z3 OCF3 H H
    C-3.13 Z3 OCF2H H H
    C-3.14 Z3 Cl H F
    C-3.15 Z3 CH3 H F
    C-3.16 Z3 CH3 F H
    C-3.17 Z3 Cl F H
    C-3.18 Z3 F F H
    C-3.19 Z3 F H F
    C-3.20 Z3 F H Cl
    C-3.21 Z3 F H CH3
    C-3.22 Z3 Cl H CH3
    C-3.23 Z3 SCH3 H H
    C-3.24 Z3 SO2CH3 H H
    C-3.25 Z3 ethynyl H H
    C-4.1 Z4 H H H
    C-4.2 Z4 CH3 H H
    C-4.3 Z4 Cl H H
    C-4.4 Z4 F H H
    C-4.5 Z4 CH2CH3 H H
    C-4.6 Z4 CF2H H H
    C-4.7 Z4 CH2F H H
    C-4.8 Z4 CF3 H H
    C-4.9 Z4 CF2CH3 H H
    C-4.10 Z4 CH2CF3 H H
    C-4.11 Z4 cyclopropyl H H
    C-4.12 Z4 OCF3 H H
    C-4.13 Z4 OCF2H H H
    C-4.14 Z4 Cl H F
    C-4.15 Z4 CH3 H F
    C-4.16 Z4 CH3 F H
    C-4.17 Z4 Cl F H
    C-4.18 Z4 F F H
    C-4.19 Z4 F H F
    C-4.20 Z4 F H Cl
    C-4.21 Z4 F H CH3
    C-4.22 Z4 Cl H CH3
    C-4.23 Z4 SCH3 H H
    C-4.24 Z4 SO2CH3 H H
    C-4.25 Z4 ethynyl H H
    C-5.1 Z5 H H H
    C-5.2 Z5 CH3 H H
    C-5.3 Z5 Cl H H
    C-5.4 Z5 F H H
    C-5.5 Z5 CH2CH3 H H
    C-5.6 Z5 CF2H H H
    C-5.7 Z5 CH2F H H
    C-5.8 Z5 CF3 H H
    C-5.9 Z5 CF2CH3 H H
    C-5.10 Z5 CH2CF3 H H
    C-5.11 Z5 cyclopropyl H H
    C-5.12 Z5 OCF3 H H
    C-5.13 Z5 OCF2H H H
    C-5.14 Z5 Cl H F
    C-5.15 Z5 CH3 H F
    C-5.16 Z5 CH3 F H
    C-5.17 Z5 Cl F H
    C-5.18 Z5 F F H
    C-5.19 Z5 F H F
    C-5.20 Z5 F H Cl
    C-5.21 Z5 F H CH3
    C-5.22 Z5 Cl H CH3
    C-5.23 Z5 SCH3 H H
    C-5.24 Z5 SO2CH3 H H
    C-5.25 Z5 ethynyl H H
    C-6.1 Z6, Ra is H H H H
    C-6.2 Z6, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-6.3 Z6, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-6.4 Z6, Ra is H F H H
    C-6.5 Z6, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-6.6 Z6, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-6.7 Z6, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-6.8 Z6, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-6.9 Z6, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-6.10 Z6, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-6.11 Z6, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-6.12 Z6, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-6.13 Z6, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-6.14 Z6, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-6.15 Z6, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-6.16 Z6, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-6.17 Z6, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-6.18 Z6, Ra is H F F H
    C-6.19 Z6, Ra is H F H F
    C-6.20 Z6, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-6.21 Z6, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-6.22 Z6, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-6.23 Z6, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-6.24 Z6, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-6.25 Z6, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-7.1 Z7, Ra is H H H H
    C-7.2 Z7, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-7.3 Z7, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-7.4 Z7, Ra is H F H H
    C-7.5 Z7, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-7.6 Z7, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-7.7 Z7, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-7.8 Z7, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-7.9 Z7, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-7.10 Z7, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-7.11 Z7, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-7.12 Z7, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-7.13 Z7, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-7.14 Z7, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-7.15 Z7, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-7.16 Z7, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-7.17 Z7, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-7.18 Z7, Ra is H F F H
    C-7.19 Z7, Ra is H F H F
    C-7.20 Z7, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-7.21 Z7, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-7.22 Z7, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-7.23 Z7, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-7.24 Z7, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-7.25 Z7, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-8.1 Z8, Ra is H H H H
    C-8.2 Z8, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-8.3 Z8, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-8.4 Z8, Ra is H F H H
    C-8.5 Z8, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-8.6 Z8, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-8.7 Z8, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-8.8 Z8, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-8.9 Z8, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-8.10 Z8, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-8.11 Z8, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-8.12 Z8, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-8.13 Z8, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-8.14 Z8, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-8.15 Z8, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-8.16 Z8, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-8.17 Z8, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-8.18 Z8, Ra is H F F H
    C-8.19 Z8, Ra is H F H F
    C-8.20 Z8, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-8.21 Z8, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-8.22 Z8, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-8.23 Z8, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-8.24 Z8, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-8.25 Z8, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-9.1 Z9 H H H
    C-9.2 Z9 CH3 H H
    C-9.3 Z9 Cl H H
    C-9.4 Z9 F H H
    C-9.5 Z9 CH2CH3 H H
    C-9.6 Z9 CF2H H H
    C-9.7 Z9 CH2F H H
    C-9.8 Z9 CF3 H H
    C-9.9 Z9 CF2CH3 H H
    C-9.10 Z9 CH2CF3 H H
    C-9.11 Z9 cyclopropyl H H
    C-9.12 Z9 OCF3 H H
    C-9.13 Z9 OCF2H H H
    C-9.14 Z9 Cl H F
    C-9.15 Z9 CH3 H F
    C-9.16 Z9 CH3 F H
    C-9.17 Z9 Cl F H
    C-9.18 Z9 F F H
    C-9.19 Z9 F H F
    C-9.20 Z9 F H Cl
    C-9.21 Z9 F H CH3
    C-9.22 Z9 Cl H CH3
    C-9.23 Z9 SCH3 H H
    C-9.24 Z9 SO2CH3 H H
    C-9.25 Z9 ethynyl H H
    C-10.1 Z10 H H H
    C-10.2 Z10 CH3 H H
    C-10.3 Z10 Cl H H
    C-10.4 Z10 F H H
    C-10.5 Z10 CH2CH3 H H
    C-10.6 Z10 CF2H H H
    C-10.7 Z10 CH2F H H
    C-10.8 Z10 CF3 H H
    C-10.9 Z10 CF2CH3 H H
    C-10.10 Z10 CH2CF3 H H
    C-10.11 Z10 cyclopropyl H H
    C-10.12 Z10 OCF3 H H
    C-10.13 Z10 OCF2H H H
    C-10.14 Z10 Cl H F
    C-10.15 Z10 CH3 H F
    C-10.16 Z10 CH3 F H
    C-10.17 Z10 Cl F H
    C-10.18 Z10 F F H
    C-10.19 Z10 F H F
    C-10.20 Z10 F H Cl
    C-10.21 Z10 F H CH3
    C-10.22 Z10 Cl H CH3
    C-10.23 Z10 SCH3 H H
    C-10.24 Z10 SO2CH3 H H
    C-10.25 Z10 ethynyl H H
    C-11.1 Z11, Ra is H H H H
    C-11.2 Z11, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-11.3 Z11, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-11.4 Z11, Ra is H F H H
    C-11.5 Z11, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-11.6 Z11, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-11.7 Z11, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-11.8 Z11, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-11.9 Z11, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-11.10 Z11, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-11.11 Z11, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-11.12 Z11, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-11.13 Z11, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-11.14 Z11, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-11.15 Z11, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-11.16 Z11, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-11.17 Z11, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-11.18 Z11, Ra is H F F H
    C-11.19 Z11, Ra is H F H F
    C-11.20 Z11, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-11.21 Z11, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-11.22 Z11, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-11.23 Z11, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-11.24 Z11, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-11.25 Z11, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-12.1 Z12 H H H
    C-12.2 Z12 CH3 H H
    C-12.3 Z12 Cl H H
    C-12.4 Z12 F H H
    C-12.5 Z12 CH2CH3 H H
    C-12.6 Z12 CF2H H H
    C-12.7 Z12 CH2F H H
    C-12.8 Z12 CF3 H H
    C-12.9 Z12 CF2CH3 H H
    C-12.10 Z12 CH2CF3 H H
    C-12.11 Z12 cyclopropyl H H
    C-12.12 Z12 OCF3 H H
    C-12.13 Z12 OCF2H H H
    C-12.14 Z12 Cl H F
    C-12.15 Z12 CH3 H F
    C-12.16 Z12 CH3 F H
    C-12.17 Z12 Cl F H
    C-12.18 Z12 F F H
    C-12.19 Z12 F H F
    C-12.20 Z12 F H Cl
    C-12.21 Z12 F H CH3
    C-12.22 Z12 Cl H CH3
    C-12.23 Z12 SCH3 H H
    C-12.24 Z12 SO2CH3 H H
    C-12.25 Z12 ethynyl H H
    C-13.1 Z13, Ra is H H H H
    C-13.2 Z13, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-13.3 Z13, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-13.4 Z13, Ra is H F H H
    C-13.5 Z13, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-13.6 Z13, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-13.7 Z13, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-13.8 Z13, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-13.9 Z13, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-13.10 Z13, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-13.11 Z13, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-13.12 Z13, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-13.13 Z13, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-13.14 Z13, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-13.15 Z13, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-13.16 Z13, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-13.17 Z13, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-13.18 Z13, Ra is H F F H
    C-13.19 Z13, Ra is H F H F
    C-13.20 Z13, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-13.21 Z13, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-13.22 Z13, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-13.23 Z13, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-13.24 Z13, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-13.25 Z13, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-14.1 Z14, Ra is H H H H
    C-14.2 Z14, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-14.3 Z14, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-14.4 Z14, Ra is H F H H
    C-14.5 Z14, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-14.6 Z14, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-14.7 Z14, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-14.8 Z14, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-14.9 Z14, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-14.10 Z14, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-14.11 Z14, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-14.12 Z14, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-14.13 Z14, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-14.14 Z14, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-14.15 Z14, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-14.16 Z14, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-14.17 Z14, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-14.18 Z14, Ra is H F F H
    C-14.19 Z14, Ra is H F H F
    C-14.20 Z14, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-14.21 Z14, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-14.22 Z14, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-14.23 Z14, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-14.24 Z14, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-14.25 Z14, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-15.1 Z15, Ra is H H H H
    C-15.2 Z15, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-15.3 Z15, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-15.4 Z15, Ra is H F H H
    C-15.5 Z15, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-15.6 Z15, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-15.7 Z15, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-15.8 Z15, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-15.9 Z15, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-15.10 Z15, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-15.11 Z15, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-15.12 Z15, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-15.13 Z15, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-15.14 Z15, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-15.15 Z15, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-15.16 Z15, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-15.17 Z15, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-15.18 Z15, Ra is H F F H
    C-15.19 Z15, Ra is H F H F
    C-15.20 Z15, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-15.21 Z15, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-15.22 Z15, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-15.23 Z15, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-15.24 Z15, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-15.25 Z15, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-16.1 Z16, Ra is H H H H
    C-16.2 Z16, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-16.3 Z16, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-16.4 Z16, Ra is H F H H
    C-16.5 Z16, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-16.6 Z16, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-16.7 Z16, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-16.8 Z16, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-16.9 Z16, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-16.10 Z16, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-16.11 Z16, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-16.12 Z16, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-16.13 Z16, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-16.14 Z16, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-16.15 Z16, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-16.16 Z16, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-16.17 Z16, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-16.18 Z16, Ra is H F F H
    C-16.19 Z16, Ra is H F H F
    C-16.20 Z16, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-16.21 Z16, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-16.22 Z16, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-16.23 Z16, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-16.24 Z16, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-16.25 Z16, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-17.1 Z17 H H H
    C-17.2 Z17 CH3 H H
    C-17.3 Z17 Cl H H
    C-17.4 Z17 F H H
    C-17.5 Z17 CH2CH3 H H
    C-17.6 Z17 CF2H H H
    C-17.7 Z17 CH2F H H
    C-17.8 Z17 CF3 H H
    C-17.9 Z17 CF2CH3 H H
    C-17.10 Z17 CH2CF3 H H
    C-17.11 Z17 cyclopropyl H H
    C-17.12 Z17 OCF3 H H
    C-17.13 Z17 OCF2H H H
    C-17.14 Z17 Cl H F
    C-17.15 Z17 CH3 H F
    C-17.16 Z17 CH3 F H
    C-17.17 Z17 Cl F H
    C-17.18 Z17 F F H
    C-17.19 Z17 F H F
    C-17.20 Z17 F H Cl
    C-17.21 Z17 F H CH3
    C-17.22 Z17 Cl H CH3
    C-17.23 Z17 SCH3 H H
    C-17.24 Z17 SO2CH3 H H
    C-17.25 Z17 ethynyl H H
    C-18.1 Z18 H H H
    C-18.2 Z18 CH3 H H
    C-18.3 Z18 Cl H H
    C-18.4 Z18 F H H
    C-18.5 Z18 CH2CH3 H H
    C-18.6 Z18 CF2H H H
    C-18.7 Z18 CH2F H H
    C-18.8 Z18 CF3 H H
    C-18.9 Z18 CF2CH3 H H
    C-18.10 Z18 CH2CF3 H H
    C-18.11 Z18 cyclopropyl H H
    C-18.12 Z18 OCF3 H H
    C-18.13 Z18 OCF2H H H
    C-18.14 Z18 Cl H F
    C-18.15 Z18 CH3 H F
    C-18.16 Z18 CH3 F H
    C-18.17 Z18 Cl F H
    C-18.18 Z18 F F H
    C-18.19 Z18 F H F
    C-18.20 Z18 F H Cl
    C-18.21 Z18 F H CH3
    C-18.22 Z18 Cl H CH3
    C-18.23 Z18 SCH3 H H
    C-18.24 Z18 SO2CH3 H H
    C-18.25 Z18 ethynyl H H
    C-19.1 Z19 H H H
    C-19.2 Z19 CH3 H H
    C-19.3 Z19 Cl H H
    C-19.4 Z19 F H H
    C-19.5 Z19 CH2CH3 H H
    C-19.6 Z19 CF2H H H
    C-19.7 Z19 CH2F H H
    C-19.8 Z19 CF3 H H
    C-19.9 Z19 CF2CH3 H H
    C-19.10 Z19 CH2CF3 H H
    C-19.11 Z19 cyclopropyl H H
    C-19.12 Z19 OCF3 H H
    C-19.13 Z19 OCF2H H H
    C-19.14 Z19 Cl H F
    C-19.15 Z19 CH3 H F
    C-19.16 Z19 CH3 F H
    C-19.17 Z19 Cl F H
    C-19.18 Z19 F F H
    C-19.19 Z19 F H F
    C-19.20 Z19 F H Cl
    C-19.21 Z19 F H CH3
    C-19.22 Z19 Cl H CH3
    C-19.23 Z19 SCH3 H H
    C-19.24 Z19 SO2CH3 H H
    C-19.25 Z19 ethynyl H H
    C-19.26 Z19 CH3 H H
    C-20.1 Z20 H H H
    C-20.2 Z20 CH3 H H
    C-20.3 Z20 Cl H H
    C-20.4 Z20 F H H
    C-20.5 Z20 CH2CH3 H H
    C-20.6 Z20 CF2H H H
    C-20.7 Z20 CH2F H H
    C-20.8 Z20 CF3 H H
    C-20.9 Z20 CF2CH3 H H
    C-20.10 Z20 CH2CF3 H H
    C-20.11 Z20 cyclopropyl H H
    C-20.12 Z20 OCF3 H H
    C-20.13 Z20 OCF2H H H
    C-20.14 Z20 Cl H F
    C-20.15 Z20 CH3 H F
    C-20.16 Z20 CH3 F H
    C-20.17 Z20 Cl F H
    C-20.18 Z20 F F H
    C-20.19 Z20 F H F
    C-20.20 Z20 F H Cl
    C-20.21 Z20 F H CH3
    C-20.22 Z20 Cl H CH3
    C-20.23 Z20 SCH3 H H
    C-20.24 Z20 SO2CH3 H H
    C-20.25 Z20 ethynyl H H
    C-21.1 Z21 H H H
    C-21.2 Z21 CH3 H H
    C-21.3 Z21 Cl H H
    C-21.4 Z21 F H H
    C-21.5 Z21 CH2CH3 H H
    C-21.6 Z21 CF2H H H
    C-21.7 Z21 CH2F H H
    C-21.8 Z21 CF3 H H
    C-21.9 Z21 CF2CH3 H H
    C-21.10 Z21 CH2CF3 H H
    C-21.11 Z21 cyclopropyl H H
    C-21.12 Z21 OCF3 H H
    C-21.13 Z21 OCF2H H H
    C-21.14 Z21 Cl H F
    C-21.15 Z21 CH3 H F
    C-21.16 Z21 CH3 F H
    C-21.17 Z21 Cl F H
    C-21.18 Z21 F F H
    C-21.19 Z21 F H F
    C-21.20 Z21 F H Cl
    C-21.21 Z21 F H CH3
    C-21.22 Z21 Cl H CH3
    C-21.23 Z21 SCH3 H H
    C-21.24 Z21 SO2CH3 H H
    C-21.25 Z21 ethynyl H H
    C-21.26
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00013
    CH3 H H
    C-22.1 Z22 H H H
    C-22.2 Z22 CH3 H H
    C-22.3 Z22 Cl H H
    C-22.4 Z22 F H H
    C-22.5 Z22 CH2CH3 H H
    C-22.6 Z22 CF2H H H
    C-22.7 Z22 CH2F H H
    C-22.8 Z22 CF3 H H
    C-22.9 Z22 CF2CH3 H H
    C-22.10 Z22 CH2CF3 H H
    C-22.11 Z22 cyclopropyl H H
    C-22.12 Z22 OCF3 H H
    C-22.13 Z22 OCF2H H H
    C-22.14 Z22 Cl H F
    C-22.15 Z22 CH3 H F
    C-22.16 Z22 CH3 F H
    C-22.17 Z22 Cl F H
    C-22.18 Z22 F F H
    C-22.19 Z22 F H F
    C-22.20 Z22 F H Cl
    C-22.21 Z22 F H CH3
    C-22.22 Z22 Cl H CH3
    C-22.23 Z22 SCH3 H H
    C-22.24 Z22 SO2CH3 H H
    C-22.25 Z22 ethynyl H H
    C-23.1 Z23 H H H
    C-23.2 Z23 CH3 H H
    C-23.3 Z23 Cl H H
    C-23.4 Z23 F H H
    C-23.5 Z23 CH2CH3 H H
    C-23.6 Z23 CF2H H H
    C-23.7 Z23 CH2F H H
    C-23.8 Z23 CF3 H H
    C-23.9 Z23 CF2CH3 H H
    C-23.10 Z23 CH2CF3 H H
    C-23.11 Z23 cyclopropyl H H
    C-23.12 Z23 OCF3 H H
    C-23.13 Z23 OCF2H H H
    C-23.14 Z23 Cl H F
    C-23.15 Z23 CH3 H F
    C-23.16 Z23 CH3 F H
    C-23.17 Z23 Cl F H
    C-23.18 Z23 F F H
    C-23.19 Z23 F H F
    C-23.20 Z23 F H Cl
    C-23.21 Z23 F H CH3
    C-23.22 Z23 Cl H CH3
    C-23.23 Z23 SCH3 H H
    C-23.24 Z23 SO2CH3 H H
    C-23.25 Z23 ethynyl H H
    C-24.1 Z24 H H H
    C-24.2 Z24 CH3 H H
    C-24.3 Z24 Cl H H
    C-24.4 Z24 F H H
    C-24.5 Z24 CH2CH3 H H
    C-24.6 Z24 CF2H H H
    C-24.7 Z24 CH2F H H
    C-24.8 Z24 CF3 H H
    C-24.9 Z24 CF2CH3 H H
    C-24.10 Z24 CH2CF3 H H
    C-24.11 Z24 cyclopropyl H H
    C-24.12 Z24 OCF3 H H
    C-24.13 Z24 OCF2H H H
    C-24.14 Z24 Cl H F
    C-24.15 Z24 CH3 H F
    C-24.16 Z24 CH3 F H
    C-24.17 Z24 Cl F H
    C-24.18 Z24 F F H
    C-24.19 Z24 F H F
    C-24.20 Z24 F H Cl
    C-24.21 Z24 F H CH3
    C-24.22 Z24 Cl H CH3
    C-24.23 Z24 SCH3 H H
    C-24.24 Z24 SO2CH3 H H
    C-24.25 Z24 ethynyl H H
    C-25.1 Z25, Ra is H H H H
    C-25.2 Z25, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-25.3 Z25, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-25.4 Z25, Ra is H F H H
    C-25.5 Z25, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-25.6 Z25, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-25.7 Z25, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-25.8 Z25, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-25.9 Z25, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-25.10 Z25, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-25.11 Z25, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-25.12 Z25, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-25.13 Z25, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-25.14 Z25, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-25.15 Z25, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-25.16 Z25, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-25.17 Z25, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-25.18 Z25, Ra is H F F H
    C-25.19 Z25, Ra is H F H F
    C-25.20 Z25, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-25.21 Z25, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-25.22 Z25, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-25.23 Z25, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-25.24 Z25, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-25.25 Z25, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-26.1 Z26, Ra is H H H H
    C-26.2 Z26, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-26.3 Z26, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-26.4 Z26, Ra is H F H H
    C-26.5 Z26, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-26.6 Z26, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-26.7 Z26, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-26.8 Z26, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-26.9 Z26, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-26.10 Z26, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-26.11 Z26, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-26.12 Z26, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-26.13 Z26, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-26.14 Z26, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-26.15 Z26, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-26.16 Z26, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-26.17 Z26, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-26.18 Z26, Ra is H F F H
    C-26.19 Z26, Ra is H F H F
    C-26.20 Z26, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-26.21 Z26, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-26.22 Z26, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-26.23 Z26, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-26.24 Z26, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-26.25 Z26, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-27.1 Z27 H H H
    C-27.2 Z27 CH3 H H
    C-27.3 Z27 Cl H H
    C-27.4 Z27 F H H
    C-27.5 Z27 CH2CH3 H H
    C-27.6 Z27 CF2H H H
    C-27.7 Z27 CH2F H H
    C-27.8 Z27 CF3 H H
    C-27.9 Z27 CF2CH3 H H
    C-27.10 Z27 CH2CF3 H H
    C-27.11 Z27 cyclopropyl H H
    C-27.12 Z27 OCF3 H H
    C-27.13 Z27 OCF2H H H
    C-27.14 Z27 Cl H F
    C-27.15 Z27 CH3 H F
    C-27.16 Z27 CH3 F H
    C-27.17 Z27 Cl F H
    C-27.18 Z27 F F H
    C-27.19 Z27 F H F
    C-27.20 Z27 F H Cl
    C-27.21 Z27 F H CH3
    C-27.22 Z27 Cl H CH3
    C-27.23 Z27 SCH3 H H
    C-27.24 Z27 SO2CH3 H H
    C-27.25 Z27 ethynyl H H
    C-28.1 Z28 H H H
    C-28.2 Z28 CH3 H H
    C-28.3 Z28 Cl H H
    C-28.4 Z28 F H H
    C-28.5 Z28 CH2CH3 H H
    C-28.6 Z28 CF2H H H
    C-28.7 Z28 CH2F H H
    C-28.8 Z28 CF3 H H
    C-28.9 Z28 CF2CH3 H H
    C-28.10 Z28 CH2CF3 H H
    C-28.11 Z28 cyclopropyl H H
    C-28.12 Z28 OCF3 H H
    C-28.13 Z28 OCF2H H H
    C-28.14 Z28 Cl H F
    C-28.15 Z28 CH3 H F
    C-28.16 Z28 CH3 F H
    C-28.17 Z28 Cl F H
    C-28.18 Z28 F F H
    C-28.19 Z28 F H F
    C-28.20 Z28 F H Cl
    C-28.21 Z28 F H CH3
    C-28.22 Z28 Cl H CH3
    C-28.23 Z28 SCH3 H H
    C-28.24 Z28 SO2CH3 H H
    C-28.25 Z28 ethynyl H H
    C-29.1 Z29 H H H
    C-29.2 Z29 CH3 H H
    C-29.3 Z29 Cl H H
    C-29.4 Z29 F H H
    C-29.5 Z29 CH2CH3 H H
    C-29.6 Z29 CF2H H H
    C-29.7 Z29 CH2F H H
    C-29.8 Z29 CF3 H H
    C-29.9 Z29 CF2CH3 H H
    C-29.10 Z29 CH2CF3 H H
    C-29.11 Z29 cyclopropyl H H
    C-29.12 Z29 OCF3 H H
    C-29.13 Z29 OCF2H H H
    C-29.14 Z29 Cl H F
    C-29.15 Z29 CH3 H F
    C-29.16 Z29 CH3 F H
    C-29.17 Z29 Cl F H
    C-29.18 Z29 F F H
    C-29.19 Z29 F H F
    C-29.20 Z29 F H Cl
    C-29.21 Z29 F H CH3
    C-29.22 Z29 Cl H CH3
    C-29.23 Z29 SCH3 H H
    C-29.24 Z29 SO2CH3 H H
    C-29.25 Z29 ethynyl H H
    C-30.1 Z30 H H H
    C-30.2 Z30 CH3 H H
    C-30.3 Z30 Cl H H
    C-30.4 Z30 F H H
    C-30.5 Z30 CH2CH3 H H
    C-30.6 Z30 CF2H H H
    C-30.7 Z30 CH2F H H
    C-30.8 Z30 CF3 H H
    C-30.9 Z30 CF2CH3 H H
    C-30.10 Z30 CH2CF3 H H
    C-30.11 Z30 cyclopropyl H H
    C-30.12 Z30 OCF3 H H
    C-30.13 Z30 OCF2H H H
    C-30.14 Z30 Cl H F
    C-30.15 Z30 CH3 H F
    C-30.16 Z30 CH3 F H
    C-30.17 Z30 Cl F H
    C-30.18 Z30 F F H
    C-30.19 Z30 F H F
    C-30.20 Z30 F H Cl
    C-30.21 Z30 F H CH3
    C-30.22 Z30 Cl H CH3
    C-30.23 Z30 SCH3 H H
    C-30.24 Z30 SO2CH3 H H
    C-30.25 Z30 ethynyl H H
    C-31.1 Z31 H H H
    C-31.2 Z31 CH3 H H
    C-31.3 Z31 Cl H H
    C-31.4 Z31 F H H
    C-31.5 Z31 CH2CH3 H H
    C-31.6 Z31 CF2H H H
    C-31.7 Z31 CH2F H H
    C-31.8 Z31 CF3 H H
    C-31.9 Z31 CF2CH3 H H
    C-31.10 Z31 CH2CF3 H H
    C-31.11 Z31 cyclopropyl H H
    C-31.12 Z31 OCF3 H H
    C-31.13 Z31 OCF2H H H
    C-31.14 Z31 Cl H F
    C-31.15 Z31 CH3 H F
    C-31.16 Z31 CH3 F H
    C-31.17 Z31 Cl F H
    C-31.18 Z31 F F H
    C-31.19 Z31 F H F
    C-31.20 Z31 F H Cl
    C-31.21 Z31 F H CH3
    C-31.22 Z31 Cl H CH3
    C-31.23 Z31 SCH3 H H
    C-31.24 Z31 SO2CH3 H H
    C-31.25 Z31 ethynyl H H
    C-32.1 Z32 H H H
    C-32.2 Z32 CH3 H H
    C-32.3 Z32 Cl H H
    C-32.4 Z32 F H H
    C-32.5 Z32 CH2CH3 H H
    C-32.6 Z32 CF2H H H
    C-32.7 Z32 CH2F H H
    C-32.8 Z32 CF3 H H
    C-32.9 Z32 CF2CH3 H H
    C-32.10 Z32 CH2CF3 H H
    C-32.11 Z32 cyclopropyl H H
    C-32.12 Z32 OCF3 H H
    C-32.13 Z32 OCF2H H H
    C-32.14 Z32 Cl H F
    C-32.15 Z32 CH3 H F
    C-32.16 Z32 CH3 F H
    C-32.17 Z32 Cl F H
    C-32.18 Z32 F F H
    C-32.19 Z32 F H F
    C-32.20 Z32 F H Cl
    C-32.21 Z32 F H CH3
    C-32.22 Z32 Cl H CH3
    C-32.23 Z32 SCH3 H H
    C-32.24 Z32 SO2CH3 H H
    C-32.25 Z32 ethynyl H H
    C-33.1 Z33 H H H
    C-33.2 Z33 CH3 H H
    C-33.3 Z33 Cl H H
    C-33.4 Z33 F H H
    C-33.5 Z33 CH2CH3 H H
    C-33.6 Z33 CF2H H H
    C-33.7 Z33 CH2F H H
    C-33.8 Z33 CF3 H H
    C-33.9 Z33 CF2CH3 H H
    C-33.10 Z33 CH2CF3 H H
    C-33.11 Z33 cyclopropyl H H
    C-33.12 Z33 OCF3 H H
    C-33.13 Z33 OCF2H H H
    C-33.14 Z33 Cl H F
    C-33.15 Z33 CH3 H F
    C-33.16 Z33 CH3 F H
    C-33.17 Z33 Cl F H
    C-33.18 Z33 F F H
    C-33.19 Z33 F H F
    C-33.20 Z33 F H Cl
    C-33.21 Z33 F H CH3
    C-33.22 Z33 Cl H CH3
    C-33.23 Z33 SCH3 H H
    C-33.24 Z33 SO2CH3 H H
    C-33.25 Z33 ethynyl H H
    C-34.1 Z34 H H H
    C-34.2 Z34 CH3 H H
    C-34.3 Z34 Cl H H
    C-34.4 Z34 F H H
    C-34.5 Z34 CH2CH3 H H
    C-34.6 Z34 CF2H H H
    C-34.7 Z34 CH2F H H
    C-34.8 Z34 CF3 H H
    C-34.9 Z34 CF2CH3 H H
    C-34.10 Z34 CH2CF3 H H
    C-34.11 Z34 cyclopropyl H H
    C-34.12 Z34 OCF3 H H
    C-34.13 Z34 OCF2H H H
    C-34.14 Z34 Cl H F
    C-34.15 Z34 CH3 H F
    C-34.16 Z34 CH3 F H
    C-34.17 Z34 Cl F H
    C-34.18 Z34 F F H
    C-34.19 Z34 F H F
    C-34.20 Z34 F H Cl
    C-34.21 Z34 F H CH3
    C-34.22 Z34 Cl H CH3
    C-34.23 Z34 SCH3 H H
    C-34.24 Z34 SO2CH3 H H
    C-34.25 Z34 ethynyl H H
    C-35.1 Z35, Ra is H H H H
    C-35.2 Z35, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-35.3 Z35, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-35.4 Z35, Ra is H F H H
    C-35.5 Z35, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-35.6 Z35, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-35.7 Z35, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-35.8 Z35, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-35.9 Z35, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-35.10 Z35, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-35.11 Z35, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-35.12 Z35, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-35.13 Z35, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-35.14 Z35, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-35.15 Z35, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-35.16 Z35, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-35.17 Z35, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-35.18 Z35, Ra is H F F H
    C-35.19 Z35, Ra is H F H F
    C-35.20 Z35, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-35.21 Z35, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-35.22 Z35, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-35.23 Z35, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-35.24 Z35, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-35.25 Z35, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    C-36.1 Z36, Ra is H H H H
    C-36.2 Z36, Ra is H CH3 H H
    C-36.3 Z36, Ra is H Cl H H
    C-36.4 Z36, Ra is H F H H
    C-36.5 Z36, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    C-36.6 Z36, Ra is H CF2H H H
    C-36.7 Z36, Ra is H CH2F H H
    C-36.8 Z36, Ra is H CF3 H H
    C-36.9 Z36, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    C-36.10 Z36, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    C-36.11 Z36, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    C-36.12 Z36, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    C-36.13 Z36, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    C-36.14 Z36, Ra is H Cl H F
    C-36.15 Z36, Ra is H CH3 H F
    C-36.16 Z36, Ra is H CH3 F H
    C-36.17 Z36, Ra is H Cl F H
    C-36.18 Z36, Ra is H F F H
    C-36.19 Z36, Ra is H F H F
    C-36.20 Z36, Ra is H F H Cl
    C-36.21 Z36, Ra is H F H CH3
    C-36.22 Z36, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    C-36.23 Z36, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    C-36.24 Z36, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    C-36.25 Z36, Ra is H ethynyl H H
  • TABLE 1.E1
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00014
    compound Z R5 R6 R7
    E1-1.1 Z1 H H H
    E1-1.2 Z1 CH3 H H
    E1-1.3 Z1 Cl H H
    E1-1.4 Z1 F H H
    E1-1.5 Z1 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-1.6 Z1 CF2H H H
    E1-1.7 Z1 CH2F H H
    E1-1.8 Z1 CF3 H H
    E1-1.9 Z1 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-1.10 Z1 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-1.11 Z1 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-1.12 Z1 OCF3 H H
    E1-1.13 Z1 OCF2H H H
    E1-1.14 Z1 Cl H F
    E1-1.15 Z1 CH3 H F
    E1-1.16 Z1 CH3 F H
    E1-1.17 Z1 Cl F H
    E1-1.18 Z1 F F H
    E1-1.19 Z1 F H F
    E1-1.20 Z1 F H Cl
    E1-1.21 Z1 F H CH3
    E1-1.22 Z1 Cl H CH3
    E1-1.23 Z1 SCH3 H H
    E1-1.24 Z1 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-1.25 Z1 ethynyl H H
    E1-2.1 Z2 H H H
    E1-2.2 Z2 CH3 H H
    E1-2.3 Z2 Cl H H
    E1-2.4 Z2 F H H
    E1-2.5 Z2 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-2.6 Z2 CF2H H H
    E1-2.7 Z2 CH2F H H
    E1-2.8 Z2 CF3 H H
    E1-2.9 Z2 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-2.10 Z2 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-2.11 Z2 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-2.12 Z2 OCF3 H H
    E1-2.13 Z2 OCF2H H H
    E1-2.14 Z2 Cl H F
    E1-2.15 Z2 CH3 H F
    E1-2.16 Z2 CH3 F H
    E1-2.17 Z2 Cl F H
    E1-2.18 Z2 F F H
    E1-2.19 Z2 F H F
    E1-2.20 Z2 F H Cl
    E1-2.21 Z2 F H CH3
    E1-2.22 Z2 Cl H CH3
    E1-2.23 Z2 SCH3 H H
    E1-2.24 Z2 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-2.25 Z2 ethynyl H H
    E1-3.1 Z3 H H H
    E1-3.2 Z3 CH3 H H
    E1-3.3 Z3 Cl H H
    E1-3.4 Z3 F H H
    E1-3.5 Z3 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-3.6 Z3 CF2H H H
    E1-3.7 Z3 CH2F H H
    E1-3.8 Z3 CF3 H H
    E1-3.9 Z3 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-3.10 Z3 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-3.11 Z3 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-3.12 Z3 OCF3 H H
    E1-3.13 Z3 OCF2H H H
    E1-3.14 Z3 Cl H F
    E1-3.15 Z3 CH3 H F
    E1-3.16 Z3 CH3 F H
    E1-3.17 Z3 Cl F H
    E1-3.18 Z3 F F H
    E1-3.19 Z3 F H F
    E1-3.20 Z3 F H Cl
    E1-3.21 Z3 F H CH3
    E1-3.22 Z3 Cl H CH3
    E1-3.23 Z3 SCH3 H H
    E1-3.24 Z3 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-3.25 Z3 ethynyl H H
    E1-4.1 Z4 H H H
    E1-4.2 Z4 CH3 H H
    E1-4.3 Z4 Cl H H
    E1-4.4 Z4 F H H
    E1-4.5 Z4 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-4.6 Z4 CF2H H H
    E1-4.7 Z4 CH2F H H
    E1-4.8 Z4 CF3 H H
    E1-4.9 Z4 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-4.10 Z4 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-4.11 Z4 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-4.12 Z4 OCF3 H H
    E1-4.13 Z4 OCF2H H H
    E1-4.14 Z4 Cl H F
    E1-4.15 Z4 CH3 H F
    E1-4.16 Z4 CH3 F H
    E1-4.17 Z4 Cl F H
    E1-4.18 Z4 F F H
    E1-4.19 Z4 F H F
    E1-4.20 Z4 F H Cl
    E1-4.21 Z4 F H CH3
    E1-4.22 Z4 Cl H CH3
    E1-4.23 Z4 SCH3 H H
    E1-4.24 Z4 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-4.25 Z4 ethynyl H H
    E1-5.1 Z5 H H H
    E1-5.2 Z5 CH3 H H
    E1-5.3 Z5 Cl H H
    E1-5.4 Z5 F H H
    E1-5.5 Z5 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-5.6 Z5 CF2H H H
    E1-5.7 Z5 CH2F H H
    E1-5.8 Z5 CF3 H H
    E1-5.9 Z5 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-5.10 Z5 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-5.11 Z5 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-5.12 Z5 OCF3 H H
    E1-5.13 Z5 OCF2H H H
    E1-5.14 Z5 Cl H F
    E1-5.15 Z5 CH3 H F
    E1-5.16 Z5 CH3 F H
    E1-5.17 Z5 Cl F H
    E1-5.18 Z5 F F H
    E1-5.19 Z5 F H F
    E1-5.20 Z5 F H Cl
    E1-5.21 Z5 F H CH3
    E1-5.22 Z5 Cl H CH3
    E1-5.23 Z5 SCH3 H H
    E1-5.24 Z5 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-5.25 Z5 ethynyl H H
    E1-6.1 Z6, Ra is H H H H
    E1-6.2 Z6, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-6.3 Z6, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-6.4 Z6, Ra is H F H H
    E1-6.5 Z6, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-6.6 Z6, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-6.7 Z6, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-6.8 Z6, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-6.9 Z6, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-6.10 Z6, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-6.11 Z6, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-6.12 Z6, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-6.13 Z6, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-6.14 Z6, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-6.15 Z6, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-6.16 Z6, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-6.17 Z6, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-6.18 Z6, Ra is H F F H
    E1-6.19 Z6, Ra is H F H F
    E1-6.20 Z6, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-6.21 Z6, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-6.22 Z6, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-6.23 Z6, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-6.24 Z6, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-6.25 Z6, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-7.1 Z7, Ra is H H H H
    E1-7.2 Z7, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-7.3 Z7, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-7.4 Z7, Ra is H F H H
    E1-7.5 Z7, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-7.6 Z7, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-7.7 Z7, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-7.8 Z7, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-7.9 Z7, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-7.10 Z7, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-7.11 Z7, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-7.12 Z7, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-7.13 Z7, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-7.14 Z7, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-7.15 Z7, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-7.16 Z7, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-7.17 Z7, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-7.18 Z7, Ra is H F F H
    E1-7.19 Z7, Ra is H F H F
    E1-7.20 Z7, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-7.21 Z7, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-7.22 Z7, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-7.23 Z7, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-7.24 Z7, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-7.25 Z7, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-8.1 Z8, Ra is H H H H
    E1-8.2 Z8, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-8.3 Z8, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-8.4 Z8, Ra is H F H H
    E1-8.5 Z8, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-8.6 Z8, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-8.7 Z8, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-8.8 Z8, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-8.9 Z8, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-8.10 Z8, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-8.11 Z8, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-8.12 Z8, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-8.13 Z8, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-8.14 Z8, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-8.15 Z8, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-8.16 Z8, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-8.17 Z8, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-8.18 Z8, Ra is H F F H
    E1-8.19 Z8, Ra is H F H F
    E1-8.20 Z8, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-8.21 Z8, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-8.22 Z8, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-8.23 Z8, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-8.24 Z8, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-8.25 Z8, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-9.1 Z9 H H H
    E1-9.2 Z9 CH3 H H
    E1-9.3 Z9 Cl H H
    E1-9.4 Z9 F H H
    E1-9.5 Z9 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-9.6 Z9 CF2H H H
    E1-9.7 Z9 CH2F H H
    E1-9.8 Z9 CF3 H H
    E1-9.9 Z9 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-9.10 Z9 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-9.11 Z9 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-9.12 Z9 OCF3 H H
    E1-9.13 Z9 OCF2H H H
    E1-9.14 Z9 Cl H F
    E1-9.15 Z9 CH3 H F
    E1-9.16 Z9 CH3 F H
    E1-9.17 Z9 Cl F H
    E1-9.18 Z9 F F H
    E1-9.19 Z9 F H F
    E1-9.20 Z9 F H Cl
    E1-9.21 Z9 F H CH3
    E1-9.22 Z9 Cl H CH3
    E1-9.23 Z9 SCH3 H H
    E1-9.24 Z9 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-9.25 Z9 ethynyl H H
    E1-10.1 Z10 H H H
    E1-10.2 Z10 CH3 H H
    E1-10.3 Z10 Cl H H
    E1-10.4 Z10 F H H
    E1-10.5 Z10 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-10.6 Z10 CF2H H H
    E1-10.7 Z10 CH2F H H
    E1-10.8 Z10 CF3 H H
    E1-10.9 Z10 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-10.10 Z10 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-10.11 Z10 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-10.12 Z10 OCF3 H H
    E1-10.13 Z10 OCF2H H H
    E1-10.14 Z10 Cl H F
    E1-10.15 Z10 CH3 H F
    E1-10.16 Z10 CH3 F H
    E1-10.17 Z10 Cl F H
    E1-10.18 Z10 F F H
    E1-10.19 Z10 F H F
    E1-10.20 Z10 F H Cl
    E1-10.21 Z10 F H CH3
    E1-10.22 Z10 Cl H CH3
    E1-10.23 Z10 SCH3 H H
    E1-10.24 Z10 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-10.25 Z10 ethynyl H H
    E1-11.1 Z11, Ra is H H H H
    E1-11.2 Z11, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-11.3 Z11, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-11.4 Z11, Ra is H F H H
    E1-11.5 Z11, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-11.6 Z11, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-11.7 Z11, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-11.8 Z11, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-11.9 Z11, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-11.10 Z11, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-11.11 Z11, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-11.12 Z11, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-11.13 Z11, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-11.14 Z11, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-11.15 Z11, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-11.16 Z11, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-11.17 Z11, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-11.18 Z11, Ra is H F F H
    E1-11.19 Z11, Ra is H F H F
    E1-11.20 Z11, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-11.21 Z11, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-11.22 Z11, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-11.23 Z11, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-11.24 Z11, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-11.25 Z11, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-12.1 Z12 H H H
    E1-12.2 Z12 CH3 H H
    E1-12.3 Z12 Cl H H
    E1-12.4 Z12 F H H
    E1-12.5 Z12 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-12.6 Z12 CF2H H H
    E1-12.7 Z12 CH2F H H
    E1-12.8 Z12 CF3 H H
    E1-12.9 Z12 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-12.10 Z12 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-12.11 Z12 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-12.12 Z12 OCF3 H H
    E1-12.13 Z12 OCF2H H H
    E1-12.14 Z12 Cl H F
    E1-12.15 Z12 CH3 H F
    E1-12.16 Z12 CH3 F H
    E1-12.17 Z12 Cl F H
    E1-12.18 Z12 F F H
    E1-12.19 Z12 F H F
    E1-12.20 Z12 F H Cl
    E1-12.21 Z12 F H CH3
    E1-12.22 Z12 Cl H CH3
    E1-12.23 Z12 SCH3 H H
    E1-12.24 Z12 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-12.25 Z12 ethynyl H H
    E1-13.1 Z13, Ra is H H H H
    E1-13.2 Z13, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-13.3 Z13, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-13.4 Z13, Ra is H F H H
    E1-13.5 Z13, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-13.6 Z13, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-13.7 Z13, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-13.8 Z13, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-13.9 Z13, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-13.10 Z13, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-13.11 Z13, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-13.12 Z13, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-13.13 Z13, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-13.14 Z13, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-13.15 Z13, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-13.16 Z13, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-13.17 Z13, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-13.18 Z13, Ra is H F F H
    E1-13.19 Z13, Ra is H F H F
    E1-13.20 Z13, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-13.21 Z13, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-13.22 Z13, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-13.23 Z13, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-13.24 Z13, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-13.25 Z13, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-14.1 Z14, Ra is H H H H
    E1-14.2 Z14, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-14.3 Z14, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-14.4 Z14, Ra is H F H H
    E1-14.5 Z14, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-14.6 Z14, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-14.7 Z14, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-14.8 Z14, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-14.9 Z14, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-14.10 Z14, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-14.11 Z14, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-14.12 Z14, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-14.13 Z14, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-14.14 Z14, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-14.15 Z14, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-14.16 Z14, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-14.17 Z14, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-14.18 Z14, Ra is H F F H
    E1-14.19 Z14, Ra is H F H F
    E1-14.20 Z14, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-14.21 Z14, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-14.22 Z14, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-14.23 Z14, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-14.24 Z14, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-14.25 Z14, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-15.1 Z15, Ra is H H H H
    E1-15.2 Z15, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-15.3 Z15, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-15.4 Z15, Ra is H F H H
    E1-15.5 Z15, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-15.6 Z15, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-15.7 Z15, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-15.8 Z15, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-15.9 Z15, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-15.10 Z15, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-15.11 Z15, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-15.12 Z15, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-15.13 Z15, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-15.14 Z15, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-15.15 Z15, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-15.16 Z15, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-15.17 Z15, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-15.18 Z15, Ra is H F F H
    E1-15.19 Z15, Ra is H F H F
    E1-15.20 Z15, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-15.21 Z15, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-15.22 Z15, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-15.23 Z15, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-15.24 Z15, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-15.25 Z15, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-16.1 Z16, Ra is H H H H
    E1-16.2 Z16, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-16.3 Z16, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-16.4 Z16, Ra is H F H H
    E1-16.5 Z16, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-16.6 Z16, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-16.7 Z16, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-16.8 Z16, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-16.9 Z16, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-16.10 Z16, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-16.11 Z16, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-16.12 Z16, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-16.13 Z16, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-16.14 Z16, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-16.15 Z16, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-16.16 Z16, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-16.17 Z16, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-16.18 Z16, Ra is H F F H
    E1-16.19 Z16, Ra is H F H F
    E1-16.20 Z16, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-16.21 Z16, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-16.22 Z16, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-16.23 Z16, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-16.24 Z16, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-16.25 Z16, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-17.1 Z17 H H H
    E1-17.2 Z17 CH3 H H
    E1-17.3 Z17 Cl H H
    E1-17.4 Z17 F H H
    E1-17.5 Z17 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-17.6 Z17 CF2H H H
    E1-17.7 Z17 CH2F H H
    E1-17.8 Z17 CF3 H H
    E1-17.9 Z17 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-17.10 Z17 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-17.11 Z17 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-17.12 Z17 OCF3 H H
    E1-17.13 Z17 OCF2H H H
    E1-17.14 Z17 Cl H F
    E1-17.15 Z17 CH3 H F
    E1-17.16 Z17 CH3 F H
    E1-17.17 Z17 Cl F H
    E1-17.18 Z17 F F H
    E1-17.19 Z17 F H F
    E1-17.20 Z17 F H Cl
    E1-17.21 Z17 F H CH3
    E1-17.22 Z17 Cl H CH3
    E1-17.23 Z17 SCH3 H H
    E1-17.24 Z17 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-17.25 Z17 ethynyl H H
    E1-18.1 Z18 H H H
    E1-18.2 Z18 CH3 H H
    E1-18.3 Z18 Cl H H
    E1-18.4 Z18 F H H
    E1-18.5 Z18 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-18.6 Z18 CF2H H H
    E1-18.7 Z18 CH2F H H
    E1-18.8 Z18 CF3 H H
    E1-18.9 Z18 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-18.10 Z18 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-18.11 Z18 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-18.12 Z18 OCF3 H H
    E1-18.13 Z18 OCF2H H H
    E1-18.14 Z18 Cl H F
    E1-18.15 Z18 CH3 H F
    E1-18.16 Z18 CH3 F H
    E1-18.17 Z18 Cl F H
    E1-18.18 Z18 F F H
    E1-18.19 Z18 F H F
    E1-18.20 Z18 F H Cl
    E1-18.21 Z18 F H CH3
    E1-18.22 Z18 Cl H CH3
    E1-18.23 Z18 SCH3 H H
    E1-18.24 Z18 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-18.25 Z18 ethynyl H H
    E1-19.1 Z19 H H H
    E1-19.2 Z19 CH3 H H
    E1-19.3 Z19 Cl H H
    E1-19.4 Z19 F H H
    E1-19.5 Z19 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-19.6 Z19 CF2H H H
    E1-19.7 Z19 CH2F H H
    E1-19.8 Z19 CF3 H H
    E1-19.9 Z19 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-19.10 Z19 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-19.11 Z19 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-19.12 Z19 OCF3 H H
    E1-19.13 Z19 OCF2H H H
    E1-19.14 Z19 Cl H F
    E1-19.15 Z19 CH3 H F
    E1-19.16 Z19 CH3 F H
    E1-19.17 Z19 Cl F H
    E1-19.18 Z19 F F H
    E1-19.19 Z19 F H F
    E1-19.20 Z19 F H Cl
    E1-19.21 Z19 F H CH3
    E1-19.22 Z19 Cl H CH3
    E1-19.23 Z19 SCH3 H H
    E1-19.24 Z19 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-19.25 Z19 ethynyl H H
    E1-19.26 Z19 CH3 H H
    E1-20.1 Z20 H H H
    E1-20.2 Z20 CH3 H H
    E1-20.3 Z20 Cl H H
    E1-20.4 Z20 F H H
    E1-20.5 Z20 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-20.6 Z20 CF2H H H
    E1-20.7 Z20 CH2F H H
    E1-20.8 Z20 CF3 H H
    E1-20.9 Z20 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-20.10 Z20 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-20.11 Z20 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-20.12 Z20 OCF3 H H
    E1-20.13 Z20 OCF2H H H
    E1-20.14 Z20 Cl H F
    E1-20.15 Z20 CH3 H F
    E1-20.16 Z20 CH3 F H
    E1-20.17 Z20 Cl F H
    E1-20.18 Z20 F F H
    E1-20.19 Z20 F H F
    E1-20.20 Z20 F H Cl
    E1-20.21 Z20 F H CH3
    E1-20.22 Z20 Cl H CH3
    E1-20.23 Z20 SCH3 H H
    E1-20.24 Z20 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-20.25 Z20 ethynyl H H
    E1-21.1 Z21 H H H
    E1-21.2 Z21 CH3 H H
    E1-21.3 Z21 Cl H H
    E1-21.4 Z21 F H H
    E1-21.5 Z21 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-21.6 Z21 CF2H H H
    E1-21.7 Z21 CH2F H H
    E1-21.8 Z21 CF3 H H
    E1-21.9 Z21 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-21.10 Z21 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-21.11 Z21 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-21.12 Z21 OCF3 H H
    E1-21.13 Z21 OCF2H H H
    E1-21.14 Z21 Cl H F
    E1-21.15 Z21 CH3 H F
    E1-21.16 Z21 CH3 F H
    E1-21.17 Z21 Cl F H
    E1-21.18 Z21 F F H
    E1-21.19 Z21 F H F
    E1-21.20 Z21 F H Cl
    E1-21.21 Z21 F H CH3
    E1-21.22 Z21 Cl H CH3
    E1-21.23 Z21 SCH3 H H
    E1-21.24 Z21 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-21.25 Z21 ethynyl H H
    E1-21.26
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00015
    CH3 H H
    E1-22.1 Z22 H H H
    E1-22.2 Z22 CH3 H H
    E1-22.3 Z22 Cl H H
    E1-22.4 Z22 F H H
    E1-22.5 Z22 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-22.6 Z22 CF2H H H
    E1-22.7 Z22 CH2F H H
    E1-22.8 Z22 CF3 H H
    E1-22.9 Z22 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-22.10 Z22 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-22.11 Z22 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-22.12 Z22 OCF3 H H
    E1-22.13 Z22 OCF2H H H
    E1-22.14 Z22 Cl H F
    E1-22.15 Z22 CH3 H F
    E1-22.16 Z22 CH3 F H
    E1-22.17 Z22 Cl F H
    E1-22.18 Z22 F F H
    E1-22.19 Z22 F H F
    E1-22.20 Z22 F H Cl
    E1-22.21 Z22 F H CH3
    E1-22.22 Z22 Cl H CH3
    E1-22.23 Z22 SCH3 H H
    E1-22.24 Z22 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-22.25 Z22 ethynyl H H
    E1-23.1 Z23 H H H
    E1-23.2 Z23 CH3 H H
    E1-23.3 Z23 Cl H H
    E1-23.4 Z23 F H H
    E1-23.5 Z23 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-23.6 Z23 CF2H H H
    E1-23.7 Z23 CH2F H H
    E1-23.8 Z23 CF3 H H
    E1-23.9 Z23 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-23.10 Z23 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-23.11 Z23 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-23.12 Z23 OCF3 H H
    E1-23.13 Z23 OCF2H H H
    E1-23.14 Z23 Cl H F
    E1-23.15 Z23 CH3 H F
    E1-23.16 Z23 CH3 F H
    E1-23.17 Z23 Cl F H
    E1-23.18 Z23 F F H
    E1-23.19 Z23 F H F
    E1-23.20 Z23 F H Cl
    E1-23.21 Z23 F H CH3
    E1-23.22 Z23 Cl H CH3
    E1-23.23 Z23 SCH3 H H
    E1-23.24 Z23 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-23.25 Z23 ethynyl H H
    E1-24.1 Z24 H H H
    E1-24.2 Z24 CH3 H H
    E1-24.3 Z24 Cl H H
    E1-24.4 Z24 F H H
    E1-24.5 Z24 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-24.6 Z24 CF2H H H
    E1-24.7 Z24 CH2F H H
    E1-24.8 Z24 CF3 H H
    E1-24.9 Z24 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-24.10 Z24 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-24.11 Z24 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-24.12 Z24 OCF3 H H
    E1-24.13 Z24 OCF2H H H
    E1-24.14 Z24 Cl H F
    E1-24.15 Z24 CH3 H F
    E1-24.16 Z24 CH3 F H
    E1-24.17 Z24 Cl F H
    E1-24.18 Z24 F F H
    E1-24.19 Z24 F H F
    E1-24.20 Z24 F H Cl
    E1-24.21 Z24 F H CH3
    E1-24.22 Z24 Cl H CH3
    E1-24.23 Z24 SCH3 H H
    E1-24.24 Z24 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-24.25 Z24 ethynyl H H
    E1-25.1 Z25, Ra is H H H H
    E1-25.2 Z25, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-25.3 Z25, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-25.4 Z25, Ra is H F H H
    E1-25.5 Z25, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-25.6 Z25, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-25.7 Z25, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-25.8 Z25, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-25.9 Z25, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-25.10 Z25, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-25.11 Z25, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-25.12 Z25, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-25.13 Z25, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-25.14 Z25, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-25.15 Z25, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-25.16 Z25, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-25.17 Z25, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-25.18 Z25, Ra is H F F H
    E1-25.19 Z25, Ra is H F H F
    E1-25.20 Z25, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-25.21 Z25, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-25.22 Z25, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-25.23 Z25, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-25.24 Z25, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-25.25 Z25, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-26.1 Z26, Ra is H H H H
    E1-26.2 Z26, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-26.3 Z26, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-26.4 Z26, Ra is H F H H
    E1-26.5 Z26, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-26.6 Z26, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-26.7 Z26, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-26.8 Z26, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-26.9 Z26, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-26.10 Z26, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-26.11 Z26, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-26.12 Z26, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-26.13 Z26, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-26.14 Z26, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-26.15 Z26, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-26.16 Z26, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-26.17 Z26, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-26.18 Z26, Ra is H F F H
    E1-26.19 Z26, Ra is H F H F
    E1-26.20 Z26, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-26.21 Z26, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-26.22 Z26, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-26.23 Z26, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-26.24 Z26, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-26.25 Z26, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-27.1 Z27 H H H
    E1-27.2 Z27 CH3 H H
    E1-27.3 Z27 Cl H H
    E1-27.4 Z27 F H H
    E1-27.5 Z27 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-27.6 Z27 CF2H H H
    E1-27.7 Z27 CH2F H H
    E1-27.8 Z27 CF3 H H
    E1-27.9 Z27 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-27.10 Z27 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-27.11 Z27 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-27.12 Z27 OCF3 H H
    E1-27.13 Z27 OCF2H H H
    E1-27.14 Z27 Cl H F
    E1-27.15 Z27 CH3 H F
    E1-27.16 Z27 CH3 F H
    E1-27.17 Z27 Cl F H
    E1-27.18 Z27 F F H
    E1-27.19 Z27 F H F
    E1-27.20 Z27 F H Cl
    E1-27.21 Z27 F H CH3
    E1-27.22 Z27 Cl H CH3
    E1-27.23 Z27 SCH3 H H
    E1-27.24 Z27 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-27.25 Z27 ethynyl H H
    E1-28.1 Z28 H H H
    E1-28.2 Z28 CH3 H H
    E1-28.3 Z28 Cl H H
    E1-28.4 Z28 F H H
    E1-28.5 Z28 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-28.6 Z28 CF2H H H
    E1-28.7 Z28 CH2F H H
    E1-28.8 Z28 CF3 H H
    E1-28.9 Z28 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-28.10 Z28 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-28.11 Z28 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-28.12 Z28 OCF3 H H
    E1-28.13 Z28 OCF2H H H
    E1-28.14 Z28 Cl H F
    E1-28.15 Z28 CH3 H F
    E1-28.16 Z28 CH3 F H
    E1-28.17 Z28 Cl F H
    E1-28.18 Z28 F F H
    E1-28.19 Z28 F H F
    E1-28.20 Z28 F H Cl
    E1-28.21 Z28 F H CH3
    E1-28.22 Z28 Cl H CH3
    E1-28.23 Z28 SCH3 H H
    E1-28.24 Z28 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-28.25 Z28 ethynyl H H
    E1-29.1 Z29 H H H
    E1-29.2 Z29 CH3 H H
    E1-29.3 Z29 Cl H H
    E1-29.4 Z29 F H H
    E1-29.5 Z29 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-29.6 Z29 CF2H H H
    E1-29.7 Z29 CH2F H H
    E1-29.8 Z29 CF3 H H
    E1-29.9 Z29 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-29.10 Z29 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-29.11 Z29 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-29.12 Z29 OCF3 H H
    E1-29.13 Z29 OCF2H H H
    E1-29.14 Z29 Cl H F
    E1-29.15 Z29 CH3 H F
    E1-29.16 Z29 CH3 F H
    E1-29.17 Z29 Cl F H
    E1-29.18 Z29 F F H
    E1-29.19 Z29 F H F
    E1-29.20 Z29 F H Cl
    E1-29.21 Z29 F H CH3
    E1-29.22 Z29 Cl H CH3
    E1-29.23 Z29 SCH3 H H
    E1-29.24 Z29 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-29.25 Z29 ethynyl H H
    E1-30.1 Z30 H H H
    E1-30.2 Z30 CH3 H H
    E1-30.3 Z30 Cl H H
    E1-30.4 Z30 F H H
    E1-30.5 Z30 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-30.6 Z30 CF2H H H
    E1-30.7 Z30 CH2F H H
    E1-30.8 Z30 CF3 H H
    E1-30.9 Z30 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-30.10 Z30 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-30.11 Z30 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-30.12 Z30 OCF3 H H
    E1-30.13 Z30 OCF2H H H
    E1-30.14 Z30 Cl H F
    E1-30.15 Z30 CH3 H F
    E1-30.16 Z30 CH3 F H
    E1-30.17 Z30 Cl F H
    E1-30.18 Z30 F F H
    E1-30.19 Z30 F H F
    E1-30.20 Z30 F H Cl
    E1-30.21 Z30 F H CH3
    E1-30.22 Z30 Cl H CH3
    E1-30.23 Z30 SCH3 H H
    E1-30.24 Z30 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-30.25 Z30 ethynyl H H
    E1-31.1 Z31 H H H
    E1-31.2 Z31 CH3 H H
    E1-31.3 Z31 Cl H H
    E1-31.4 Z31 F H H
    E1-31.5 Z31 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-31.6 Z31 CF2H H H
    E1-31.7 Z31 CH2F H H
    E1-31.8 Z31 CF3 H H
    E1-31.9 Z31 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-31.10 Z31 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-31.11 Z31 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-31.12 Z31 OCF3 H H
    E1-31.13 Z31 OCF2H H H
    E1-31.14 Z31 Cl H F
    E1-31.15 Z31 CH3 H F
    E1-31.16 Z31 CH3 F H
    E1-31.17 Z31 Cl F H
    E1-31.18 Z31 F F H
    E1-31.19 Z31 F H F
    E1-31.20 Z31 F H Cl
    E1-31.21 Z31 F H CH3
    E1-31.22 Z31 Cl H CH3
    E1-31.23 Z31 SCH3 H H
    E1-31.24 Z31 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-31.25 Z31 ethynyl H H
    E1-32.1 Z32 H H H
    E1-32.2 Z32 CH3 H H
    E1-32.3 Z32 Cl H H
    E1-32.4 Z32 F H H
    E1-32.5 Z32 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-32.6 Z32 CF2H H H
    E1-32.7 Z32 CH2F H H
    E1-32.8 Z32 CF3 H H
    E1-32.9 Z32 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-32.10 Z32 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-32.11 Z32 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-32.12 Z32 OCF3 H H
    E1-32.13 Z32 OCF2H H H
    E1-32.14 Z32 Cl H F
    E1-32.15 Z32 CH3 H F
    E1-32.16 Z32 CH3 F H
    E1-32.17 Z32 Cl F H
    E1-32.18 Z32 F F H
    E1-32.19 Z32 F H F
    E1-32.20 Z32 F H Cl
    E1-32.21 Z32 F H CH3
    E1-32.22 Z32 Cl H CH3
    E1-32.23 Z32 SCH3 H H
    E1-32.24 Z32 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-32.25 Z32 ethynyl H H
    E1-33.1 Z33 H H H
    E1-33.2 Z33 CH3 H H
    E1-33.3 Z33 Cl H H
    E1-33.4 Z33 F H H
    E1-33.5 Z33 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-33.6 Z33 CF2H H H
    E1-33.7 Z33 CH2F H H
    E1-33.8 Z33 CF3 H H
    E1-33.9 Z33 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-33.10 Z33 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-33.11 Z33 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-33.12 Z33 OCF3 H H
    E1-33.13 Z33 OCF2H H H
    E1-33.14 Z33 Cl H F
    E1-33.15 Z33 CH3 H F
    E1-33.16 Z33 CH3 F H
    E1-33.17 Z33 Cl F H
    E1-33.18 Z33 F F H
    E1-33.19 Z33 F H F
    E1-33.20 Z33 F H Cl
    E1-33.21 Z33 F H CH3
    E1-33.22 Z33 Cl H CH3
    E1-33.23 Z33 SCH3 H H
    E1-33.24 Z33 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-33.25 Z33 ethynyl H H
    E1-34.1 Z34 H H H
    E1-34.2 Z34 CH3 H H
    E1-34.3 Z34 Cl H H
    E1-34.4 Z34 F H H
    E1-34.5 Z34 CH2CH3 H H
    E1-34.6 Z34 CF2H H H
    E1-34.7 Z34 CH2F H H
    E1-34.8 Z34 CF3 H H
    E1-34.9 Z34 CF2CH3 H H
    E1-34.10 Z34 CH2CF3 H H
    E1-34.11 Z34 cyclopropyl H H
    E1-34.12 Z34 OCF3 H H
    E1-34.13 Z34 OCF2H H H
    E1-34.14 Z34 Cl H F
    E1-34.15 Z34 CH3 H F
    E1-34.16 Z34 CH3 F H
    E1-34.17 Z34 Cl F H
    E1-34.18 Z34 F F H
    E1-34.19 Z34 F H F
    E1-34.20 Z34 F H Cl
    E1-34.21 Z34 F H CH3
    E1-34.22 Z34 Cl H CH3
    E1-34.23 Z34 SCH3 H H
    E1-34.24 Z34 SO2CH3 H H
    E1-34.25 Z34 ethynyl H H
    E1-35.1 Z35, Ra is H H H H
    E1-35.2 Z35, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-35.3 Z35, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-35.4 Z35, Ra is H F H H
    E1-35.5 Z35, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-35.6 Z35, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-35.7 Z35, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-35.8 Z35, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-35.9 Z35, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-35.10 Z35, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-35.11 Z35, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-35.12 Z35, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-35.13 Z35, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-35.14 Z35, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-35.15 Z35, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-35.16 Z35, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-35.17 Z35, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-35.18 Z35, Ra is H F F H
    E1-35.19 Z35, Ra is H F H F
    E1-35.20 Z35, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-35.21 Z35, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-35.22 Z35, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-35.23 Z35, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-35.24 Z35, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-35.25 Z35, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E1-36.1 Z36, Ra is H H H H
    E1-36.2 Z36, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E1-36.3 Z36, Ra is H Cl H H
    E1-36.4 Z36, Ra is H F H H
    E1-36.5 Z36, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E1-36.6 Z36, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E1-36.7 Z36, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E1-36.8 Z36, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E1-36.9 Z36, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E1-36.10 Z36, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E1-36.11 Z36, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E1-36.12 Z36, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E1-36.13 Z36, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E1-36.14 Z36, Ra is H Cl H F
    E1-36.15 Z36, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E1-36.16 Z36, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E1-36.17 Z36, Ra is H Cl F H
    E1-36.18 Z36, Ra is H F F H
    E1-36.19 Z36, Ra is H F H F
    E1-36.20 Z36, Ra is H F H Cl
    E1-36.21 Z36, Ra is H F H CH3
    E1-36.22 Z36, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E1-36.23 Z36, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E1-36.24 Z36, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E1-36.25 Z36, Ra is H ethynyl H H
  • TABLE 1.E2
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00016
    compound Z R5 R6 R7
    E2-1.1 Z1 H H H
    E2-1.2 Z1 CH3 H H
    E2-1.3 Z1 Cl H H
    E2-1.4 Z1 F H H
    E2-1.5 Z1 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-1.6 Z1 CF2H H H
    E2-1.7 Z1 CH2F H H
    E2-1.8 Z1 CF3 H H
    E2-1.9 Z1 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-1.10 Z1 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-1.11 Z1 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-1.12 Z1 OCF3 H H
    E2-1.13 Z1 OCF2H H H
    E2-1.14 Z1 Cl H F
    E2-1.15 Z1 CH3 H F
    E2-1.16 Z1 CH3 F H
    E2-1.17 Z1 Cl F H
    E2-1.18 Z1 F F H
    E2-1.19 Z1 F H F
    E2-1.20 Z1 F H Cl
    E2-1.21 Z1 F H CH3
    E2-1.22 Z1 Cl H CH3
    E2-1.23 Z1 SCH3 H H
    E2-1.24 Z1 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-1.25 Z1 ethynyl H H
    E2-2.1 Z2 H H H
    E2-2.2 Z2 CH3 H H
    E2-2.3 Z2 Cl H H
    E2-2.4 Z2 F H H
    E2-2.5 Z2 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-2.6 Z2 CF2H H H
    E2-2.7 Z2 CH2F H H
    E2-2.8 Z2 CF3 H H
    E2-2.9 Z2 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-2.10 Z2 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-2.11 Z2 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-2.12 Z2 OCF3 H H
    E2-2.13 Z2 OCF2H H H
    E2-2.14 Z2 Cl H F
    E2-2.15 Z2 CH3 H F
    E2-2.16 Z2 CH3 F H
    E2-2.17 Z2 Cl F H
    E2-2.18 Z2 F F H
    E2-2.19 Z2 F H F
    E2-2.20 Z2 F H Cl
    E2-2.21 Z2 F H CH3
    E2-2.22 Z2 Cl H CH3
    E2-2.23 Z2 SCH3 H H
    E2-2.24 Z2 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-2.25 Z2 ethynyl H H
    E2-3.1 Z3 H H H
    E2-3.2 Z3 CH3 H H
    E2-3.3 Z3 Cl H H
    E2-3.4 Z3 F H H
    E2-3.5 Z3 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-3.6 Z3 CF2H H H
    E2-3.7 Z3 CH2F H H
    E2-3.8 Z3 CF3 H H
    E2-3.9 Z3 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-3.10 Z3 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-3.11 Z3 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-3.12 Z3 OCF3 H H
    E2-3.13 Z3 OCF2H H H
    E2-3.14 Z3 Cl H F
    E2-3.15 Z3 CH3 H F
    E2-3.16 Z3 CH3 F H
    E2-3.17 Z3 Cl F H
    E2-3.18 Z3 F F H
    E2-3.19 Z3 F H F
    E2-3.20 Z3 F H Cl
    E2-3.21 Z3 F H CH3
    E2-3.22 Z3 Cl H CH3
    E2-3.23 Z3 SCH3 H H
    E2-3.24 Z3 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-3.25 Z3 ethynyl H H
    E2-4.1 Z4 H H H
    E2-4.2 Z4 CH3 H H
    E2-4.3 Z4 Cl H H
    E2-4.4 Z4 F H H
    E2-4.5 Z4 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-4.6 Z4 CF2H H H
    E2-4.7 Z4 CH2F H H
    E2-4.8 Z4 CF3 H H
    E2-4.9 Z4 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-4.10 Z4 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-4.11 Z4 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-4.12 Z4 OCF3 H H
    E2-4.13 Z4 OCF2H H H
    E2-4.14 Z4 Cl H F
    E2-4.15 Z4 CH3 H F
    E2-4.16 Z4 CH3 F H
    E2-4.17 Z4 Cl F H
    E2-4.18 Z4 F F H
    E2-4.19 Z4 F H F
    E2-4.20 Z4 F H Cl
    E2-4.21 Z4 F H CH3
    E2-4.22 Z4 Cl H CH3
    E2-4.23 Z4 SCH3 H H
    E2-4.24 Z4 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-4.25 Z4 ethynyl H H
    E2-5.1 Z5 H H H
    E2-5.2 Z5 CH3 H H
    E2-5.3 Z5 Cl H H
    E2-5.4 Z5 F H H
    E2-5.5 Z5 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-5.6 Z5 CF2H H H
    E2-5.7 Z5 CH2F H H
    E2-5.8 Z5 CF3 H H
    E2-5.9 Z5 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-5.10 Z5 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-5.11 Z5 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-5.12 Z5 OCF3 H H
    E2-5.13 Z5 OCF2H H H
    E2-5.14 Z5 Cl H F
    E2-5.15 Z5 CH3 H F
    E2-5.16 Z5 CH3 F H
    E2-5.17 Z5 Cl F H
    E2-5.18 Z5 F F H
    E2-5.19 Z5 F H F
    E2-5.20 Z5 F H Cl
    E2-5.21 Z5 F H CH3
    E2-5.22 Z5 Cl H CH3
    E2-5.23 Z5 SCH3 H H
    E2-5.24 Z5 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-5.25 Z5 ethynyl H H
    E2-6.1 Z6, Ra is H H H H
    E2-6.2 Z6, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-6.3 Z6, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-6.4 Z6, Ra is H F H H
    E2-6.5 Z6, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-6.6 Z6, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-6.7 Z6, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-6.8 Z6, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-6.9 Z6, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-6.10 Z6, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-6.11 Z6, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-6.12 Z6, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-6.13 Z6, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-6.14 Z6, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-6.15 Z6, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-6.16 Z6, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-6.17 Z6, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-6.18 Z6, Ra is H F F H
    E2-6.19 Z6, Ra is H F H F
    E2-6.20 Z6, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-6.21 Z6, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-6.22 Z6, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-6.23 Z6, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-6.24 Z6, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-6.25 Z6, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-7.1 Z7, Ra is H H H H
    E2-7.2 Z7, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-7.3 Z7, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-7.4 Z7, Ra is H F H H
    E2-7.5 Z7, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-7.6 Z7, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-7.7 Z7, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-7.8 Z7, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-7.9 Z7, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-7.10 Z7, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-7.11 Z7, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-7.12 Z7, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-7.13 Z7, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-7.14 Z7, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-7.15 Z7, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-7.16 Z7, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-7.17 Z7, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-7.18 Z7, Ra is H F F H
    E2-7.19 Z7, Ra is H F H F
    E2-7.20 Z7, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-7.21 Z7, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-7.22 Z7, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-7.23 Z7, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-7.24 Z7, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-7.25 Z7, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-8.1 Z8, Ra is H H H H
    E2-8.2 Z8, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-8.3 Z8, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-8.4 Z8, Ra is H F H H
    E2-8.5 Z8, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-8.6 Z8, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-8.7 Z8, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-8.8 Z8, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-8.9 Z8, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-8.10 Z8, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-8.11 Z8, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-8.12 Z8, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-8.13 Z8, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-8.14 Z8, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-8.15 Z8, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-8.16 Z8, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-8.17 Z8, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-8.18 Z8, Ra is H F F H
    E2-8.19 Z8, Ra is H F H F
    E2-8.20 Z8, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-8.21 Z8, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-8.22 Z8, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-8.23 Z8, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-8.24 Z8, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-8.25 Z8, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-9.1 Z9 H H H
    E2-9.2 Z9 CH3 H H
    E2-9.3 Z9 Cl H H
    E2-9.4 Z9 F H H
    E2-9.5 Z9 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-9.6 Z9 CF2H H H
    E2-9.7 Z9 CH2F H H
    E2-9.8 Z9 CF3 H H
    E2-9.9 Z9 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-9.10 Z9 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-9.11 Z9 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-9.12 Z9 OCF3 H H
    E2-9.13 Z9 OCF2H H H
    E2-9.14 Z9 Cl H F
    E2-9.15 Z9 CH3 H F
    E2-9.16 Z9 CH3 F H
    E2-9.17 Z9 Cl F H
    E2-9.18 Z9 F F H
    E2-9.19 Z9 F H F
    E2-9.20 Z9 F H Cl
    E2-9.21 Z9 F H CH3
    E2-9.22 Z9 Cl H CH3
    E2-9.23 Z9 SCH3 H H
    E2-9.24 Z9 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-9.25 Z9 ethynyl H H
    E2-10.1 Z10 H H H
    E2-10.2 Z10 CH3 H H
    E2-10.3 Z10 Cl H H
    E2-10.4 Z10 F H H
    E2-10.5 Z10 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-10.6 Z10 CF2H H H
    E2-10.7 Z10 CH2F H H
    E2-10.8 Z10 CF3 H H
    E2-10.9 Z10 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-10.10 Z10 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-10.11 Z10 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-10.12 Z10 OCF3 H H
    E2-10.13 Z10 OCF2H H H
    E2-10.14 Z10 Cl H F
    E2-10.15 Z10 CH3 H F
    E2-10.16 Z10 CH3 F H
    E2-10.17 Z10 Cl F H
    E2-10.18 Z10 F F H
    E2-10.19 Z10 F H F
    E2-10.20 Z10 F H Cl
    E2-10.21 Z10 F H CH3
    E2-10.22 Z10 Cl H CH3
    E2-10.23 Z10 SCH3 H H
    E2-10.24 Z10 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-10.25 Z10 ethynyl H H
    E2-11.1 Z11, Ra is H H H H
    E2-11.2 Z11, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-11.3 Z11, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-11.4 Z11, Ra is H F H H
    E2-11.5 Z11, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-11.6 Z11, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-11.7 Z11, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-11.8 Z11, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-11.9 Z11, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-11.10 Z11, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-11.11 Z11, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-11.12 Z11, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-11.13 Z11, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-11.14 Z11, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-11.15 Z11, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-11.16 Z11, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-11.17 Z11, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-11.18 Z11, Ra is H F F H
    E2-11.19 Z11, Ra is H F H F
    E2-11.20 Z11, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-11.21 Z11, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-11.22 Z11, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-11.23 Z11, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-11.24 Z11, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-11.25 Z11, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-12.1 Z12 H H H
    E2-12.2 Z12 CH3 H H
    E2-12.3 Z12 Cl H H
    E2-12.4 Z12 F H H
    E2-12.5 Z12 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-12.6 Z12 CF2H H H
    E2-12.7 Z12 CH2F H H
    E2-12.8 Z12 CF3 H H
    E2-12.9 Z12 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-12.10 Z12 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-12.11 Z12 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-12.12 Z12 OCF3 H H
    E2-12.13 Z12 OCF2H H H
    E2-12.14 Z12 Cl H F
    E2-12.15 Z12 CH3 H F
    E2-12.16 Z12 CH3 F H
    E2-12.17 Z12 Cl F H
    E2-12.18 Z12 F F H
    E2-12.19 Z12 F H F
    E2-12.20 Z12 F H Cl
    E2-12.21 Z12 F H CH3
    E2-12.22 Z12 Cl H CH3
    E2-12.23 Z12 SCH3 H H
    E2-12.24 Z12 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-12.25 Z12 ethynyl H H
    E2-13.1 Z13, Ra is H H H H
    E2-13.2 Z13, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-13.3 Z13, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-13.4 Z13, Ra is H F H H
    E2-13.5 Z13, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-13.6 Z13, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-13.7 Z13, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-13.8 Z13, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-13.9 Z13, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-13.10 Z13, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-13.11 Z13, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-13.12 Z13, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-13.13 Z13, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-13.14 Z13, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-13.15 Z13, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-13.16 Z13, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-13.17 Z13, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-13.18 Z13, Ra is H F F H
    E2-13.19 Z13, Ra is H F H F
    E2-13.20 Z13, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-13.21 Z13, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-13.22 Z13, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-13.23 Z13, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-13.24 Z13, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-13.25 Z13, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-14.1 Z14, Ra is H H H H
    E2-14.2 Z14, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-14.3 Z14, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-14.4 Z14, Ra is H F H H
    E2-14.5 Z14, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-14.6 Z14, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-14.7 Z14, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-14.8 Z14, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-14.9 Z14, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-14.10 Z14, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-14.11 Z14, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-14.12 Z14, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-14.13 Z14, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-14.14 Z14, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-14.15 Z14, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-14.16 Z14, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-14.17 Z14, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-14.18 Z14, Ra is H F F H
    E2-14.19 Z14, Ra is H F H F
    E2-14.20 Z14, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-14.21 Z14, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-14.22 Z14, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-14.23 Z14, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-14.24 Z14, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-14.25 Z14, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-15.1 Z15, Ra is H H H H
    E2-15.2 Z15, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-15.3 Z15, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-15.4 Z15, Ra is H F H H
    E2-15.5 Z15, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-15.6 Z15, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-15.7 Z15, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-15.8 Z15, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-15.9 Z15, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-15.10 Z15, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-15.11 Z15, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-15.12 Z15, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-15.13 Z15, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-15.14 Z15, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-15.15 Z15, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-15.16 Z15, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-15.17 Z15, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-15.18 Z15, Ra is H F F H
    E2-15.19 Z15, Ra is H F H F
    E2-15.20 Z15, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-15.21 Z15, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-15.22 Z15, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-15.23 Z15, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-15.24 Z15, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-15.25 Z15, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-16.1 Z16, Ra is H H H H
    E2-16.2 Z16, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-16.3 Z16, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-16.4 Z16, Ra is H F H H
    E2-16.5 Z16, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-16.6 Z16, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-16.7 Z16, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-16.8 Z16, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-16.9 Z16, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-16.10 Z16, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-16.11 Z16, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-16.12 Z16, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-16.13 Z16, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-16.14 Z16, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-16.15 Z16, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-16.16 Z16, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-16.17 Z16, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-16.18 Z16, Ra is H F F H
    E2-16.19 Z16, Ra is H F H F
    E2-16.20 Z16, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-16.21 Z16, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-16.22 Z16, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-16.23 Z16, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-16.24 Z16, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-16.25 Z16, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-17.1 Z17 H H H
    E2-17.2 Z17 CH3 H H
    E2-17.3 Z17 Cl H H
    E2-17.4 Z17 F H H
    E2-17.5 Z17 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-17.6 Z17 CF2H H H
    E2-17.7 Z17 CH2F H H
    E2-17.8 Z17 CF3 H H
    E2-17.9 Z17 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-17.10 Z17 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-17.11 Z17 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-17.12 Z17 OCF3 H H
    E2-17.13 Z17 OCF2H H H
    E2-17.14 Z17 Cl H F
    E2-17.15 Z17 CH3 H F
    E2-17.16 Z17 CH3 F H
    E2-17.17 Z17 Cl F H
    E2-17.18 Z17 F F H
    E2-17.19 Z17 F H F
    E2-17.20 Z17 F H Cl
    E2-17.21 Z17 F H CH3
    E2-17.22 Z17 Cl H CH3
    E2-17.23 Z17 SCH3 H H
    E2-17.24 Z17 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-17.25 Z17 ethynyl H H
    E2-18.1 Z18 H H H
    E2-18.2 Z18 CH3 H H
    E2-18.3 Z18 Cl H H
    E2-18.4 Z18 F H H
    E2-18.5 Z18 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-18.6 Z18 CF2H H H
    E2-18.7 Z18 CH2F H H
    E2-18.8 Z18 CF3 H H
    E2-18.9 Z18 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-18.10 Z18 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-18.11 Z18 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-18.12 Z18 OCF3 H H
    E2-18.13 Z18 OCF2H H H
    E2-18.14 Z18 Cl H F
    E2-18.15 Z18 CH3 H F
    E2-18.16 Z18 CH3 F H
    E2-18.17 Z18 Cl F H
    E2-18.18 Z18 F F H
    E2-18.19 Z18 F H F
    E2-18.20 Z18 F H Cl
    E2-18.21 Z18 F H CH3
    E2-18.22 Z18 Cl H CH3
    E2-18.23 Z18 SCH3 H H
    E2-18.24 Z18 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-18.25 Z18 ethynyl H H
    E2-19.1 Z19 H H H
    E2-19.2 Z19 CH3 H H
    E2-19.3 Z19 Cl H H
    E2-19.4 Z19 F H H
    E2-19.5 Z19 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-19.6 Z19 CF2H H H
    E2-19.7 Z19 CH2F H H
    E2-19.8 Z19 CF3 H H
    E2-19.9 Z19 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-19.10 Z19 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-19.11 Z19 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-19.12 Z19 OCF3 H H
    E2-19.13 Z19 OCF2H H H
    E2-19.14 Z19 Cl H F
    E2-19.15 Z19 CH3 H F
    E2-19.16 Z19 CH3 F H
    E2-19.17 Z19 Cl F H
    E2-19.18 Z19 F F H
    E2-19.19 Z19 F H F
    E2-19.20 Z19 F H Cl
    E2-19.21 Z19 F H CH3
    E2-19.22 Z19 Cl H CH3
    E2-19.23 Z19 SCH3 H H
    E2-19.24 Z19 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-19.25 Z19 ethynyl H H
    E2-19.26 Z19 CH3 H H
    E2-20.1 Z20 H H H
    E2-20.2 Z20 CH3 H H
    E2-20.3 Z20 Cl H H
    E2-20.4 Z20 F H H
    E2-20.5 Z20 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-20.6 Z20 CF2H H H
    E2-20.7 Z20 CH2F H H
    E2-20.8 Z20 CF3 H H
    E2-20.9 Z20 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-20.10 Z20 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-20.11 Z20 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-20.12 Z20 OCF3 H H
    E2-20.13 Z20 OCF2H H H
    E2-20.14 Z20 Cl H F
    E2-20.15 Z20 CH3 H F
    E2-20.16 Z20 CH3 F H
    E2-20.17 Z20 Cl F H
    E2-20.18 Z20 F F H
    E2-20.19 Z20 F H F
    E2-20.20 Z20 F H Cl
    E2-20.21 Z20 F H CH3
    E2-20.22 Z20 Cl H CH3
    E2-20.23 Z20 SCH3 H H
    E2-20.24 Z20 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-20.25 Z20 ethynyl H H
    E2-21.1 Z21 H H H
    E2-21.2 Z21 CH3 H H
    E2-21.3 Z21 Cl H H
    E2-21.4 Z21 F H H
    E2-21.5 Z21 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-21.6 Z21 CF2H H H
    E2-21.7 Z21 CH2F H H
    E2-21.8 Z21 CF3 H H
    E2-21.9 Z21 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-21.10 Z21 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-21.11 Z21 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-21.12 Z21 OCF3 H H
    E2-21.13 Z21 OCF2H H H
    E2-21.14 Z21 Cl H F
    E2-21.15 Z21 CH3 H F
    E2-21.16 Z21 CH3 F H
    E2-21.17 Z21 Cl F H
    E2-21.18 Z21 F F H
    E2-21.19 Z21 F H F
    E2-21.20 Z21 F H Cl
    E2-21.21 Z21 F H CH3
    E2-21.22 Z21 Cl H CH3
    E2-21.23 Z21 SCH3 H H
    E2-21.24 Z21 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-21.25 Z21 ethynyl H H
    E2-21.26
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00017
    CH3 H H
    E2-22.1 Z22 H H H
    E2-22.2 Z22 CH3 H H
    E2-22.3 Z22 Cl H H
    E2-22.4 Z22 F H H
    E2-22.5 Z22 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-22.6 Z22 CF2H H H
    E2-22.7 Z22 CH2F H H
    E2-22.8 Z22 CF3 H H
    E2-22.9 Z22 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-22.10 Z22 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-22.11 Z22 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-22.12 Z22 OCF3 H H
    E2-22.13 Z22 OCF2H H H
    E2-22.14 Z22 Cl H F
    E2-22.15 Z22 CH3 H F
    E2-22.16 Z22 CH3 F H
    E2-22.17 Z22 Cl F H
    E2-22.18 Z22 F F H
    E2-22.19 Z22 F H F
    E2-22.20 Z22 F H Cl
    E2-22.21 Z22 F H CH3
    E2-22.22 Z22 Cl H CH3
    E2-22.23 Z22 SCH3 H H
    E2-22.24 Z22 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-22.25 Z22 ethynyl H H
    E2-23.1 Z23 H H H
    E2-23.2 Z23 CH3 H H
    E2-23.3 Z23 Cl H H
    E2-23.4 Z23 F H H
    E2-23.5 Z23 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-23.6 Z23 CF2H H H
    E2-23.7 Z23 CH2F H H
    E2-23.8 Z23 CF3 H H
    E2-23.9 Z23 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-23.10 Z23 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-23.11 Z23 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-23.12 Z23 OCF3 H H
    E2-23.13 Z23 OCF2H H H
    E2-23.14 Z23 Cl H F
    E2-23.15 Z23 CH3 H F
    E2-23.16 Z23 CH3 F H
    E2-23.17 Z23 Cl F H
    E2-23.18 Z23 F F H
    E2-23.19 Z23 F H F
    E2-23.20 Z23 F H Cl
    E2-23.21 Z23 F H CH3
    E2-23.22 Z23 Cl H CH3
    E2-23.23 Z23 SCH3 H H
    E2-23.24 Z23 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-23.25 Z23 ethynyl H H
    E2-24.1 Z24 H H H
    E2-24.2 Z24 CH3 H H
    E2-24.3 Z24 Cl H H
    E2-24.4 Z24 F H H
    E2-24.5 Z24 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-24.6 Z24 CF2H H H
    E2-24.7 Z24 CH2F H H
    E2-24.8 Z24 CF3 H H
    E2-24.9 Z24 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-24.10 Z24 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-24.11 Z24 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-24.12 Z24 OCF3 H H
    E2-24.13 Z24 OCF2H H H
    E2-24.14 Z24 Cl H F
    E2-24.15 Z24 CH3 H F
    E2-24.16 Z24 CH3 F H
    E2-24.17 Z24 Cl F H
    E2-24.18 Z24 F F H
    E2-24.19 Z24 F H F
    E2-24.20 Z24 F H Cl
    E2-24.21 Z24 F H CH3
    E2-24.22 Z24 Cl H CH3
    E2-24.23 Z24 SCH3 H H
    E2-24.24 Z24 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-24.25 Z24 ethynyl H H
    E2-25.1 Z25, Ra is H H H H
    E2-25.2 Z25, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-25.3 Z25, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-25.4 Z25, Ra is H F H H
    E2-25.5 Z25, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-25.6 Z25, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-25.7 Z25, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-25.8 Z25, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-25.9 Z25, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-25.10 Z25, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-25.11 Z25, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-25.12 Z25, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-25.13 Z25, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-25.14 Z25, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-25.15 Z25, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-25.16 Z25, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-25.17 Z25, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-25.18 Z25, Ra is H F F H
    E2-25.19 Z25, Ra is H F H F
    E2-25.20 Z25, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-25.21 Z25, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-25.22 Z25, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-25.23 Z25, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-25.24 Z25, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-25.25 Z25, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-26.1 Z26, Ra is H H H H
    E2-26.2 Z26, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-26.3 Z26, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-26.4 Z26, Ra is H F H H
    E2-26.5 Z26, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-26.6 Z26, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-26.7 Z26, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-26.8 Z26, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-26.9 Z26, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-26.10 Z26, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-26.11 Z26, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-26.12 Z26, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-26.13 Z26, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-26.14 Z26, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-26.15 Z26, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-26.16 Z26, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-26.17 Z26, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-26.18 Z26, Ra is H F F H
    E2-26.19 Z26, Ra is H F H F
    E2-26.20 Z26, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-26.21 Z26, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-26.22 Z26, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-26.23 Z26, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-26.24 Z26, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-26.25 Z26, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-27.1 Z27 H H H
    E2-27.2 Z27 CH3 H H
    E2-27.3 Z27 Cl H H
    E2-27.4 Z27 F H H
    E2-27.5 Z27 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-27.6 Z27 CF2H H H
    E2-27.7 Z27 CH2F H H
    E2-27.8 Z27 CF3 H H
    E2-27.9 Z27 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-27.10 Z27 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-27.11 Z27 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-27.12 Z27 OCF3 H H
    E2-27.13 Z27 OCF2H H H
    E2-27.14 Z27 Cl H F
    E2-27.15 Z27 CH3 H F
    E2-27.16 Z27 CH3 F H
    E2-27.17 Z27 Cl F H
    E2-27.18 Z27 F F H
    E2-27.19 Z27 F H F
    E2-27.20 Z27 F H Cl
    E2-27.21 Z27 F H CH3
    E2-27.22 Z27 Cl H CH3
    E2-27.23 Z27 SCH3 H H
    E2-27.24 Z27 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-27.25 Z27 ethynyl H H
    E2-28.1 Z28 H H H
    E2-28.2 Z28 CH3 H H
    E2-28.3 Z28 Cl H H
    E2-28.4 Z28 F H H
    E2-28.5 Z28 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-28.6 Z28 CF2H H H
    E2-28.7 Z28 CH2F H H
    E2-28.8 Z28 CF3 H H
    E2-28.9 Z28 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-28.10 Z28 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-28.11 Z28 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-28.12 Z28 OCF3 H H
    E2-28.13 Z28 OCF2H H H
    E2-28.14 Z28 Cl H F
    E2-28.15 Z28 CH3 H F
    E2-28.16 Z28 CH3 F H
    E2-28.17 Z28 Cl F H
    E2-28.18 Z28 F F H
    E2-28.19 Z28 F H F
    E2-28.20 Z28 F H Cl
    E2-28.21 Z28 F H CH3
    E2-28.22 Z28 Cl H CH3
    E2-28.23 Z28 SCH3 H H
    E2-28.24 Z28 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-28.25 Z28 ethynyl H H
    E2-29.1 Z29 H H H
    E2-29.2 Z29 CH3 H H
    E2-29.3 Z29 Cl H H
    E2-29.4 Z29 F H H
    E2-29.5 Z29 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-29.6 Z29 CF2H H H
    E2-29.7 Z29 CH2F H H
    E2-29.8 Z29 CF3 H H
    E2-29.9 Z29 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-29.10 Z29 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-29.11 Z29 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-29.12 Z29 OCF3 H H
    E2-29.13 Z29 OCF2H H H
    E2-29.14 Z29 Cl H F
    E2-29.15 Z29 CH3 H F
    E2-29.16 Z29 CH3 F H
    E2-29.17 Z29 Cl F H
    E2-29.18 Z29 F F H
    E2-29.19 Z29 F H F
    E2-29.20 Z29 F H Cl
    E2-29.21 Z29 F H CH3
    E2-29.22 Z29 Cl H CH3
    E2-29.23 Z29 SCH3 H H
    E2-29.24 Z29 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-29.25 Z29 ethynyl H H
    E2-30.1 Z30 H H H
    E2-30.2 Z30 CH3 H H
    E2-30.3 Z30 Cl H H
    E2-30.4 Z30 F H H
    E2-30.5 Z30 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-30.6 Z30 CF2H H H
    E2-30.7 Z30 CH2F H H
    E2-30.8 Z30 CF3 H H
    E2-30.9 Z30 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-30.10 Z30 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-30.11 Z30 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-30.12 Z30 OCF3 H H
    E2-30.13 Z30 OCF2H H H
    E2-30.14 Z30 Cl H F
    E2-30.15 Z30 CH3 H F
    E2-30.16 Z30 CH3 F H
    E2-30.17 Z30 Cl F H
    E2-30.18 Z30 F F H
    E2-30.19 Z30 F H F
    E2-30.20 Z30 F H Cl
    E2-30.21 Z30 F H CH3
    E2-30.22 Z30 Cl H CH3
    E2-30.23 Z30 SCH3 H H
    E2-30.24 Z30 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-30.25 Z30 ethynyl H H
    E2-31.1 Z31 H H H
    E2-31.2 Z31 CH3 H H
    E2-31.3 Z31 Cl H H
    E2-31.4 Z31 F H H
    E2-31.5 Z31 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-31.6 Z31 CF2H H H
    E2-31.7 Z31 CH2F H H
    E2-31.8 Z31 CF3 H H
    E2-31.9 Z31 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-31.10 Z31 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-31.11 Z31 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-31.12 Z31 OCF3 H H
    E2-31.13 Z31 OCF2H H H
    E2-31.14 Z31 Cl H F
    E2-31.15 Z31 CH3 H F
    E2-31.16 Z31 CH3 F H
    E2-31.17 Z31 Cl F H
    E2-31.18 Z31 F F H
    E2-31.19 Z31 F H F
    E2-31.20 Z31 F H Cl
    E2-31.21 Z31 F H CH3
    E2-31.22 Z31 Cl H CH3
    E2-31.23 Z31 SCH3 H H
    E2-31.24 Z31 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-31.25 Z31 ethynyl H H
    E2-32.1 Z32 H H H
    E2-32.2 Z32 CH3 H H
    E2-32.3 Z32 Cl H H
    E2-32.4 Z32 F H H
    E2-32.5 Z32 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-32.6 Z32 CF2H H H
    E2-32.7 Z32 CH2F H H
    E2-32.8 Z32 CF3 H H
    E2-32.9 Z32 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-32.10 Z32 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-32.11 Z32 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-32.12 Z32 OCF3 H H
    E2-32.13 Z32 OCF2H H H
    E2-32.14 Z32 Cl H F
    E2-32.15 Z32 CH3 H F
    E2-32.16 Z32 CH3 F H
    E2-32.17 Z32 Cl F H
    E2-32.18 Z32 F F H
    E2-32.19 Z32 F H F
    E2-32.20 Z32 F H Cl
    E2-32.21 Z32 F H CH3
    E2-32.22 Z32 Cl H CH3
    E2-32.23 Z32 SCH3 H H
    E2-32.24 Z32 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-32.25 Z32 ethynyl H H
    E2-33.1 Z33 H H H
    E2-33.2 Z33 CH3 H H
    E2-33.3 Z33 Cl H H
    E2-33.4 Z33 F H H
    E2-33.5 Z33 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-33.6 Z33 CF2H H H
    E2-33.7 Z33 CH2F H H
    E2-33.8 Z33 CF3 H H
    E2-33.9 Z33 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-33.10 Z33 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-33.11 Z33 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-33.12 Z33 OCF3 H H
    E2-33.13 Z33 OCF2H H H
    E2-33.14 Z33 Cl H F
    E2-33.15 Z33 CH3 H F
    E2-33.16 Z33 CH3 F H
    E2-33.17 Z33 Cl F H
    E2-33.18 Z33 F F H
    E2-33.19 Z33 F H F
    E2-33.20 Z33 F H Cl
    E2-33.21 Z33 F H CH3
    E2-33.22 Z33 Cl H CH3
    E2-33.23 Z33 SCH3 H H
    E2-33.24 Z33 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-33.25 Z33 ethynyl H H
    E2-34.1 Z34 H H H
    E2-34.2 Z34 CH3 H H
    E2-34.3 Z34 Cl H H
    E2-34.4 Z34 F H H
    E2-34.5 Z34 CH2CH3 H H
    E2-34.6 Z34 CF2H H H
    E2-34.7 Z34 CH2F H H
    E2-34.8 Z34 CF3 H H
    E2-34.9 Z34 CF2CH3 H H
    E2-34.10 Z34 CH2CF3 H H
    E2-34.11 Z34 cyclopropyl H H
    E2-34.12 Z34 OCF3 H H
    E2-34.13 Z34 OCF2H H H
    E2-34.14 Z34 Cl H F
    E2-34.15 Z34 CH3 H F
    E2-34.16 Z34 CH3 F H
    E2-34.17 Z34 Cl F H
    E2-34.18 Z34 F F H
    E2-34.19 Z34 F H F
    E2-34.20 Z34 F H Cl
    E2-34.21 Z34 F H CH3
    E2-34.22 Z34 Cl H CH3
    E2-34.23 Z34 SCH3 H H
    E2-34.24 Z34 SO2CH3 H H
    E2-34.25 Z34 ethynyl H H
    E2-35.1 Z35, Ra is H H H H
    E2-35.2 Z35, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-35.3 Z35, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-35.4 Z35, Ra is H F H H
    E2-35.5 Z35, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-35.6 Z35, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-35.7 Z35, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-35.8 Z35, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-35.9 Z35, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-35.10 Z35, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-35.11 Z35, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-35.12 Z35, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-35.13 Z35, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-35.14 Z35, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-35.15 Z35, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-35.16 Z35, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-35.17 Z35, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-35.18 Z35, Ra is H F F H
    E2-35.19 Z35, Ra is H F H F
    E2-35.20 Z35, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-35.21 Z35, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-35.22 Z35, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-35.23 Z35, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-35.24 Z35, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-35.25 Z35, Ra is H ethynyl H H
    E2-36.1 Z36, Ra is H H H H
    E2-36.2 Z36, Ra is H CH3 H H
    E2-36.3 Z36, Ra is H Cl H H
    E2-36.4 Z36, Ra is H F H H
    E2-36.5 Z36, Ra is H CH2CH3 H H
    E2-36.6 Z36, Ra is H CF2H H H
    E2-36.7 Z36, Ra is H CH2F H H
    E2-36.8 Z36, Ra is H CF3 H H
    E2-36.9 Z36, Ra is H CF2CH3 H H
    E2-36.10 Z36, Ra is H CH2CF3 H H
    E2-36.11 Z36, Ra is H cyclopropyl H H
    E2-36.12 Z36, Ra is H OCF3 H H
    E2-36.13 Z36, Ra is H OCF2H H H
    E2-36.14 Z36, Ra is H Cl H F
    E2-36.15 Z36, Ra is H CH3 H F
    E2-36.16 Z36, Ra is H CH3 F H
    E2-36.17 Z36, Ra is H Cl F H
    E2-36.18 Z36, Ra is H F F H
    E2-36.19 Z36, Ra is H F H F
    E2-36.20 Z36, Ra is H F H Cl
    E2-36.21 Z36, Ra is H F H CH3
    E2-36.22 Z36, Ra is H Cl H CH3
    E2-36.23 Z36, Ra is H SCH3 H H
    E2-36.24 Z36, Ra is H SO2CH3 H H
    E2-36.25 Z36, Ra is H ethynyl H H
  • Pharmacology
  • Glutamate (GLU) is a fundamental excitatory neurotransmitter in the mammalian brain and central nervous system (CNS). The effects of this endogenous neurotransmitter are mediated through binding to and activation of GLU to glutamate receptors (GLURs), which are broadly classified into metabotropic G-protein coupled (mGluRs) and ligand gated ion channels or ionotropic GluRs. The ionotropic GLURs are pharmacologically classified into three main types based on the actions of selective receptor agonists: NMDA (N-methyl D-aspartate selective), KA (kainic acid selective) and AMPA (α-amino-3-hydroxy-5-methyl-4-isoxazolepropionic acid) receptors whose structure and pharmacological function has been recently reviewed in detail (S. F. Traynelis et al. Pharmacology Reviews, 2010, 62, 405-496). Electrophysiology studies have demonstrated NMDARs to be cation ion channels that are subject to voltage-dependent channel block by endogenous Mg2+. Activation of NMDARs by glutamate in the presence of glycine as a co-agonist results in opening of the receptor ion channel. This in turn allows for the flow of Na+ and Ca2+ into the cell generating excitatory postsynaptic potentials (EPSPs) and Ca2+ activated second messenger signaling pathways in neurons. By virtue of their permeability to Ca2+, activation of NMDA receptors regulates long-term changes in neuronal communication such as learning and memory and synaptic plasticity.
  • Since the original pharmacological characterization with selective ligands, molecular biology and cloning studies have enabled detailed characterization of NMDARs at the molecular level (Paoletti et al., 2013, Nat. Rev. Neurosci. 14:383-400). Thus, NMDARs are heterotetramers comprised of two NR1 subunits and two NR2 subunits. NR1 subunits contain the binding site for the glycine co-agonist while NR2 subunits contain the binding site for glutamate. The existence of multiple splice variants for NR1 and four isoforms of NR2 (NR2A, NR2B, NR2C and NR2D) from different genes results in a diverse molecular array and of NMDARs. The pharmacological and electrophysiological properties of NMDARs vary depending on the particular NR1 isoform and NR2 subtype composition. Furthermore, the NR2 subtype isoforms are differentially expressed across cell types and brain regions. Thus, compounds that interact selectivity with NR2 subunits can exert specific pharmacological effects in particular brain regions and have potential to treat CNS diseases with a high degree of specificity and selectivity (e.g. vz side effects). For example the low expression of the NR2B subtype in the cerebellum relative to other brain structures (Cull-Candy et al., 1998, Neuropharmacol. 37:1369-1380) indicated lower motor side effects for this subtype.
  • NMDA receptor antagonism has been extensively investigated for its potential to treat a variety of CNS diseases including stroke, epilepsy, pain, depression Parkinson's Disease and Alzheimer's disease (Paoletti et al., Nat. Rev. Neurosci 14:383-400; Sancora, 2008, Nature Rev. Drug Disc., 7, 426-437). The NMDA receptor offers a number of pharmacological entry points for developing receptor inhibitors. Direct blockers of the NMDAR ion channel pore represent one family of antagonist compounds for which efficacy could be demonstrated in diverse in vitro and in vivo CNS disease models including, epilepsy, pain and neurodegeneration/stroke. However, compounds from this class, as exemplified by phencyclidine (PCP), MK-801, and ketamine, are generally categorized as unselective across the diversity of NMDA receptor subtypes.
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00018
  • In humans unselective, high-affinity NMDAR antagonists have generally been associated with serious clinical side effects including hallucinations, dysphoria and lack of coordination. Nevertheless, ketamine, an intravenous drug originally approved for use in anesthesia (Haas et. al, 1992, Anesthesia Prog., 39, 61-68) has more recently demonstrated clinical efficacy as an antidepressant therapy (Katalinic et al. 2013, Aust. N. Z. J. Psychiatry, 47, 710-727). The antidepressant action of acute ketamine therapy has an essentially immediate onset compared to approximately six weeks required for standard serotonin reuptake inhibitor (SSRI) drug therapy. Thus, intravenous administration of the drug has shown rapid onset and prolonged efficacy that can be maintained with continued intermittent administrations (Zarate et al., 2006, Arch. Gen. Psychiatry 63, 856-864). Finally, ketamine has been shown to be effective in cases of depression resistant to standard drug therapies (Murrough et al., 2013, American J. Psychiatry, 170, 1134-1142) including bipolar depression (Zarate et al. 2012, Biol. Psychiatry, 71, 939-946). However, as an intravenous drug with serious side effects (Gianni et. al 1985, Psychiatric Medicine, 3, 197-217; Curran et al 2000, Addiction, 95, 575-590) and potential chronic toxicity (Hardy et al., 2012, J. Clin. Oncol. 30:3611-3617; Noppers et al., 2011, Pain 152:2173-2178) ketamine therapy is of limited utility and restricted to acute or intermittent administration. To have broader scope of application and utility as a therapy for depression and other CNS diseases, orally active selective NMDA antagonists with reduced side effects are needed that can be administered chronically.
  • Ifenprodil, a vasodilator α1-adrenergic antagonist drug, was determined to have a novel allosteric modulator mechanism of action at the NR2B NMDA receptor subtype (Reynolds et al. 1989, Mol. Pharmacol., 36, 758-765). This new mechanism held promise for a new class of NMDA antagonist drugs having therapeutic efficacy without the limiting side effects of subtype unselective ion channel blockers. Following this discovery, NR2B selective antagonist analogs of ifenprodil (Borza et al., 2006, Current Topics in Medicinal Chemistry, 6, 687-695; Layton et al. Current Topics in Medicinal Chemistry, 6, 697-709) optimized against the undesirable α1-adrenergic activity included Ro-25,6981 (Fischer et al. 1997, J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 283, 1285-1292) and CP-101,606 otherwise known as traxoprodil (Chenard et al. 1995, Journal of Medicinal Chemistry, 38, 3138-3145; Menniti et al. 1998, CNS Drug Reviews., 4, 307-322). In a clinical study, CP-101,606 evidenced antidepressant activity in humans after intravenous administration with a favorable dissociative side effect profile relative to unselective NMDA antagonists (Preskorn et al. 2008, Journal of Clinical Psychopharmacology, 28, 631-637). However, CP-101,606 has suboptimal pharmacokinetic properties and requires limiting intravenous administration. For CP-101,606 a slow intravenous infusion protocol was required for optimal results in the aforementioned antidepressant clinical study (Preskorn et al. 2008, Journal of Clinical Psychopharmacology, 28, 631-637).
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00019
  • Other NR2B antagonists which have been described as reviewed by B. Ruppa et al. (K. B. Ruppa et al., Annual Reports in Medicinal Chemistry 2012, 47:89-103) include MK0657 (J. A. McCauley et al., 3rd Anglo-Swedish Medicinal Chemistry Symposium, Are, Sweden, Mar. 11-14, 2007; L. Mony et al., British J. of Pharmacology 2009, 157:1301-1317; see also Intl. Appl. Publ. No. WO 2004/108705; U.S. Pat. No. 7,592,360) and compounds of formula LX (Intl. Appl. Publ. No. WO 2006/113471), below, including the specific analog LX-1 depicted below.
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00020
  • The difficulties presented by NR2B antagonists having basic amine moieties with regard to overcoming hERG and CYP2D6 safety liabilities while maintaining NR2B in vitro and in vivo potency are well established as noted by Kawai et al. (M. Kawai et al., Bioorganic and Medicinal Chem. Lett. 2007, v17:5533-5536) and Brown et al. (Brown et al., Bioorganic and Medicinal Chem. Lett. 2011, v21:3399-3403). Compound inhibition of hERG channels and associated QT prolongation in the electrocardiograph (ECG) represents a well recognized serious human cardiovascular safety risk (Hancox et al., Molecular Pharmacology 2008, 73:1592-1595). QT prolongation can lead to torsades de pointes (TdP) cardiac arrhythmia which can degenerate into ventricular tachycardia and sudden death.
  • Compound inhibition of human metabolic cytochrome P-450 enzymes including CYP2D6 represents a risk with regard to human drug safety due to drug-drug interactions (Drug Metabolism Handbook: Concepts and Applications, ed. Ala F. Nassar copyright 2009 Wiley & Sons, Hoboken, N.J.). Thus, the clearance of drugs that are substrates of CYP2D6 can be reduced by compounds that inhibit CYP2D6. The result can be toxic or side effect overload due to accumulation of the given CYP2D6 drug substrate. CNS drugs including antidepressant drugs feature prominently among the established CYP2D6 substrates. Therefore, CYP2D6 inhibition is highly undesirable for an NR2B antagonist drug especially given the common application of comedications or polypharmacy in CNS indications including depression. Examples of CY2D6 substrates include antidepressants from the SSRI class such as fluoxetine, paroxetine, and fluvoxamine, duloxetine, an antidepressants from the SSNI class, numerous antipsychotics including haloperidol, risperidone and aripiperazole, numerous beta-blocker antihypertensives including metaprolol, propranolol, timolol and alprenolol and the Alzheimer's disease anticholinesterase inhibitor drug donepezil (Flockhart D A (2007). “Drug Interactions: Cytochrome P450 Drug Interaction Table”, Indiana University School of Medicine, accessed at <<http://medicine.iupui.edu/clinpharm/ddis/>> on May 28, 2014).
  • MK0657 and closely related analogs (Liverton et al., J. Med. Chem. 2007, v50:807-819) represent an improved generation of NR2B antagonists with respect to human oral bioavailability. However, drug-related systolic as well as diastolic blood pressure elevation cardiovascular side effects for MK0657 after oral dosing have been described in a published clinical efficacy trial study in patients with Parkinson's Disease (Addy et al., J. Clin. Pharm. 2009, v49:856-864). Similar blood pressure effects were reported to have also been observed after single doses of MK0657 in safety studies with healthy subjects. (Peterson et al., “A randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled, parallel-group, three-part safety, pharmacokinetic, and pharmacodynamic study of CERC-301 in healthy subjects”, National Network of Depression Centers Annual Conference, Ann Arbor, Nov. 5-6, 2015). Interestingly, MK0657 and its enantiomer (the 3R,4S compound) show similar potency against NR2B (MK0657=13.8 nM; 3R,4S enantiomer=25.5 nM). Even more remarkable is that the potency of the cis and trans diastereomers show similar potency against NR2B (see Koudih et al., European J. Med. Chem. 53 (2012), 408-415).
  • Compound LX-1 demonstrates oral bioavailability in animals and lacks a phenolic group which can compromise oral bioavailability in humans. However, not inconsistent with other NR2B antagonists having basic amine moieties, compound LX-1, which has a basic piperidine nitrogen atom, notwithstanding the basicity-attenuating vicinal difluoro moiety beta to this nitrogen exhibits human hERG channel inhibition with an IC50<10 μM (˜4.5 μM), and exhibits human CYP2D6 metabolic enzyme inhibition activity (IC50˜1.0 μM).
  • For broad scope of application and safe human use, improved NR2B selective antagonists are needed, as also noted in K. B. Ruppa et al., Annual Reports in Medicinal Chemistry 2012, 47:89-103. There is a need for NR2B antagonist compounds which are improved in one or more aspects exemplified by pharmacokinetic, absorption, metabolism, excretion (ADME, e.g., oral activity), improved efficacy, off-target activity, improved therapeutic safety index relative and compatibility with chronic oral therapy. For example, drug-related systolic as well as diastolic blood pressure elevation cardiovascular side effect for MK0657 after oral dosing have been described in a published clinical efficacy trial study in patients with Parkinson's Disease (Addy et al., J. Clin. Pharm. 2009, v49:856-864). Similar blood pressure effects were reported to have also been observed after single doses of MK0657 in safety studies with healthy elderly subjects.
  • Provided chemical entities are antagonists of the NR2B receptor and have technical advantages with regard to one or more pharmaceutical drug properties, such as oral bioavailability, pharmacokinetic parameters, ADME properties (e.g., CYP inhibition, metabolite formation), in vivo and/or in vitro pharmacological safety.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B functional NMDA receptor selectivity versus NR2A (“NR2B selectivity”, determined as the ratio NR2A IC50/NR2B IC50, in which the IC50 values are measured according to the procedure of Example 2.1)≥400. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ≥300. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ≥200. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ≥100. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ≥50. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B selectivity ≥20.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG activity (determined as hERG IC50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.2)≥5 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC 50 10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC50≥15 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC50≥20 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC50≥25 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC50≥30 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has hERG IC50≥40 μM.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B functional antagonist activity (determined as NR2B IC50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.1)≤200 nM and hERG activity (determined as hERG IC50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.2)≥5 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and hERG IC50≥10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and hERG IC50≥15 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and hERG IC50≥20 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and hERG IC50≥25 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and hERG IC50≥30 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and hERG IC50≥40 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and hERG IC50≥5 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and hERG IC50≥10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and hERG IC50≥5 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and hERG IC50≥10 μM.
  • In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B functional antagonist activity (determined as NR2B IC50 measured according to the procedure of Example 2.1)≤200 nM and CYP2D6 inhibition (measured as CYP2D6 IC50 determined according to the procedure of Example 2.3) ≥2 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥3 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥4 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥5 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and CYP2D6 IC50 of about 5-10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤200 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥2 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥3 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥4 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥5 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and CYP2D6 IC50 of about 5-10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤100 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥2 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥3 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥4 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥5 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and CYP2D6 IC50 of about 5-10 μM. In some embodiments, a provided chemical entity has NR2B IC50≤50 nM and CYP2D6 IC50≥10 μM.
  • Uses, Formulation and Administration, and Pharmaceutically Acceptable Compositions
  • In some embodiments, the invention provides a composition comprising a chemical entity of the invention or a pharmaceutically acceptable derivative thereof and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle. The amount of chemical entity in compositions of this invention is such that is effective to measurably inhibit NR2B, in a biological sample or in a patient. In some embodiments, the amount of chemical entity in compositions of this invention is such that is effective to measurably inhibit NR2B, in a biological sample or in a patient. In some embodiments, a composition of this invention is formulated for administration to a patient in need of such composition. In some embodiments, a composition of this invention is formulated for oral administration to a patient.
  • The term “patient,” as used herein, means an animal, preferably a mammal, and most preferably a human.
  • The term “pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle” refers to a non-toxic carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle that does not destroy the pharmacological activity of the chemical entity with which it is formulated. Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, adjuvants or vehicles that may be used in the compositions of this invention include ion exchangers, alumina, aluminum stearate, lecithin, serum proteins, such as human serum albumin, buffer substances such as phosphates, glycine, sorbic acid, potassium sorbate, partial glyceride mixtures of saturated vegetable fatty acids, water, salts or electrolytes, such as protamine sulfate, disodium hydrogen phosphate, potassium hydrogen phosphate, sodium chloride, zinc salts, colloidal silica, magnesium trisilicate, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, cellulose-based substances, polyethylene glycol, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, polyacrylates, waxes, polyethylene-polyoxypropylene-block polymers, polyethylene glycol and wool fat.
  • A “pharmaceutically acceptable derivative” means any non-toxic ester, salt of an ester or other derivative of a chemical entity of this invention (e.g., a prodrug) that, upon administration to a recipient, is capable of providing, either directly or indirectly, a chemical entity of this invention or an inhibitorily active metabolite or residue thereof.
  • As used herein, the term “inhibitorily active metabolite or residue thereof” means that a metabolite or residue thereof is also an inhibitor of NR2B.
  • Compositions of the present invention may be administered orally, parenterally, by inhalation spray, topically, rectally, nasally, buccally, vaginally or via an implanted reservoir. The term “parenteral” as used herein includes subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, intra-articular, intra-synovial, intrasternal, intrathecal, intrahepatic, intralesional and intracranial injection or infusion techniques. Preferably, the compositions are administered orally, intraperitoneally or intravenously. Sterile injectable forms of the compositions of this invention may be aqueous or oleaginous suspension. These suspensions may be formulated according to techniques known in the art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents. The sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution or suspension in a non-toxic parenterally acceptable diluent or solvent, for example as a solution in 1,3-butanediol. Among the acceptable vehicles and solvents that may be employed are water, Ringer's solution and isotonic sodium chloride solution. In addition, sterile, fixed oils are conventionally employed as a solvent or suspending medium.
  • For this purpose, any bland fixed oil may be employed including synthetic mono- or di-glycerides. Fatty acids, such as oleic acid and its glyceride derivatives are useful in the preparation of injectables, as are natural pharmaceutically-acceptable oils, such as olive oil or castor oil, especially in their polyoxyethylated versions. These oil solutions or suspensions may also contain a long-chain alcohol diluent or dispersant, such as carboxymethyl cellulose or similar dispersing agents that are commonly used in the formulation of pharmaceutically acceptable dosage forms including emulsions and suspensions. Other commonly used surfactants, such as Tweens, Spans and other emulsifying agents or bioavailability enhancers which are commonly used in the manufacture of pharmaceutically acceptable solid, liquid, or other dosage forms may also be used for the purposes of formulation.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention may be orally administered in any orally acceptable dosage form including capsules, tablets, aqueous suspensions or solutions. In the case of tablets for oral use, carriers commonly used include lactose and corn starch. Lubricating agents, such as magnesium stearate, are also typically added. For oral administration in a capsule form, useful diluents include lactose and dried cornstarch. When aqueous suspensions are required for oral use, the active ingredient is combined with emulsifying and suspending agents. If desired, certain sweetening, flavoring or coloring agents may also be added.
  • Alternatively, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention may be administered in the form of suppositories for rectal administration. These can be prepared by mixing the agent with a suitable non-irritating excipient that is solid at room temperature but liquid at rectal temperature and therefore will melt in the rectum to release the drug. Such materials include cocoa butter, beeswax and polyethylene glycols.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention may also be administered topically, especially when the target of treatment includes areas or organs readily accessible by topical application, including diseases of the eye, the skin, or the lower intestinal tract. Suitable topical formulations are readily prepared for each of these areas or organs.
  • Topical application for the lower intestinal tract can be effected in a rectal suppository formulation (see above) or in a suitable enema formulation. Topically-transdermal patches may also be used.
  • For topical applications, provided pharmaceutically acceptable compositions may be formulated in a suitable ointment containing the active component suspended or dissolved in one or more carriers. Carriers for topical administration of compounds of this invention include mineral oil, liquid petrolatum, white petrolatum, propylene glycol, polyoxyethylene, polyoxypropylene compound, emulsifying wax and water. Alternatively, provided pharmaceutically acceptable compositions can be formulated in a suitable lotion or cream containing the active components suspended or dissolved in one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. Suitable carriers include mineral oil, sorbitan monostearate, polysorbate 60, cetyl esters wax, cetearyl alcohol, 2-octyldodecanol, benzyl alcohol and water.
  • For ophthalmic use, provided pharmaceutically acceptable compositions may be formulated as micronized suspensions in isotonic, pH adjusted sterile saline, or, preferably, as solutions in isotonic, pH adjusted sterile saline, either with or without a preservative such as benzylalkonium chloride. Alternatively, for ophthalmic uses, the pharmaceutically acceptable compositions may be formulated in an ointment such as petrolatum.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention may also be administered by nasal aerosol or inhalation. Such compositions are prepared according to techniques well-known in the art of pharmaceutical formulation and may be prepared as solutions in saline, employing benzyl alcohol or other suitable preservatives, absorption promoters to enhance bioavailability, fluorocarbons, and/or other conventional solubilizing or dispersing agents.
  • Most preferably, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention are formulated for oral administration. Such formulations may be administered with or without food. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention are administered without food. In other embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention are administered with food.
  • The amount of compounds of the present invention that may be combined with the carrier materials to produce a composition in a single dosage form will vary depending upon a variety of factors, including the host treated and the particular mode of administration. Preferably, provided compositions should be formulated so that a dosage of between 0.01-100 mg/kg body weight/day of the inhibitor can be administered to a patient receiving these compositions.
  • It should also be understood that a specific dosage and treatment regimen for any particular patient will depend upon a variety of factors, including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health, sex, diet, time of administration, rate of excretion, drug combination, and the judgment of the treating physician and the severity of the particular disease being treated. The amount of a compound of the present invention in the composition will also depend upon the particular compound in the composition.
  • Uses of Chemical Entities and Pharmaceutically Acceptable Compositions
  • Human therapeutic applications of NR2B receptor antagonists have been summarized in reviews by Traynelis et al. (S. F. Traynelis et al., Pharmacology Reviews, 2010, 62:405-496), Beinat et al. (C. Beinat et al., Current Medicinal Chemistry, 2010, 17:4166-4190) and Mony et al. (L. Mony et al., British J. of Pharmacology, 2009, 157:1301-1317). Antagonism of NR2B can be useful in the treatment of diseases and disorders including depression, pain, Parkinson's disease, Huntington's disease, Alzheimer's disease, cerebral ischaemia, traumatic brain injury, seizure disorders (e.g., epilepsy) and migraine. (S. B. Bausch et al., Epilepsia, 2010, 51:102-105; P. Mares, Naunyn-Schmiedeberg's Arch Pharmacol, 2014, 387:753-761; E. Szczurowska et al., Brain Research Bulletin, 2015, 111:1-8).
  • The activity of a chemical entity utilized in this invention as an antagonist of NR2B or a treatment for a disease or disorder of the central nervous system (CNS) may be assayed in vitro or in vivo. An in vivo assessment of the efficacy of the compounds of the invention may be made using an animal model of a disease or disorder of the CNS, e.g., a rodent or primate model. Cell-based assays may be performed using, e.g., a cell line isolated from a tissue that expresses NR2B, or a cell line that recombinantly expresses NR2B. Additionally, biochemical or mechanism-based assays, e.g., measuring cAMP or cGMP levels, Northern blot, RT-PCR, etc., may be performed. In vitro assays include assays that determine cell morphology, protein expression, and/or the cytotoxicity, enzyme inhibitory activity, and/or the subsequent functional consequences of treatment of cells with chemical entities of the invention. Alternate in vitro assays quantify the ability of the inhibitor to bind to protein or nucleic acid molecules within the cell. Inhibitor binding may be measured by radiolabelling the inhibitor prior to binding, isolating the inhibitor/target molecule complex and determining the amount of radiolabel bound. Alternatively, inhibitor binding may be determined by running a competition experiment where new inhibitors are incubated with purified proteins or nucleic acids bound to known radioligands. Detailed conditions for assaying a compound utilized in this invention as an antagonist of NR2B are set forth in the Examples below. The aforementioned assays are exemplary and not intended to limit the scope of the invention. A person skilled in the art can appreciate that modifications can be made to conventional assays to develop equivalent assays that obtain the same result.
  • Those skilled in the art appreciate that identification and/or characterization of desirable or effective compounds commonly involves assessment of one or more activities in an animal model. Those skilled in the art further appreciate that such animal models do not always accurately recapitulate human experience. (Bezard et al. Neuroscience 211:1, 2012). Among other things, animal models are often developed to mimic one or more symptoms of a particular human condition, but it is not always feasible to ensure that, or possibly even determine whether, symptoms observed in the animal result from or are attributable to the same mechanism as that which causes the symptom(s) in humans. Furthermore, it is not uncommon for multiple animal models to be developed for the same disease, disorder or condition, each of which may reflect or mimic one or more features of the disease, disorder or condition; those skilled in the art appreciate that results are not always precisely consistent across such models, and that judgment and/or interpretation may be required to draw conclusions reasonably predictive of human responses. Still further, particularly for animal models of neurological conditions as described herein, different measurements or responses observed within the model may be more reliable than others in modeling or predicting human response.
  • To give but a few examples, it is known in the art that available animal models for depression have varying degrees of face, construct, and predictive validity for depression and contribute differently to our understanding of antidepressant processes. (Duman C. H. Vitamins & Hormones 82:1-21, 2010).
  • Commonly employed models relevant to work described herein include, for example, the rodent forced swim test, which is often used for evaluation of antidepressant efficacy. (Can et al. J. Vis. Exp. 2012, 59:3638; Bogdanova et al. Physiol. Behav. 118:227, 2013). Different protocols are available for performance of forced swim tests. (Slattery & Cryan Nature Protocols 7:1009, 2012; Lucki et el., 2001, Psychopharmacology 155:315-322).
  • The haloperidol-induced catalepsy (HIC) model has been used to characterize therapeutic agents for treating certain neurological conditions and/or symptoms. For example, the HIC model has been particularly recommended for use in characterizing therapeutic agents for their potential utility in protection against catalepsy associated with PD. (Steece-Collier et al. Exp. Neurol. 163: 239, 2000). Additionally, the HIC model has been used for characterizing antidepressants, and has been reported to be able to reveal differing activities among antidepressants that may have performed comparably in one or more other assays such as, for example, in forced swim tests. (Khisti et al. Indian J. Exp. Biol. 35:1297, 1997).
  • Various different models have been reported to provide information relevant to treatment of epilepsy, though the diversity of epilepsy syndromes and their causes may preclude use of any single model or test as definitive of efficacy. Most animal models used in epilepsy research are models of epileptic seizure rather than models of epilepsy. Epilepsy is characterized by spontaneous recurrent seizures, therefore, a test such as the 6 Hz seizure test described herein, in which an acute seizure is electrically induced in a normal non-epileptic animal, may not fully represent a model of epilepsy. (Löscher Seizure 2011, 20:359-368). Conversely, the 6 Hz seizure test is considered to be a potential screen for therapy-resistant epilepsy. The 6 Hz seizure test assay described herein uses a current of 44 mA which typically results in most antiepileptic drugs losing their efficacy. Accordingly, the 6 Hz seizure test has been suggested to be a useful model of therapy-resistant limbic seizures. (Barton et al. Epilepsy Res. 47(3):217-27, 2001).
  • The PTZ test, described herein, is thought to be predictive of anticonvulsant drug activity against nonconvulsive (absence or myoclonic) epileptic seizures. As described in a review by Löscher, various antiepileptic drugs that protect against nonconvulsive seizures in epilepsy patients failed in the PTZ test. (Löscher W. Seizure 20:359-368, 2011). Therefore, inconclusive or negative data resulting from the PTZ test does not necessarily mean that the tested therapy (e.g., compound) will be ineffective in epilepsy patients. Further, such compounds could be effective in a different animal model of epilepsy. For example, an antiepileptic drug may fail in the 6 Hz seizure test (electrically induced seizures) but prove efficacious in the PTZ test (chemically induced seizures).
  • Those of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that any effect observed in a specific animal model test can be significant. Furthermore, those skilled in the art will appreciate that use of multiple and various animal models of diseases can be beneficial to characterize the efficacy of a particular agent or treatment. Moreover, those skilled in the art will appreciate that it is not required that every assessment of a particular agent in an animal model provide strong evidence of activity; in some circumstances, positive evidence of activity in one context may be more significant than absence of evidence of activity in another, particularly as it is understood that optimization of reaction conditions may reveal activity not observed in initial studies.
  • As used herein, the terms “treatment,” “treat,” and “treating” refer to reversing, alleviating, delaying the onset of, or inhibiting the progress of a disease or disorder, or one or more symptoms thereof, as described herein. In some embodiments, treatment may be administered after one or more symptoms have developed. In other embodiments, treatment may be administered in the absence of symptoms. For example, treatment may be administered to a susceptible individual prior to the onset of symptoms (e.g., in light of a history of symptoms and/or in light of genetic or other susceptibility factors). Treatment may also be continued after symptoms have resolved, for example to prevent or delay their recurrence.
  • The chemical entities and compositions, according to the method of the present invention, may be administered using any amount and any route of administration effective for treating or lessening the severity of a CNS disease or disorder.
  • In some embodiments, the chemical entities and compositions, according to the method of the present invention, may be administered using any amount and any route of administration effective for treating or lessening the severity of a disease or disorder associated with NR2B.
  • In some embodiments, the chemical entities and compositions, according to the method of the present invention, may be administered using any amount and any route of administration effective for treating or lessening the severity of a CNS disease or disorder.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is depression with or without concomitant anxiety disorder, e.g., single episode and recurrent depressive disorder, dysthymic disorder, major depressive disorder, psychotic depression, premenstrual dysphoric disorder, postpartum depression, seasonal affective disorder (SAD), mood disorder, treatment-resistant depression (TRD, i.e., major depressive disorder that has not responded to other drug therapies), depression caused by a chronic medical condition such as cancer or chronic pain, chemotherapy, chronic stress, and post traumatic stress disorders.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is an acute affective disorder, e.g., selected from bipolar disorders including bipolar I and bipolar II manic disorders.
  • In some embodiments, the present invention provides a method of treating substance abuse disorders, wherein treatment results in decreased tolerance and/or dependence to opioid treatment of pain, and/or by treating withdrawal syndrome of e.g., alcohol, opioids, heroin, and cocaine. As used herein, the term “substance abuse disorders” includes substance dependence or abuse with or without physiological dependence. The substances associated with these disorders include: alcohol, amphetamines (or amphetamine-like substances), caffeine, cannabis, cocaine, hallucinogens, inhalants, marijuana, nicotine, opioids, phencyclidine (or phencyclidine-like compounds), sedative-hypnotics or benzodiazepines, and other (or unknown) substances and combinations of all of the above.
  • In some embodiments, a substance abuse disorder includes drug withdrawal disorders such as alcohol withdrawal with or without perceptual disturbances; alcohol withdrawal delirium; amphetamine withdrawal; cocaine withdrawal; nicotine withdrawal; opioid withdrawal; sedative, hypnotic or anxiolytic withdrawal with or without perceptual disturbances; sedative, hypnotic or anxiolytic withdrawal delirium; and withdrawal symptoms due to other substances. It will be appreciated that reference to treatment of nicotine withdrawal includes the treatment of symptoms associated with smoking cessation. Other substance abuse disorders include substance-induced anxiety disorder with onset during withdrawal; substance-induced mood disorder with onset during withdrawal; and substance-induced sleep disorder with onset during withdrawal.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is pain, e.g., selected from pain states arising from a variety of sources including neuropathic pain (such as post herpetic neuralgia, nerve injury/damage, the “dynias”, e.g., vulvodynia, phantom limb pain, root avulsions, painful diabetic neuropathy, compressive mononeuropathy, ischemic neuropathy, painful traumatic mononeuropathy, or painful polyneuropathy), central pain syndromes (potentially caused by virtually any lesion at any level of the nervous system), and postsurgical pain syndromes (e.g., postmastectomy syndrome, postthoracotomy syndrome, stump pain), bone and joint pain (osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis), repetitive motion pain, carpal tunnel syndrome, dental pain, cancer pain, myofascial pain (muscular injury, fibromyalgia), perioperative pain (general surgery, gynecological), chronic pain, dysmenorrhea, as well as pain associated with angina, and inflammatory pain of varied origins (e.g. osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis, rheumatic disease, teno-synovitis and gout), headache, migraine and cluster headache. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is associated with intractable pain, such as migraine, fibromyalgia, and trigeminal neuralgia.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a migraine disorder. Migraine is among the most common neurological disorders with a prevalence of 10-15% worldwide. A third of patients with migraine also suffer from transient focal neurological symptoms, termed aura. Aura typically begins minutes to hours prior to the headache, but may occur during the headache phase or even in the absence of headache. The most interesting aspects of aura are the ‘spreading’ character, suggesting an underlying mechanism that propagates slowly along adjacent brain tissue.
  • A large body of data has accumulated suggesting that spreading depression (SD), which can also refer to cortical spreading depression (CSD), is the electrophysiological substrate of migraine aura and a potential trigger for headache. Occasionally, an aura can occur with little or no headache following it. SD takes place in a number of major neurological disorders besides migraine with aura, for example stroke and brain trauma. Moreover, SD is capable of activating central and peripheral trigeminovascular nociceptive pathways with a latency matching that occurs between aura and headache in migraineurs. Last, but not least, migraine prophylactic drugs have been shown to suppress SD, suggesting that SD is a relevant pharmacological target in migraine. (Shatillo et al. Neuropharm. 2015, 93:164-170).
  • SD is an intense depolarization of neuronal and glial membranes that propagates in brain tissue at a rate of approximately 3 mm/min. The depolarization wave will be recognized by DC (direct current) recording on cortex in anesthetized rats. Simultaneously, CBF (cerebral blood flow) increase on dura can be measured indicating the vasodilatation of dural veins. Evoked when local extracellular K+ concentrations exceed a critical threshold, SD is associated with disruption of membrane ionic gradients, with massive K+ and glutamate efflux believed to first depolarize and then hyperpolarize adjacent neurons to facilitate spread. SD can be evoked pharmacologically by application of glutamate, K+ and Na+/K+-pump inhibitors, by electrical stimulation and by tissue injury, such as trauma, hemorrhage or ischemia. Direct evidence for the occurrence of SD in human brain in situ has been obtained using subdural electrophysiological recordings and intracortical multiparametric electrodes. (Ayata et al. Ann. Neurol. 2006, 59:652-61).
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a migraine without aura. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a migraine with aura. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a migraine with typical aura. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder includes migraine with brainstem aura, hemiplegic migraine, retinal migraine, and/or chronic migraine.
  • In some embodiments, a migraine may be a stress migraine, silent or acephalgic migraine, sinus migraine, ocular migraine, seasonal migraine, cyclic migraine syndrome, gastric stasis migraine, and/or tension migraine.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a primary headache disorder characterized by recurrent headaches that are moderate to severe. A headache can affect one half of the head and last from one hour to several days. In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a tension headache and/or trigeminal autonomic cephalagias.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is cluster headache. Cluster headache is a type of headache that recurs over a period of time. Generally, patients who suffer from cluster headaches experience an episode one to three times per day during a period of time (the cluster period), which may last from two weeks to three months. A cluster headache typically awakens a person from sleep one to two hours after going to bed. Cluster headaches may disappear or go into remission for months or years, only to recur without any warning. In some embodiments, the cluster headache is chronic (e.g., the cluster period is measured by months or years, rather than weeks). In certain embodiments, the cluster headache is episodic.
  • In some embodiments, a headache may result in symptoms comprising nausea, vomiting, and sensitivity to light, sound, or smell. In some embodiments, a migraine may result in symptoms comprising nausea, vomiting, and sensitivity to light, sound, or smell. In some embodiments, complications of migraine include status migrainosus, persistent aura without infarction, migrainosus infarction, and/or migraine aura-triggered seizure.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is selected from sleep disorders and their sequelae including insomnia, narcolepsy and idiopathic hypersomnia.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is selected from CNS disorders characterized by neuronal hyperexcitablity, such as epilepsy, convulsions, seizures, partial seizure disorders, generalized seizure disorders such as absence seizures, atonic, myoclonic, tonic, tonic-clonic or “grand-mal” seizures, status epilepticus, cortical spreading depression, migraine headaches, cerebral palsy, Ohtahara Syndrome, Fragile X Syndrome, pediatric or genetic seizures such as West syndrome, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome and Angleman syndrome, tuberosclerosis, intracranial hypertension, central nervous system edema, neuronal toxicity, such as toxicity induced by alcohol exposure, pathophysiological effects of head trauma, stroke, ischemia, hypoxia and other conditions resulting from or producing ionic imbalances in the central nervous system, or synchronized discharges of neuronal populations.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is characterized by the occurrence of a seizure. Seizures are a result of uncontrolled discharges of electrical activity in the brain. A seizure typically manifests as sudden, involuntary, disruptive, and often destructive sensory, motor, and cognitive phenomena. Seizures are frequently associated with physical harm to the body (e.g., tongue biting, limb breakage, and burns), a complete loss of consciousness, and incontinence. A typical seizure, for example, might begin as spontaneous shaking of an arm or leg and progress over seconds or minutes to rhythmic movement of the entire body, loss of consciousness, and voiding of urine or stool. There are both convulsive and non-convulsive seizures. Convulsive seizures can be generalized seizures or partial seizures. There are six main types of generalized seizures: tonic-clonic, tonic, clonic, myoclonic, absence, and atonic seizures. A non-convulsive seizure, for example an absence seizure, presents as a decreased level of consciousness and usually lasts about 10 seconds.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is epilepsy. Epilepsy is a disorder of the brain characterized by an enduring predisposition to generate epileptic seizures and by the neurobiologic, cognitive, psychological, and social consequences of this condition. (R. S. Fisher et al., Epilepsia, 2005, 46(4):470-472). Epilepsy can be the occurrence of at least one epileptic seizure. An epileptic seizure is a transient occurrence of signs and/or symptoms due to abnormal excessive or synchronous neuronal activity in the brain. Epilepsy affects people of all ages; however, epilepsy most often occurs in childhood and older adulthood (Institute of Medicine 2012). The exact cause of epilepsy is uncertain. Some known causes of epilepsy include head trauma, stroke, tumors, infection, or abnormalities of the brain.
  • Epilepsy is categorized as idiopathic (genetic cause) or symptomatic (cause unknown), and is further grouped into either generalized, affecting both hemispheres of the brain, or partial epilepsy, which affects one hemisphere of the brain. Examples of idiopathic generalized epilepsy include childhood absence epilepsy, juvenile myoclonic epilepsy and epilepsy with grand mal seizures. Examples of idiopathic partial epilepsy include benign focal epilepsy of childhood. Symptomatic generalized epilepsy includes West syndrome, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome and others. Symptomatic partial epilepsy includes temporal lobe epilepsy, frontal lobe epilepsy and others.
  • In some embodiments, the seizure disorder is a pediatric seizure disorder. The ability to categorize a case of a seizure disorder, e.g. epilepsy, into a specific syndrome occurs more often with children since the onset of seizures is commonly early. Less serious examples are benign rolandic epilepsy, childhood absence epilepsy and juvenile myoclonic epilepsy (A. Neligan et al., Handbook of clinical neurology 2012, 107:113-33). Other examples of pediatric seizures include febrile seizures, infantile spasms and neonatal seizures.
  • In some embodiments, the seizure disorder is frontal lobe epilepsy, juvenile myoclonic epilepsy, myoclonic epilepsy, absence epilepsy, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome, Landau-Kleffner syndrome, Dravet syndrome, progressive myoclonus epilepsies, reflex epilepsy, Rasmussen's syndrome, temporal lobe epilepsy, limbic epilepsy, status epilepticus, abdominal epilepsy, massive bilateral myoclonus, catamenial epilepsy, Jacksonian seizure disorder, Lafora disease or photosensitive epilepsy, or a combination of one or more of these.
  • For most cases of epilepsy, the disease is chronic and requires chronic medications for treatment. Antiepileptic drugs (AEDs) generally suppress neural activity by a variety of mechanisms, including altering the activity of cell membrane ion channels and the propensity of action potentials or bursts of action potentials to be generated. These desired therapeutic effects are often accompanied by the undesired side effect of sedation. Other medications have significant non-neurological side effects, such as gingival hyperplasia, a cosmetically undesirable overgrowth of the gums, and/or a thickening of the skull, as occurs with phenytoin. While chronic usage of AEDs has proven to be effective for a majority of patients suffering from epilepsy, the persistent side effects can cause a significant impairment to a patient's quality of life. Furthermore, in spite of the currently available arsenal of old and new AEDs, almost one-third of epileptic patients are non-responsive (e.g. refractory) to all pharmacological regimens. (M. M. Castel-Branco et al, Methods Find Exp Clin Pharmacol, 2009, 31(2):101-106). Subsequently, there is a substantial need to develop new and more effective AEDs.
  • In some embodiments, the seizure disorder is refractory to treatment. Severe syndromes with diffuse brain dysfunction, also referred to as epileptic encephalopathies, are refractory to current treatment. Epileptic encephalopathies constitute a group of disorders in which the epileptic activity itself is considered to contribute to severe cognitive impairment or decline above and beyond what might be expected from the underlying pathology alone. In further embodiments, the refractory seizure disorder is a disorder associated with neuronal migration, such as human microgyria. (S. Bandyopadhyay et al., Epilepsy Research, 2006, 72:127-139). Another important disturbance in a subgroup of patients surgically treated for intractable seizures is focal dysplasia of the cerebral cortex. Anticonvulsant drug therapy is often ineffective in patients with such cortical malformations. In some embodiments, the seizure disorder involves cortical hyperexcitability in focal cortical dysplasia (malformations). (S. Bandyopadhyay et al., Epilepsy Research, 2006, 72:127-139).
  • In some embodiments, the seizure or epilepsy disorder is caused by a genetic abnormality. Genetics is believed to play an important role in epilepsies by a number of mechanisms. Simple and complex modes of inheritance have been identified for some of them. Recent exome and genome sequencing studies have begun to reveal a number of de novo gene mutations that are responsible for some epileptic encephalopathies, including CHD2 and SYNGAP1 and DMN1, GABBR2, FASN and RYR3. Patients with the epileptic encephalopathie, West syndrome, present distinct clinical electrophysiological features usually manifesting between 3 and 12 months as clusters of infantile spasms (IS) and a characteristic electroencephalogram (EEG) pattern called hypsarrhythmia. West syndrome has been associated with mutations in ARX, CDKL5, STXBP1, and ST3GAL3 as well as various copy number variations (CNVs). (J. R. Lemke et al., Ann Neurol, 2014, 75(1), 147-154). Mutations in GRIN2A and GRIN2B encoding the NR2A and NR2B of the NMDA receptor are associated with several neurodevelopmental disorders. Mutations in GRIN2A have recently been detected in idiopathic focal epilepsy with rolandic spikes and related epileptic encephalopathies, that is, in Landau-Kleffner syndrome, epilepsy with continuous spike-and-waves during slow sleep syndrome, and nonsyndromic epilepsy associated with intellectual disability. By contrast, GRIN2B has not been described as an epilepsy gene to date but has repeatedly been considered as a putative candidate gene for seizures, and mutations were detected in patients with ID and schizophrenia. (J. R. Lemke et al., Ann Neurol, 2014, 75(1), 147-154).
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is a movement disorder. Movement disorders include Parkinson's disease, dyskinesias (including the side effects accompanying normal doses of L-Dopa), tardive dyskinesia, drug-induced parkinsonism, postencephalitic parkinsonism, progressive supranuclear palsy, multiple system atrophy, corticobasal degeneration, parkinsonian-ALS dementia complex, basal ganglia calcification, akinesia, akinetic-rigid syndrome, bradykinesia, dystonia, medication-induced parkinsonian, Gilles de la Tourette syndrome, Huntingon's disease, tremor, chorea, myoclonus, tick disorder and dystonia.
  • In some embodiments, the movement disorder is one or more of akinesias and akinetic-rigid syndromes, dyskinesias and medication-induced parkinsonism (such as neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism, neuroleptic malignant syndrome, neuroleptic-induced acute dystonia, neuroleptic-induced acute akathisia, neuroleptic-induced tardive dyskinesia and medication-induced postural tremor). Examples of “akinetic-rigid syndromes” include Parkinson's disease, drug-induced parkinsonism, postencephalitic parkinsonism, progressive supranuclear palsy, multiple system atrophy, corticobasal degeneration, parkinsonism-ALS dementia complex and basal ganglia calcification. Examples of dyskinesias include tremor (including rest tremor, postural tremor and intention tremor), chorea (such as Sydenham's chorea, Huntington's disease, benign hereditary chorea, neuroacanthocytosis, symptomatic chorea, drug-induced chorea and hemiballism), myoclonus (including generalized myoclonus and focal myoclonus), tics (including simple tics, complex tics and symptomatic tics), and dystonia (including generalised dystonia such as iodiopathic dystonia, drug-induced dystonia, symptomatic dystonia and paroxymal dystonia, and focal dystonia such as blepharospasm, oromandibular dystonia, spasmodic dysphonia, spasmodic torticollis, axial dystonia, dystonic writer's cramp and hemiplegic dystonia).
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is Parkinson's disease.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is Huntington's disease.
  • In some embodiments, the disease or disorder is cognitive dysfunction associated with disorders including schizophrenia, Alzheimer's disease, fronto-temporal dementia, Pick's disease, Lewy body disease, and other senile dementias (e.g., vascular dementia).
  • In some embodiments, the present invention provides a method of treating a disorder described herein, comprising administering a chemical entity of the invention in conjunction with one or more pharmaceutical agents. Suitable pharmaceutical agents that may be used in combination with the chemical entities of the present invention include selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors (SSRIs), e.g., in the treatment of depression; dopamine replacement therapy regimens and dopamine agonists, e.g., in the treatment of Parkinson's disease; typical antipsychotics; atypical antipsychotics; anticonvulsants; stimulants; Alzheimer's disease therapies; anti-migraine agents; and anxiolytic agents.
  • Suitable SSRIs include citalopram, dapoxetine, escitalopram, fluoxetine, fluvoxamine, indalpine, paroxetine, sertraline, vilazodone and zimelidine.
  • Suitable dopamine replacement therapy regimens include replacement of L-DOPA with a DOPA decarboxylase inhibitor such as carbidopa.
  • Suitable dopamine receptor agonists include aplindore, apomorphine, bromocriptine, cabergoline, ciladopa, dihydroergocryptine, lisuride, pardoprunox, pergolide, piribedil, pramipexole, ropinirole and rotigotine.
  • Suitable typical antipsychotics include chlorpromazine, thioridazine, mesoridazine, levomepromazine, loxapine, molindone, perphenazine, thiothixene, trifluoperazine, haloperidol, fluphenazine, droperidol, zuclopenthixol, flupentixol and prochlorperazine.
  • Suitable atypical antipsychotics include amisulpride, aripiprazole, asenapine, blonanserin, clotiapine, clozapine, iloperidone, Ilurasidone, mosapramine, olanzapine, paliperidone, perospirone, quetiapine, remoxipride, risperidone, sertindole, sulpiride, ziprasidone, zotepine, bifeprunox, pimavanserin and vabicaserin.
  • Suitable anticonvulsants include phenytoin, carbamazepine, barbiturates, phenobarbital, phenobarbital, mephobarbital, trimethadione, mephenytoin, paramethadione, phenthenylate, phenacemide, metharbital, benzchlorpropamide, phensuximide, priraidone, methsuximide, ethotoin, aminoglutethinide, diazepam, clonazepam, clorazepate, fosphenytoin, ethosuximide, valproate, felbamate, gabapentin, lamotrigine, topiramate, vigrabatrin, tiagabine, ziamide, clobazam, thiopental, midazolam, propofol, levetiracetam, oxcarbazepine, CCPene, and GYKI 52466.
  • Suitable stimulants include Adderall (amphetamine, dextroamphetamine mixed salts), methylphenidate, dextroamphetamine, dexmethylphenidate and lisdexamfetamine.
  • Suitable Alzheimer's disease therapies include acetylcholinesterase inhibitors such as rivastigmine, donepezil, galanthamine and huperazine; alpha-7 nicotinic agonists such as encenicline; and drugs that reduce AP42 such as BACE inhibitors, gamma secretase modulators and beta amyloid peptide antibodies.
  • Suitable anti-migraine drugs include Ergot alkaloids (e.g., ergotamine and dihydroergotamine mesylate). Other suitable anti-migraine drugs include 5-HT1D agonist triptans such as sumitriptan, almotriptan, eletriptan, frovatriptan, naratriptan, rizatriptan, and zolmitriptan.
  • Other suitable agents for use in treating or preventing headache(s) or migraine include pain medication (e.g., aspirin, naproxen, ibuprofen, and acetaminophen), medication for nasuea, caffeine, antihistamines, isometheptene mucate, divalproex sodium/sodium valproate, topiramate, metoprolol, propranolol, timolol, lisinopril, candesartan, atenolol, nadolol, diltiazem, nimodipine, verapamil, amitriptyline, nortriptyline, imipramine, doxepin, protriptyline, paroxetine, fluoxetine, sertraline, topiramate, gabapentin, and divalproex sodium.
  • In some embodiments, one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat a headache. In some embodiments, one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat a migraine. In some embodiments, one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat a migraine with aura.
  • In some embodiments, one or more other suitable agents can be combined with a chemical entity of the invention to prevent and/or treat cluster headache. Blood pressure lowering medications have been shown to treat cluster headache. Accordingly, in some such embodiments, a chemical entity of the invention can be combined with, for example, verapamil, lithium, divalproex sodium, prednisone, ergotamine tartrate, melatonin, a triptan (e.g., sumatriptan), oxygen, intranasal lidocaine, or any other suitable agent to prevent and/or treat cluster headache.
  • Suitable anxiolytic drugs include benzodiazepine receptor modulators such as diazepam, alprazolam, lorazepam and clonazepam.
  • Other suitable agents for use in conjunction with a chemical entity of the invention include memantine and modafinil.
  • The exact amount required will vary from subject to subject, depending on the species, age, and general condition of the subject, the severity of the infection, the particular agent, its mode of administration, and the like. The chemical entities of the invention are preferably formulated in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage. The expression “dosage unit form” as used herein refers to a physically discrete unit of agent appropriate for the patient to be treated. It will be understood, however, that the total daily usage of the chemical entities and compositions of the present invention will be decided by the attending physician within the scope of sound medical judgment. The specific effective dose level for any particular patient or organism will depend upon a variety of factors including the disorder being treated and the severity of the disorder; the activity of the specific chemical entity employed; the specific composition employed; the age, body weight, general health, sex and diet of the patient; the time of administration, route of administration, and rate of excretion of the specific chemical entity employed; the duration of the treatment; drugs used in combination or coincidental with the specific chemical entity employed, and like factors well known in the medical arts. The term “patient”, as used herein, means an animal, preferably a mammal, and most preferably a human.
  • In some embodiments, administration may involve dosing that is intermittent (e.g., a plurality (i.e., at least two) of doses separated in time) and/or periodic (e.g., individual doses separated by a common period of time) dosing. In some embodiments, a dosing regimen for a particular active agent may involve intermittent or continuous administration, for example to achieve a particular desired pharmacokinetic profile or other pattern of exposure in one or more tissues or fluids of interest in the subject receiving therapy. In some embodiments, intermittent dosing may include dosing that occurs once a day, once every other day, once a week, once every two weeks, or once a month.
  • In some embodiments, administration may involve dosing that is titrated over time in order to reach a target dosage. In some embodiments, increases in dosing amount and/or schedule can occur at weekly intervals based on the subject's clinical response and tolerability.
  • In some embodiments, one or more features of a dosing regimen may be modified over time (e.g., increasing or decreasing amount of active in any individual dose, increasing or decreasing time intervals between doses, etc.), for example in order to optimize a desired therapeutic effect or response.
  • In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered once a week. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered once a day. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered twice a day. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered three times a day. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered with or without regard to food.
  • In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered to treat acute conditions. Acute conditions may be sudden in onset. Acute condition symptoms may appear and change or worsen rapidly. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered to treat chronic conditions. Chronic conditions may be long-developing conditions. A chronic condition may develop and worsen over an extended period of time.
  • In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered prior to a seizure. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered after a seizure. In some embodiments, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention can be administered to a patient at risk of seizure.
  • The pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention can be administered to humans and other animals orally, rectally, parenterally, intracisternally, intravaginally, intraperitoneally, topically (as by powders, ointments, or drops), bucally, as an oral or nasal spray, or the like, depending on the severity of the infection being treated. In certain embodiments, the chemical entities of the invention may be administered orally or parenterally at dosage levels of about 0.01 mg/kg to about 50 mg/kg and preferably from about 1 mg/kg to about 25 mg/kg, of subject body weight per day, one or more times a day, to obtain the desired therapeutic effect.
  • Liquid dosage forms for oral administration include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs. In addition to the active compounds, the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art such as water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, dimethylformamide, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor, and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof. Besides inert diluents, the oral compositions can also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring, and perfuming agents.
  • Injectable preparations, for example, sterile injectable aqueous or oleaginous suspensions may be formulated according to the known art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents. The sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution, suspension or emulsion in a nontoxic parenterally acceptable diluent or solvent, for example, as a solution in 1,3-butanediol. Among the acceptable vehicles and solvents that may be employed are water, Ringer's solution, U.S.P. and isotonic sodium chloride solution. In addition, sterile, fixed oils are conventionally employed as a solvent or suspending medium. For this purpose any bland fixed oil can be employed including synthetic mono- or diglycerides. In addition, fatty acids such as oleic acid are used in the preparation of injectables.
  • The injectable formulations can be sterilized, for example, by filtration through a bacterial-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved or dispersed in sterile water or other sterile injectable medium prior to use.
  • In order to prolong the effect of a chemical entity of the present invention, it is often desirable to slow the absorption of the chemical entity from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material with poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the chemical entity then depends upon its rate of dissolution that, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally administered chemical entity form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the chemical entity in an oil vehicle. Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsule matrices of the chemical entity in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending upon the ratio of chemical entity to polymer and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of chemical entity release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the chemical entity in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissues.
  • Compositions for rectal or vaginal administration are preferably suppositories which can be prepared by mixing the chemical entities of this invention with suitable non-irritating excipients or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax which are solid at ambient temperature but liquid at body temperature and therefore melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active chemical entity.
  • Solid dosage forms for oral administration include capsules, tablets, pills, powders, and granules. In such solid dosage forms, the active chemical entity is mixed with at least one inert, pharmaceutically acceptable carrier such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate and/or a) fillers or extenders such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and silicic acid, b) binders such as carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinylpyrrolidinone, sucrose, and acacia, c) humectants such as glycerol, d) disintegrating agents such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate, e) solution retarding agents such as paraffin, f) absorption accelerators such as quaternary ammonium compounds, g) wetting agents such as cetyl alcohol and glycerol monostearate, h) absorbents such as kaolin and bentonite clay, and i) lubricants such as talc, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate, and mixtures thereof. In the case of capsules, tablets and pills, the dosage form may also comprise buffering agents.
  • Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like. The solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills, and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and can also be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes. Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polethylene glycols and the like.
  • The active chemical entities can also be in micro-encapsulated form with one or more excipients as noted above. The solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills, and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings, release controlling coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. In such solid dosage forms the active chemical entity may be admixed with at least one inert diluent such as sucrose, lactose or starch. Such dosage forms may also comprise, as is normal practice, additional substances other than inert diluents, e.g., tableting lubricants and other tableting aids such a magnesium stearate and microcrystalline cellulose. In the case of capsules, tablets and pills, the dosage forms may also comprise buffering agents. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and can also be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes.
  • Dosage forms for topical or transdermal administration of a chemical entity of the invention include ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, powders, solutions, sprays, inhalants or patches. The active chemical entity is admixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and any needed preservatives or buffers as may be required. Ophthalmic formulation, ear drops, and eye drops are also contemplated as being within the scope of the invention. Additionally, the present invention contemplates the use of transdermal patches, which have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of a chemical entity to the body. Such dosage forms can be made by dissolving or dispensing the chemical entity in the proper medium. Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the chemical entity across the skin. The rate can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or by dispersing the chemical entity in a polymer matrix or gel.
  • As used herein, the term “combination,” “combined,” and related terms refers to the simultaneous or sequential administration of therapeutic agents in accordance with this invention. For example, a chemical entity of the present invention may be administered with another therapeutic agent simultaneously or sequentially in separate unit dosage forms or together in a single unit dosage form. Accordingly, the present invention provides a single unit dosage form comprising a chemical entity of Formula (I), an additional therapeutic agent, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle.
  • In some embodiments, different agents administered in combination may be administered via different routes of delivery and/or according to different schedules. Alternatively or additionally, in some embodiments, one or more doses of a first active agent is administered substantially simultaneously with, and in some embodiments via a common route and/or as part of a single composition with, one or more other active agents.
  • The amount of both, a provided chemical entity and additional therapeutic agent (in those compositions which comprise an additional therapeutic agent as described above), that may be combined with the carrier materials to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the host treated and the particular mode of administration. Preferably, compositions of this invention should be formulated so that a dosage of between 0.01-100 mg/kg body weight/day of a provided chemical entity can be administered.
  • In those compositions which comprise an additional therapeutic agent, that additional therapeutic agent and the chemical entity of this invention may act synergistically. Therefore, the amount of additional therapeutic agent in such compositions will be less than that required in a monotherapy utilizing only that therapeutic agent. In such compositions a dosage of between 0.01-100 μg/kg body weight/day of the additional therapeutic agent can be administered.
  • The amount of additional therapeutic agent present in the compositions of this invention will be no more than the amount that would normally be administered in a composition comprising that therapeutic agent as the only active agent. Preferably the amount of additional therapeutic agent in the presently disclosed compositions will range from about 50% to 100% of the amount normally present in a composition comprising that agent as the only therapeutically active agent.
  • In some embodiments, the present invention provides a medicament comprising at least one chemical entity of Formula (I) and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant or vehicle.
  • In some embodiments, the present invention provides the use of a chemical entity of Formula (I) in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a CNS disease or disorder.
  • General Synthetic Methods
  • Chemical entities of Formula (I) can be synthesized according to Scheme 1 and/or using methods known in the art.
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00021
  • In the method depicted in Scheme 1, in a first step, compounds of formula XII may be prepared by coupling of intermediates of formula X, wherein R1′=R1 or a protecting group (e.g., where R1′ is t-butyl, the moiety R1′—OC(O)— is a Boc group), with intermediates Z-LG of formula XI. For compounds of formula XI the Z is a heterocyclic group as defined above and LG is a suitable group for the coupling reaction such as chlorine or bromine. In certain cases the coupling reaction can be conducted as a base mediated nucleophilic aromatic substitution reaction. In certain cases the coupling reaction can be conducted as a Buchwald reaction mediated by palladium catalysis. Aromatic substitution coupling reactions can be conducted in suitable protic (e.g., isopropanol, n-butanol) or aprotic (e.g., CH2Cl2, DMF, DMSO, CH3CN) solvents at temperatures from ambient to 160° C., for example, between 50° C. and 120° C. with intermediates of formula Z—Cl in the presence of a suitable base (e.g., triethylamine, diisopropylethylamine). Buchwald coupling reactions (Buchwald, S.; Muci, A. Top. Curr. Chem. 2002; 219, 133-209) can be conducted in suitable organic solvents (e.g., t-butanol, toluene, DMF, DMSO, CH3CN) in the presence of a suitable palladium catalyst and phosphine ligand system (e.g., Brettphos/Brettphos precatalyst, BINAP/Pd2(dba)3) at temperatures from 70° C. to 150° C., for example, between 80° C. and 130° C. with intermediates of formula Z—Br, in the presence of a suitable base (e.g., Cs2CO3) under inert (e.g., nitrogen) atmosphere. In the case where R1′=R1, compounds of formula XII are equivalent to compounds of formula I. In the case where R1′ is a protecting group then intermediate compounds of formula XII can be converted to intermediate compounds of formula XIII using deprotection conditions known in the art. For example, when R1′ is a t-butyl group (i.e., where the R1′—OC(O)— moiety is a Boc group), intermediate compounds of formula XII can be converted to intermediate compounds of formula XIII using a number of known methods. Typically the Boc deprotection is conducted under acidic conditions using either HCl (e.g., 1-4N HCl in ether or dioxane in a suitable organic solvent, e.g., dichloromethane, methanol or THF) at temperatures between 0° C. and 50° C., or using trifluoroacetic acid in an aprotic solvent (e.g., dichloromethane) at temperatures between 0° C. and room temperature. The latter is particularly useful for compounds which are sensitive to chloride-mediated side reactions. Intermediate compounds of formula XIII can be can be converted to compounds of formula I by carbamoylation reaction with a carbamoylating reagent of formula R1OC(O)X wherein X is a suitable leaving group (e.g., Cl, imidazolyl, hydroxysuccinyl). Reagents of formula R1OC(O)X may be implemented in isolated form or generated in situ. For example, an alcohol of formula R1OH can be treated with carbonyldiimidazole in an aprotic organic solvent at between 0° C. and room temperature to first form the R1OC(O)imidazolyl carbamoylating reagent. In situ reaction of the R1OC(O)imidazolyl carbamoylating reagent with intermediate compounds of formula XIII (in free base or acid addition salt form, at temperatures between 0° C. and 70° C.) in an aprotic solvent (e.g., DMSO) yields compounds of formula I.
  • The heteroaryl chloride or bromide coupling reagents Z-LG are either commercially available, can be prepared according to known literature procedures for the exact compound or can be prepared using methods known in the art for synthesizing heteroaryl chlorides and bromides. For example, the heteroaryl compound Z—H can be brominated or chlorinated using methods known in the art (e.g. by treatment with bromine or N-bromosuccinimide or another brominating reagent or treatment with a chlorinating reagent such as sulfurylchloride) the desired Z—Br or Z—Cl heteroaryl coupling reagent can then be isolated by the appropriate procedure (e.g. by chromatography as needed to separate regioisomers). Heteroaryl coupling reagents Z—Cl wherein the chloro group is part of an iminochloride substructure can be prepared under standard conditions (e.g., using phosphorus oxychloride at elevated temperature as solvent itself or in a suitable aprotic organic solvent) from the corresponding Z—OH starting material which has the corresponding amido tautomeric substructure. Other heteroaryl coupling reagents can be prepared from the corresponding Z—NH2 starting material under Sandmeyer reaction-type conditions which are well established in the art (i.e., diazotization reaction followed by chlorination or bromination with CuCl or CuBr). In some cases the required Z—H, Z—OH or Z—NH2 starting materials can be prepared using methods known in the art for synthesizing heteroaryl compounds.
  • Chemical entities of Formula (I) can be obtained as individual enantiomers from racemic mixtures using methods known in the art such as chiral chromatography or recrystallization of diastereomeric acid addition salts. Alternatively, chemical entities of Formula (I) can be obtained as individual enantiomers by asymmetric synthesis or from the corresponding individual enantiomer intermediates. For example, the individual enantiomers of chemical entities of Formula (I) can be prepared from enantiomers of the intermediates of formula X having the corresponding absolute stereochemical configuration at C-4 of the piperidine ring system. Intermediates of formula X can in turn be prepared by an asymmetric synthesis process as depicted in Scheme 2. In this process the known starting material XIV (Madaiah M. et. Al. Tetrahedron Lett. 2013, 54, 1424-27) is converted in three steps to an α,β-unsaturated acyl intermediate XV substituted with an optically pure R=(XVa) or S=(XVb) oxazolidinone chiral auxiliary system. In the case of XVa, with the R-absolute stereochemistry chiral auxiliary, standard catalytic hydrogenation using 10% Pd—C in ethyl acetate affords a ca. 5:1 mixture of diasteromeric products (R)-XVIa (major) and (S)—XVIa (minor). This mixture can be separated by standard chromatography over silica gel to give (R)-XVIa in pure form. As depicted in Scheme 2, hydrolysis of the chiral auxiliary of pure intermediate (R)-XVIa gives the pure enantiomer acid intermediate (R)-XVII. From (R)-XVII, a two-step Curtius reaction process gives the (−)-(R)—X enantiomer. The (+)-(S)—X enantiomer can be prepared in analogous fashion starting from intermediate XVb. Pure enantiomers of formula X may also be prepared from enantiomerically enriched or racemic mixtures by chiral acid addition salt formation and recrystallization (e.g., using a chirally pure tartaric acid) methods standard in the art.
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00022
  • Enantiomer intermediates of formula XVI can also be prepared by catalytic asymmetric hydrogenation of the intermediates of formula XV wherein Y forms simple achiral ester group (e.g.,Y=OMe, OEt). To this end chiral catalysts comprising a chiral phosphine ligand (e.g., Waldphos ligands) and a transition metal (e.g., Ir, Rh or Ru) can be employed in asymmetric catalytic hydrogenation conditions at elevated temperature and pressure to give simple ester intermediates XVI of high enantiomeric purity. The latter can be converted to pure enantiomers of X using standard methods in the art such as those described above. Hydrogenation of α,β-unsaturated acid and ester systems have been reviewed by Tang et al. (Tang W. et al., Chem Rev. 2003, 103, 3029), and additional useful catalytic asymmetric hydrogenation methods have been described by Krska et al. (Krska S. W. et al., Tetrahedron 2009, 65, 8987-8994) and Tudge et al. (Tudge M. et al., Organic Process Research and Development 2010, 14, 787-798).
  • Pure enantiomer intermediates for synthesizing enantiomers of compounds of Formula I may also be prepared by variants of the above methods using intermediates with alternative protecting groups or double bond isomers as exemplified in Scheme 3.
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00023
  • For example, an intermediate of formula XXI wherein R=benzyl can be subjected to the above-described reduction processes (e.g., catalytic asymmetric hydrogenation) to generate intermediates of formula (R)-XXII that are chirally pure at the C-4 piperidine stereocenter. In subsequent steps the benzyl group can be removed and exchanged for another protecting group (e.g., Boc) or the CO2R1 group present in the compound of Formula I. Alternatively, the same reaction scheme can be implemented via asymmetric hydrogenation of the double bond isomer starting material XXX.
  • Example 1. Chemical Entities
  • As depicted in the Examples below, in certain exemplary embodiments, chemical entities are prepared according to the following procedures. It will be appreciated that, although the general methods depict the synthesis of certain chemical entities of the present invention, the following methods, and other methods known to persons skilled in the art, can be applied to all chemical entities and subclasses and species of each of these chemical entities, as described herein.
  • Temperatures are given in degrees centigrade. If not mentioned otherwise, all evaporations are performed under reduced pressure, preferably between 15 mm Hg and 100 mm Hg. The structures of intermediates and final products are confirmed by standard analytical methods, for example, mass spectrometry and NMR spectroscopy. Optical rotations are measured at the sodium D line and given in degrees. Enantiomeric excess can be determined via chiral HPLC methods (e.g., using CHIRALPAK AD-H4.6*150 mm, 5 μm columns and suitable mobile phase selection, e.g., hexane/isopropanol (80:20), and flow rates, e.g., 1.5 mL/min).
  • Abbreviations
      • aq aqueous
      • BINAP 2,2′-bis(diphenylphosphino)-1,1′-binaphthalene
      • Boc t-butoxycarbonyl
      • Brettphos 2-(dicyclohexylphosphino)-3,6-dimethoxy-2′,4′,6′-triisopropyl-1,1′-biphenyl
      • Brettphos precatalyst chloro[2-(dicyclohexylphosphino)-3,6-dimethoxy-2′,4′,6′-triisopropyl-1,1′-biphenyl][2-(2-aminoethyl)phenyl]-palladium(II)
      • nBuOH n-butanol
      • Cbz benzyloxycarbonyl
      • CDI carbonyldiimidazole
      • DAST diethylamino sulfur trifluoride
      • dba dibenylideneacetone
      • DCM dichloromethane
      • DCE 1,2-dichloroethane
      • DIPEA N,N-diisopropylethylamine
      • DMF N,N-dimethylformamide
      • DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide
      • Et ethyl
      • Et2O diethyl ether (“ether”)
      • EtOAc ethyl acetate
      • EtOH ethanol
      • eq equivalents
      • h hours
      • HPLC high performance liquid chromatography
      • LC liquid chromatography
      • Me methyl
      • Ms methanesulfonyl
      • MsCl methanesulfonylchloride
      • MS mass spectrometry
      • MS (ESI) mass spectrometry electrospray ionization
      • NMP N-methyl-2-pyrrolidone
      • NMR nuclear magnetic resonance
      • Pd/C palladium supported on carbon
      • rt room temperature
      • TEA triethylamine
      • TFA trifluoroacetic acid
      • THF tetrahydrofuran
      • TLC thin layer chromatography
      • Ts p-toluenesulfonyl
    Example 1.A. (−)-R-Tert-Butyl 4-(Aminomethyl)-3,3-Difluoropiperidine-1-Carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00024
  • Step 1: tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4,4-dihydroxypiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00025
  • To a solution of 1-benzyl-3,3-difluoropiperidine-4,4-diol (100.0 g, 412 mmol) in ethanol (1850 mL) was added 10% Pd/C (10.0 g) and HCl (6.0 M, 69 mL, 414 mmol). The mixture was purged with H2 three times and hydrogenated at room temperature under atmospheric pressure. After the starting material was consumed, the mixture was filtered through celite and the filter pad was extracted with EtOH. The combined filtrates were concentrated under reduced pressure and the crude 3,3-difluoropiperidine-4,4-diol hydrochloride product was used directly in the next step without purification. A stirred solution of the crude product 3,3-difluoropiperidine-4,4-diol hydrochloride (78 g) in water (1000 mL) and acetone (500 mL) was basified by Na2CO3 to pH 9. Di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (98.9 g, 453 mmol) was then added and the mixture was stirred at rt for 4 h. The mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure to remove the acetone cosolvent. The resulting mixture was extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic layers were dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated to afford the crude product as a brown oil. The oil was treated with hexane and the precipitated solid material was triturated and filtered to give the title compound as a white powder (94.3 g, 90% overall). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 3.72 (t, J=11.6 Hz, 2H), 3.56-3.46 (m, 2H), 1.83-1.77 (m, 2H), 1.42 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-(2-methoxy-2-oxoethylidene)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00026
  • To a stirred solution of tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4,4-dihydroxypiperidine-1-carboxylate (80.0 g, 314 mmol) in toluene (1000 mL) was added methyl (triphenylphosphoranylidene)acetate (126 g, 377 mmol) and the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 4 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (EtOAc/hexane=1/5) to afford the title compound as a colorless oil (79.6 g, 87%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 6.23 (s, 1H), 3.83-3.71 (m, 2H), 3.76 (s, 3H), 3.58-3.47 (m, 2H), 3.13-3.05 (m, 2H), 1.48 (s, 9H).
  • Step 3: 2-(1-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3, 3-difluoropiperidin-4-ylidene)acetic acid
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00027
  • To a stirred solution of tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-(2-methoxy-2-oxoethylidene)piperidine-1-carboxylate (590 g, 2.03 mol) in THF (1.5 L) was added a solution of NaOH (40.1 g, 1.0 mol) in water (1.5 L) at room temperature. The resulting mixture was heated to 50° C., and stirred for 1 h. After the starting material was consumed, the THF was concentrated under reduced pressure. The aqueous concentrate was extracted with ethyl acetate and acidified to pH 5 with 4.0M aqueous HCl under ice-water bath cooling. The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate three times. The combined organic phases were washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with hexane and the suspension was filtered to afford the title product as an off-white powder (492 g, 87%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 12.99 (s, 1H), 6.11 (s, 1H), 3.81 (t, J=11.6 Hz, 2H), 3.50-3.42 (m, 2H), 2.94-2.88 (m, 2H), 1.42 (s, 9H).
  • Step 4: tert-butyl (R)-4-(2-(4-benzyl-2-oxooxazolidin-3-yl)-2-oxoethylidene)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00028
  • To a stirred solution of 2-(1-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3, 3-difluoropiperidin-4-ylidene)acetic acid (23.5 g, 84.8 mmol) in dry THF (250 mL) was added Et3N (11.7 mL, 85.7 mmol) at 0° C. Pivaloyl chloride (10.5 mL, 89.0 mmol) was added dropwise and the mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 2 h. To the mixture at −78° C. was added a THF solution of one equivalent of (R)-4-benzyl-3-lithio-2-oxazolidinone (prepared from (R)-4-benzyl-2-oxazolidinone (15.0 g, 84.7 mmol) and n-BuLi (2.5 M in hexane, 34 mL, 85 mmol) in THF (150 mL) at −78° C.). The resulting mixture was allowed to warm to 0° C., stirred for 30 minutes at 0° C. and quenched with sat.NH4Cl. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate. The combined organic layers were washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was recrystallized from ethyl acetate/hexane (60 mL/400 mL) to afford the title compound as a white powder (24.5 g, 66%). MS (ESI) calcd for C22H26F2N2O5:436.2; found [459.3] [M+Na]; 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.39-7.32 (m, 3H), 7.31-7.29 (m, 1H), 7.22 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 4.76-4.70 (m, 1H), 4.27-4.19 (m, 2H), 3.84-3.79 (m, 2H), 3.63-3.52 (m, 2H), 3.35 (dd, J=3.2 and 13.2 Hz, 1H), 3.08-2.97 (m, 2H), 2.80 (dd, J=10.0 and 13.2 Hz, 1H), 1.49 (s, 9H).
  • Step 5: R-tert-butyl 4-(2-((R)-4-benzyl-2-oxooxazolidin-3-yl)-2-oxoethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00029
  • To a suspension of ((R)-tert-butyl 4-(2-(4-benzyl-2-oxooxazolidin-3-yl)-2-oxoethylidene)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (10.0 g, 22.8 mmol) in ethyl acetate (150 mL) was added 10% palladium on carbon (1.0 g). The mixture was hydrogenated at room temperature for 13 hr at atmospheric pressure. The mixture was filtered through celite and the filter pad was extracted with ethyl acetate. The combined filtrates were concentrated in vacuo to afford a 12.0 g of a ca. 5:1 mixture mixture of the R title compound along with corresponding minor S diastereoisomer. The diastereomers were separated by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate/hexane=1/3). The major diastereoisomer eluted first and was obtained as white powder (5.20 g, 52%, >99% de) (Column:CHIRALPAKAD-H 4.6*150 mm, 5 um; Mobile Phase: A:Hexanes B:Ethanol=70:30; t=9.07). MS (ESI) calcd for C22H28F2N2O5: 438.2; found: 461.2 [M+Na] 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.37-7.32 (m, 2H), 7.31-7.28 (m, 1H), 7.20 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 4.72-4.66 (m, 1H), 4.48-4.00 (m, 4H), 3.38-3.27 (m, 2H), 3.11-2.72 (m, 4H), 2.66-2.53 (m, 1H), 1.93-1.89 (m, 1H), 1.63-1.51 (m, 1H), 1.47 (s, 9H).
  • Step 6: R-2-(1-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)acetic acid
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00030
  • To a stirred mixture of R-tert-butyl 4-(2-((R)-4-benzyl-2-oxooxazolidin-3-yl)-2-oxoethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (5.20 g, 11.8 mmol) in THF/H2O (45 mL/45 mL) were added 30% aq. H2O2(4.9 mL, 48 mmol) and lithium hydroxide monohydrate (800 mg, 19.0 mmol) at 0° C. After stirring for 90 min at 0° C., the reaction mixture was treated with 1M Na2SO3 solution (40 mL) and then extracted with ethyl acetate (2×100 mL) to remove the chiral auxiliary. The aqueous phase was acidified to pH=2˜3 with 1M aq.HCl and then extracted with ethyl acetate (2×100 mL). The combined ethyl acetate phases were dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was recrystallized from ethyl acetate/hexane (5 mL/50 mL) to afford the title compound as a white powder (3.70 g, 79%). MS (ESI) calcd for C12H19F2NO4: 279.1; found 224 [M+H−56 (t-butyl group)]; 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 4.51-4.01 (m, 2H), 3.10-2.70 (m, 3H), 2.45-2.28 (m, 2H), 1.93-1.89 (m, 1H), 1.58-1.50 (m, 1H), 1.46 (s, 9H).
  • Step 7: R-tert-butyl 4-((benzyloxycarbonylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00031
  • To a stirred solution of R-2-(1-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)acetic acid (6.05 g, 21.7 mmol) in dry toluene (50 mL) were added triethylamine (4.6 mL, 34 mmol) and diphenylphosphoryl azide (5.2 mL, 24 mmol) under nitrogen. After stirring for 20 min at 80° C., benzyl alcohol (1.4 mL, 25 mmol) was added and the reaction was stirred at 100° C. overnight. The mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature, concentrated and diluted with DCM (200 mL). The organic phase was washed with 0.5M aq. HCl (2×50 mL), water (2×50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was recrystallized from ethanol/H2O (30 mL/90 mL) to afford the title compound as a white powder (6.91 g, 84%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H26F2N2O4: 384.2; found: 407.2 [M+Na]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.39-7.30 (m, 5H), 5.10 (s, 2H), 5.02 (brs, 1H), 4.51-3.99 (m, 2H), 3.55-3.44 (m, 1H), 3.39-3.26 (m, 1H), 3.04-2.65 (m, 2H), 2.18-2.02 (m, 1H), 1.78-1.75 (m, 1H), 1.58-1.48 (m, 1H), 1.46 (s, 9H).
  • Step 8: (−)-R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00032
  • To a suspension of R-tert-butyl 4-((benzyloxycarbonylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (7.01 g, 24.7 mmol) in ethyl acetate (45 mL) was added 10% palladium on carbon (700 mg). The mixture was hydrogenated at room temperature under atmospheric hydrogen pressure for 13 hr. The mixture was filtered through celite and the filter pad was extracted with ethyl acetate. The combined filtrates were concentrated in vacuo to afford the title compound as a brown oil (4.60 g, 93%). [α]D=−18.3° (c=10 mg/mL, methanol, 20° C.), MS (ESI) calcd for C11H20F2N2O2: 250.2; found: 195.2 [M+H−56 (t-butyl group)]; 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 4.45-4.01 (m, 2H), 3.15 (dd, J=5.2, 12.8 Hz, 1H), 3.05-2.75 (m, 2H), 2.68 (dd, J=6.4, 12.8 Hz, 1H) 1.96-1.74 (m, 2H), 1.58-1.48 (m, 1H), 1.46 (s, 9H), 1.40 (brs, 2H).
  • Example 1.B. 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00033
  • A mixture of p-tolylmethanol (2.40 g, 19.6 mmol) and bis(2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl) carbonate (5.03 g, 19.6 mmol) in a mixed solvent comprised of acetonitrile (30 mL) and CH2Cl2 (30 mL) was treated with 4-dimethylaminopyridine (1.20 g, 9.8 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 2 h at room temperature. After the alcohol was consumed, the mixture was poured into water (100 mL), and the organic layer was separated, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and concentrated under vacuum. The solid thus obtained was triturated with ether and dried to afford the title compound as a white solid (3.40 g, 66%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) 7.29 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.20 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.28 (s, 2H), 2.82 (s, 4H), 2.36 (s, 3H).
  • Example 1.C. 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl 4-ethylbenzyl carbonate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00034
  • A mixture of 4-ethylbenzyl alcohol (1.0 g, 7.3 mmol) and bis(2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl) carbonate (1.88 g, 7.3 mmol) in a solvent mixture of acetonitrile (15.0 mL) and CH2Cl2 (15.0 mL) was treated with 4-dimethylaminopyridine (446 mg, 3.65 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 2 h at room temperature. Then the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the title compound as an off white powder (2.0 g, 99%) which was used without further purification.
  • Example 1.D. (+)-S-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • The title compound can be prepared in an analogous manner to (−)-R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate as described in Example 1.A., but using (S)-4-benzyl-3-lithio-2-oxazolidinone (prepared from (S)-4-benzyl-2-oxazolidinone and n-BuLi) in place of the corresponding reagent having the (R) configuration.
  • Example 1.1. (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-1.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00035
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00036
  • A stirred mixture of (−)-R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (230 mg, 0.92 mmol), 8-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazine (127 mg, 0.83 mmol) and DIPEA (0.30 mL, 1.8 mmol) in n-BuOH (5 mL) was heated to 95° C. under nitrogen for 13 hr. The reaction mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate/hexane=1/1) to afford the title compound as a white powder (210 mg, 62%). MS (ESI) calcd for C16H22F2N6O2: 368.2; found: 369.1 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.72 (s, 1H), 7.41 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.35 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 6.50-6.45 (m, 1H), 4.47-4.09 (m, 2H), 4.02-3.96 (m, 1H), 3.79-3.72 (m, 1H), 3.09-2.69 (m, 2H), 2.45-2.29 (m, 1H), 1.92-1.87 (m, 1H), 1.68-1.58 (m, 1H), 1.47 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine trifluoroacetate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00037
  • To stirred suspension of R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)-methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (1.01 g, 2.72 mmol) in dichloromethane (15 mL) was added TFA (3 mL). The solution was then stirred at ambient temperature for 30 min. The resulting reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the title compound as a yellow residue which was used in the next step without further purification. MS (ESI) calcd for C11H14F2N6: 268.1; found: 269.1 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.26 (s, 1H), 7.87 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.33 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 4.16-4.05 (m, 1H), 3.82-3.75 (m, 2H), 3.52-3.46 (m, 2H), 3.20-3.13 (m, 1H), 2.92-2.76 (m, 1H), 2.36-2.26 (m, 1H), 1.95-1.87 (m, 1H).
  • Step 3: (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00038
  • To a stirred solution of R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine trifluoroacetate from the previous step (ca. 2.72 mmol) and triethylamine (2.1 mL, 15 mmol) in acetonitrile (20 mL) was added 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate (750 mg, 2.85 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hr at room temperature. Then the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate (100 mL), washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (DCM/MeOH=35/1) to afford the title compound as an off-white powder (840 mg, 75%). [α]D=+13.5° (c=10 mg/mL, MeOH, 20° C.). HPLC Chiral Purity >99% ee (CHIRALPAKAD-H 4.6*150 mm, 5 um; Mobile Phase: Hexane:Isopropanol=80:20; rt=6.88 min). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O6: 416.2; found: 417.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.11 (s, 1H), 7.71 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.34 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.26 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.19 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.11 (s, 2H), 4.38-4.26 (m, 1H), 4.18-4.14 (m, 1H), 4.01 (dd, J=5.2, 13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.62 (dd, J=8.8, 13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.29-3.11 (m, 1H), 3.03-2.89 (m, 1H), 2.65-2.50 (m, 1H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.00-1.94 (m, 1H), 1.62-1.52 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.1a. R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-1.2a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00039
  • To a stirred solution of (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)-methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (1.8 g, 4.32 mmol) in 30 mL DCM/MeOH (1/1) was added methanesulfonic acid (420 mg, 4.32 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. The solvent was evaporated, and the solid thus obtained was triturated with ether (25 mL) to give the title compound as a white solid (1.90 g, 86%). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O6: 416.2; found: 417.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.33 (s, 1H), 7.96 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.27 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.26 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.19 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.12 (s, 2H), 4.47-4.33 (m, 1H), 4.27-4.21 (m, 1H), 4.07-3.99 (m, 1H), 3.75-3.65 (m, 1H), 3.30-3.14 (m, 1H), 3.08-2.92 (m, 1H), 2.72 (s, 3H), 2.70-2.60 (m, 1H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.08-2.00 (m, 1H), 1.67-1.56 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.2. (±)-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (C-1.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00040
  • Step 1: methyl 2-(1-benzyl-3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-ylidene)acetate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00041
  • To a stirred solution of 1-benzyl-3,3-difluoropiperidine-4,4-diol (10.9 g, 44.8 mmol) in toluene (350 mL) was added methyl (triphenylphosphoranylidene)acetate (18.0 g, 52 mmol) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 hrs. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and purified by column chromatography over silica gel (EtOAc/hexane=1/6) to afford the title compound as a white powder (10.9 g, 86%). MS (ESI) calcd for C15H17F2NO2: 281.1; found: 282.3 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.36-7.27 (m, 5H), 6.19 (br s, 1H), 3.74 (s, 3H), 3.64 (s, 2H), 3.14-3.11 (m, 2H), 2.79 (t, J=11.2 Hz, 2H), 2.60 (t, J=5.6 Hz, 2H).
  • Step 2: methyl 2-(3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)acetate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00042
  • To a stirred solution of methyl 2-(1-benzyl-3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-ylidene)acetate (10.9 g, 39 mmol) in MeOH (200 mL) was added 10% Pd/C (1.0 g, 10%). The reaction mixture was purged with H2 three times, and hydrogenated at room temperature under atmospheric pressure. After the starting material was consumed, the mixture was filtered through celite and the filter pad was extracted with MeOH. The combined filtrates were concentrated and the residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (EtOAc/hexane=1/6) to afford the title compound as a clear oil (5.30 g, 70%). MS (ESI) calcd for C8H13F2NO2: 193.1; found: 194.4 [M+H]. 1HNMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 3.67 (s, 3H), 3.20-3.11 (m, 1H), 3.03-2.99 (m, 1H), 2.83-2.70 (m, 2H), 2.66-2.56 (m, 1H), 2.46-2.29 (m, 1H), 2.25-2.19 (m, 1H), 1.90-1.82 (m, 1H), 1.64 (br s, 1H), 1.45-1.34 (m, 1H).
  • Step 3: 4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-(2-methoxy-2-oxoethyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00043
  • To a stirred solution of p-tolylmethanol (1.5 g, 12 mmol) in DMSO (20 mL) was added CDI (1.9 g, 11 mmol) at room temperature under N2 atmosphere. The mixture was stirred for 1 hr and methyl 2-(3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)acetate (2.0 g, 10 mmol) was added in DMSO (10 mL) at room temperature. The mixture was heated at 50° C. overnight, allowed to cool to room temperature and diluted with EtOAc. The organic layer was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (EtOAc/hexane=1/6) to afford the title compound as a clear oil (1.5 g, 43%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.26 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (br s, 2H), 4.64 (d, J=5.2 Hz, 1H), 4.54-4.06 (m, 2H), 3.69 (d, J=12.0 Hz, 2H), 3.12-2.73 (m, 2H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.29-2.22 (m, 1H), 1.92-1.65 (m, 1H), 1.59 (s, 3H).
  • Step 4: 2-(3,3-difluoro-1-((4-methylbenzyloxy)carbonyl)piperidin-4-yl)acetic acid
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00044
  • To a stirred solution of 4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-(2-methoxy-2-oxoethyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (1.5 g, 4.4 mmol) in THF (20 mL) was added aqueous NaOH (1 M, 20 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 5 hr and quenched with 1N HCl under ice-water bath cooling. The mixture was concentrated and extracted with ethyl acetate. The ethyl acetate layer was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated to afford the title compound as a white solid (650 mg, 46%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.25 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.16 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.08 (s, 2H), 4.16 (br s, 2H), 2.91-2.71 (m, 2H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.31-2.26 (m, 1H), 2.01-1.88 (m, 1H), 1.80-1.69 (m, 1H), 1.25-1.14 (m, 2H).
  • Step 5: 4-methylbenzyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00045
  • To a stirred solution of 2-(3,3-difluoro-1-((4-methylbenzyloxy)carbonyl)piperidin-4-yl)acetic acid (650 mg, 1.98 mmol) in toluene (3 mL) was added triethylamine (93 mg, 1.0 mmol) and DPPA (187 mg, 2.98 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at 70° C. for 1 hr. A mixture of dioxane (3 mL) and 1M aqueous NaOH (3 mL) was added and the reaction mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature. The mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and diluted with EtOAc. The organic layer was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated. The residue was taken up in dichloromethane and filtered. The filtrate was concentrated to afford crude product as a yellow oil (600 mg). MS (ESI) calcd for C15H20F2N2O2: 298.2; found: 299.2 [M+H].
  • Step 6: (±)-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00046
  • A mixture of crude 4-methylbenzyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (600 mg, 2.0 mmol), 8-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazine (360 mg, 2.0 mmol) and DIPEA (0.76 mL, 4.0 mmol) in butyl alcohol (10 mL) was heated at 130° C. overnight. The mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and concentrated under reduced pressure. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (100% ethyl acetate) to afford the title compound as a light gray powder (150 mg, 18%). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O2: 416.2; found: 417.3 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.16 (s, 1H), 7.77 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.33 (br s, 1H), 4.19-4.15 (m, 1H), 4.05-3.95 (m, 1H), 3.72-3.58 (m, 1H), 3.25-2.90 (m, 2H), 2.67-2.51 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.99-1.93 (m, 1H), 1.62-1.52 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.3. (−)-S-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E2-1.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00047
  • (±)-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate was separated by chiral HPLC [CHIRALPAKAD-H4.6*150 mm, 5 um. Mobile phase: A:Hexanes B:(Ethanol/Methanol=2:1)=70:30] to give the respective pure enantiomers with (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate eluting first (rt=7.065 min) followed by (−)-S-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (rt=9.160 min).
  • (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate. CHIRALPAKAD rt=7.065 min, α20 D=+13.5° (c=10 mg/mL, MeOH).
  • (−)-S-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate. CHIRALPAKAD rt=9.160 min, α20 D=−12.0° (c=10 mg/mL, MeOH).
  • Example. 1.4. 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-2.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00048
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00049
  • A mixture of R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (300 mg, 1.20 mmol), 5-bromo-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazine (356 mg, 1.80 mmol) and DIPEA (0.42 mL, 2.40 mmol) in NMP (9 mL) was heated to 130° C. with stirring overnight. The orange solution was allowed to cool down to rt and diluted with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated under vacuum. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (hexane/ethyl acetate=1/3) to afford the title compound as a yellow powder (210 mg, 48%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.25 (s, 1H), 8.85 (s, 1H), 7.27 (s, 1H), 6.17-6.01 (m, 1H), 4.51-4.17 (m, 2H), 3.93-3.84 (m, 1H), 3.52-3.44 (m, 1H), 3.11-2.71 (m, 2H), 2.52-2.37 (m, 1H), 2.03-1.92 (m, 1H), 1.73-1.63 (m, 1H), 1.48 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-amine trifluoroacetate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00050
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (256 mg, 0.69 mmol) in dichloromethane (5 mL) was added TFA (2 mL) at room temperature. After stirring for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as a yellow oil which was directly used as crude salt in the next step. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.38 (s, 1H), 8.71 (s, 1H), 7.33 (s, 1H), 3.99-3.92 (m, 1H), 3.84-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.57-3.46 (m, 3H), 3.18-3.11 (m, 1H), 2.83-2.69 (m, 1H), 2.40-2.33 (m, 1H), 1.92-1.81 (m, 1H).
  • Step 3: R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00051
  • To a solution of 2,5-dioxocyclopentyl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate (201 mg, 0.76 mmol) in MeCN (5 mL) was added R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-amine trifluoroacetate (470 mg, 0.69 mmol) and triethylamine (0.32 mL, 2.30 mmol) at room temperature. After stirring for 1 hr, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc. The organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated under vacuum. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (DCM/MeOH=40/1) to afford the title compound as a yellow powder (126 mg, two steps yield 43.6%). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O2: 416.2; found: 417.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.33 (s, 1H), 8.64 (s, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.23 (s, 1H), 7.16 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.10 (s, 2H), 4.40-4.29 (m, 1H), 4.23-4.14 (m, 1H), 3.86 (dd, J=4.8 and 14.4 Hz, 1H), 3.41 (dd, J=4.8 and 14.4 Hz, 1H), 3.30-2.15 (m, 1H), 3.05-2.88 (m, 1H), 2.61-2.47 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 2.10-2.00 (m, 1H), 1.65-1.53 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.4a. R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-2.2a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00052
  • To a solution of R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-5-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (127 mg, 0.31 mmol) in MeOH (3 mL) was added methanesulfonic acid (29 mg, 0.30 mmol). After stirring for 1 h at rt, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as a white powder (131 mg, 84%). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O2: 416.2; found: 417.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.58 (s, 1H), 8.85 (s, 1H), 7.70 (s, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.10 (s, 2H), 4.45-4.30 (m, 1H), 4.24-4.18 (m, 1H), 3.95 (dd, J=5.2 and 14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.57 (dd, J=8.0 and 14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.26-2.90 (m, 2H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.64-2.51 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 2.11-2.02 (m, 1H), 1.67-1.54 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.5. (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyridin-2-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-9.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00053
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyridin-2-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00054
  • To a stirred suspension of 2-bromo-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyridine (500 mg, 2.53 mmol) in t-butyl alcohol (15 mL) were added (−)-R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoro piperidine-1-carboxylate (758 mg, 3.03 mmol), Brettphos precatalyst (75 mg), Brettphos (75 mg) and Cs2CO3 (2.25 g, 5.06 mmol) at room temperature under nitrogen. The reaction mixture was heated to 100° C. overnight. The mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature, diluted with DCM and filtered through celite. The filtrate was washed with water, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (50% hexanes in EtOAc) to afford the title compound as an off-white powder (298 mg, 32%). MS (ESI) calcd for C17H23F2N5O2: 367.2; found: 368.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.45 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 1H), 7.53-7.48 (m, 1H), 7.37 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 6.96-6.92 (m, 1H), 4.28-4.14 (m, 1H), 4.12-4.04 (m, 1H), 3.77 (dd, J=14, 4.8 Hz, 1H), 3.36-3.33 (m, 1H), 3.18-3.07 (m, 1H), 2.92-2.84 (m, 1H), 2.48-2.35 (m, 1H), 1.98-1.91 (m, 1H), 1.56-1.48 (m, 1H), 1.47 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyridin-2-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00055
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyridin-2-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (230 mg, 0.63 mmol) in DCM (6 mL) was added TFA (2 mL). The reaction solution was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. The solvent was evaporated to afford the intermediate R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]-triazolo[1,5-a]pyridin-2-amine trifluoroacetic acid salt as a yellow oil (260 mg) which was used in the next step without further purification. To a stirred solution of R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]-triazolo[1,5-a]pyridin-2-amine trifluoroacetate salt (260 mg) in acetonitrile (5 mL) were added triethylamine (0.26 mL) and 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate (181 mg, 0.69 mmol). After stirring for 1 h at room temperature, the reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was taken up in EtOAc. The solution was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (50% hexanes in EtOAc) to afford the title compound as a white powder (234 mg, 90%). [α]D=+26.2° (c=7.5 mg/mL, MeOH, 28° C.). MS (ESI) calcd for C21H23F2N5O2: 415.2; found: 416.6 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.44 (d, J=6.4 Hz, 1H), 7.52-7.48 (m, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 6.95-6.92 (m, 1H), 5.12-5.06 (m, 2H), 4.34-4.22 (m, 1H), 4.16-4.11 (m, 1H), 3.77 (dd, J=14, 4.8 Hz, 1H), 3.36-3.31 (m, 1H), 3.25-3.09 (m, 1H), 3.00-2.89 (m, 1H), 2.51-2.38 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 2.00-1.92 (m, 1H), 1.57-1.46 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.6. (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl-4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-8.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00056
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00057
  • A mixture of R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (440 mg, 1.60 mmol), 6-chloro-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidine (272 mg, 1.76 mmol) and DIPEA (0.84 mL, 4.80 mmol) in i-PrOH (10 mL) was heated overnight at 85° C. The mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and was concentrated under reduced pressure. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (hexane/ethyl acetate=1/3) to afford the title compound as a yellow powder (510 mg, 86%). MS (ESI) calcd for C16H22F2N6O2: 368.2; found: 369.4 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 10.88 (brs, 1H), 8.78 (s, 1H), 7.92 (s, 1H), 5.77-5.67 (m, 1H), 4.50-4.00 (m, 2H), 3.90-3.84 (m, 1H), 3.67-3.58 (m, 1H), 3.07-2.68 (m, 2H), 2.38-2.23 (m, 1H), 1.91-1.85 (m, 1H), 1.62-1.56 (m, 1H), 1.46 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-amine hydrochloride
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00058
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (510 mg, 1.39 mmol) in DCM (4 mL) was added HCl in MeOH (10 mL, 2.0 M) at room temperature. After stirring overnight, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as a pale-yellow powder (504 mg, 100%) which was used in the next step without further purification. MS (ESI) calcd for C11H14F2N6: 268.1; found: 269.2 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.09 (s, 1H), 8.33 (s, 1H), 4.04 (dd, J=5.2, 14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.81-3.73 (m, 1H), 3.63-3.46 (m, 3H), 3.21-3.13 (m, 1H), 2.83-2.69 (m, 1H), 2.33-2.24 (m, 1H), 1.90-1.79 (m, 1H).
  • Step 3: (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl-4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00059
  • To a solution of p-tolylmethanol (263 mg, 2.15 mmol) in DMSO (4 mL) was added CDI (349 mg, 2.15 mmol) at room temperature. After stirring for 1 hr, R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)-methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-amine hydrochloride (504 mg, 1.66 mmol) was added. The mixture was heated to 80° C. under N2 atmosphere. After stirring overnight, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc. The organic phase was washed with water and brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated under vacuum. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (DCM/MeOH=40/1) to afford the title compound as a white powder (306 mg, 49%). [α]D=+22° (c=8.5 mg/mL, 50% DCM in MeOH, 26° C.). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O2: 416.2; found: 417.4 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.77 (s, 1H), 7.92 (s, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.33-4.23 (m, 1H), 4.16-4.10 (m, 1H), 3.87 (dd, J=5.2 and 14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.47-3.39 (m, 1H), 3.25-3.10 (m, 1H), 3.02-2.87 (m, 1H), 2.54-2.40 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.95-1.88 (m, 1H), 1.58-1.47 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.6a. (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-8.2a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00060
  • To a solution of R-4-methylbenzyl4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (184 mg, 0.44 mmol) in DCM/MeOH (12 mL/4 mL) was added methanesulfonic acid (43 mg, 0.44 mmol). After stirring for 1 h at rt, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as a white powder (191 mg, 84%). [α]D=+11.2° (c=10 mg/mL, 50% DCM in MeOH, 26° C.). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O2: 416.2; found: 417.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.03 (s, 1H), 8.29 (s, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.37-4.27 (m, 1H), 4.20-4.13 (m, 1H), 3.94 (dd, J=5.2 and 14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.58-3.53 (m, 1H), 3.24-3.10 (m, 1H), 3.03-2.92 (m, 1H), 2.72 (s, 3H), 2.56-2.44 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.99-1.90 (m, 1H), 1.61-1.50 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.7. R-4-chlorobenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-1.3)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00061
  • To a stirred solution of of 4-chlorobenzyl alcohol (115 mg, 0.81 mmol) and bis-(2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl)carbonate (207 mg, 0.81 mmol) in acetonitrile (3.0 mL) and CH2Cl2 (3.0 mL) was added 4-dimethylaminopyridine (49 mg, 0.40 mmol) and the mixture was stirred for 2 h at room temperature. N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine trifluoroacetate salt (280 mg, 0.73 mmol) in MeCN (2 mL) and TEA (0.3 mL, 2.2 mmol) were added and the resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hour at room temperature. The mixture was then diluted with ethyl acetate (5 mL) and the organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (DCM/MeOH=50/1) to afford the title compound as a pale yellow powder (190 mg, 59%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H19ClF2N6O2: 436.1, 438.1; found: 437.4, 439.4 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.08 (s, 1H), 7.69 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.39-7.33 (m, 4H), 7.32 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 5.16-5.09 (m, 2H), 4.37-4.26 (m, 1H), 4.19-4.11 (m, 1H), 4.01-3.95 (m, 1H), 3.65-3.57 (m, 1H), 3.27-3.07 (m, 1H), 3.07-2.88 (m, 1H), 2.65-2.47 (m, 1H), 1.99-1.91 (m, 1H), 1.63-1.49 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.7a. R-4-chlorobenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-1.3a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00062
  • To a stirred solution of R-4-chlorobenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (99 mg, 0.23 mmol) in MeOH (2.0 mL) was added CH3SO3H (22 mg, 0.23 mmol) at rt. After stirring for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as an off-white powder (116 mg, 96%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H19ClF2N6O2: 436.1, 438.4; found: 437.4, 439.4[M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.31 (s, 1H), 7.94 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.36 (s, 4H), 7.25 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 5.19-5.09 (m, 2H), 4.44-4.33 (m, 1H), 4.26-4.18 (m, 1H), 4.06-3.96 (m, 1H), 3.73-3.62 (m, 1H), 3.29-3.14 (m, 1H), 3.11-2.91 (m, 1H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.68-2.58 (m, 1H), 2.07-1.99 (m, 1H), 1.66-1.53 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.8. R-4-fluorobenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-1.4)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00063
  • To a stirred solution of 4-fluorobenzyl alcohol (300 mg, 2.38 mmol) in DCM-MeCN (1:1 v/v, 10 mL) were added N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate (610 mg, 2.38 mmol) and DMAP (145 mg, 1.19 mmol) at ambient temperature. A clear solution was gradually obtained, and the mixture was stirred for 1 h at room temperature. Triethylamine (1.0 mL, 7.1 mmol) was then added followed by R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine TFA salt (780 mg, 2.14 mmol) in acetonitrile (3 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hr at room temperature and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate and the organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate) to afford the title compound as an off-white powder (446 mg, 50%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H19F3N6O2: 420.2; found: 421.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.71 (s, 1H), 7.40 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.36-7.31 (m, 3H), 7.04 (t, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 6.51-6.51 (m, 1H), 5.11 (s, 2H), 4.54-4.10 (m, 2H), 4.04-3.96 (m, 1H), 3.82-3.72 (m, 1H), 3.14-2.96 (m, 1H), 2.94-2.78 (m, 1H), 2.49-2.33 (m, 1H), 1.95-1.87 (m, 1H), 1.71-1.61 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.8a. R-4-fluorobenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-1.4a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00064
  • To a stirred solution of R-4-fluorobenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)-methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (446 mg, 1.06 mmol) in DCM/MeOH (6 mL, 1:1) was added methylsulfonic acid (102 mg, 1.06 mmol) at room temperature. After stirring for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated. The obtained solid was washed with ether to afford the title compound as a pale brown solid (510 mg, 93%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H19F3N6O2: 420.2; found: 421.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.31 (s, 1H), 7.94 (d, J=5.6 Hz, 1H), 7.43-7.37 (m, 2H), 7.25 (d, J=5.6 Hz, 1H), 7.09 (t, J=8.8 Hz, 2H), 5.13 (s, 2H), 4.43-4.32 (m, 1H), 4.24-4.17 (m, 1H), 4.06-3.95 (m, 1H), 3.73-3.63 (m, 1H), 3.32-3.10 (m, 1H), 3.09-2.92 (m, 1H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.68-2.58 (m, 1H), 2.06-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.65-1.53 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.9. (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrimidin-2-ylamino)methyl)-piperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-22.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00065
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrimidin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00066
  • A solution of 2-chloropyrimidine (206 mg, 1.8 mmol), R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (500 mg, 1.8 mmol) and DIPEA (0.63 mL, 3.6 mmol) in n-BuOH (5 mL) was heated to 95° C. in a sealed tube overnight with stirring. The mixture was allowed to cool to rt and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate and the organic phase was washed with water and brine. The organic phase was dried over sodium sulfate, and concentrated in vacuo. The concentrate was treated with hexane and ethyl acetate (1.5 mL+5 mL). The resulting suspension was filtered to afford the title compound as an off-white powder (420 mg, 71%). MS (ESI) calcd for C15H22F2N4O2: 328.2; found: 329.3[M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.27 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 2H), 6.55 (t, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 5.35-5.29 (m, 1H), 4.45-4.03 (m, 2H), 3.82-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.57-3.47 (m, 1H), 3.06-2.67 (m, 2H), 2.31-2.16 (m, 1H), 1.88-1.79 (m, 1H), 1.62-1.52 (m, 1H), 1.46 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)pyrimidin-2-amine hydrochloride
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00067
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrimidin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (410 mg, 1.24 mmol) in dichloromethane (2 mL) was added 2N methanolic HCl (7 mL) at room temperature. After stirring overnight at ambient temperature, the mixture was concentrated in vacuo to afford the title compound (285 mg, 76%) which was directly used in the next step. MS (ESI) calcd for C10H14F2N4: 228.1; found: 229.3[M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.95-8.43 (m, 2H), 7.10 (t, J=5.6 Hz, 1H), 4.03 (dd, J=14.0, 5.6 Hz, 1H), 3.82-3.74 (m, 1H), 3.68 (dd, J=14.0, 5.6 Hz, 1H), 3.59-3.48 (m, 2H), 3.23-3.15 (m, 1H), 2.82-2.67 (m, 1H), 2.34-2.24 (m, 1H), 1.91-1.78 (m, 1H).
  • Step 3: (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrimidin-2-ylamino)methyl)-piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00068
  • To a stirred solution of 4-methylbenzyl alcohol (199 mg, 1.62 mmol) in DMSO (5 mL) was added CDI (263 mg, 1.62 mmol). After stirring for 1 h at rt, (3,3-difluoro-piperidin-4-ylmethyl)-pyrimidin-2-yl-amine dihydrochloride (285 mg, 0.95 mmol) was added, and the reaction mixture was stirred overnight at 80° C. The reaction mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate, and the organic phase was washed with water and brine. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate, and concentrated in vacuo. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (hexane/EtOAc=1:1) to afford the title compound as a white powder (135 mg, 38%). %). [α]D=+10.5° (c=3.7 mg/mL, MeOH, 26° C.). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H22F2N4O2: 376.2; found: 377.4 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.27 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 2H), 7.25 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 6.55 (t, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 5.37-5.26 (m, 1H), 5.16-5.05 (m, 2H), 4.57-4.10 (m, 2H), 3.84-3.74 (m, 1H), 3.59-3.47 (m, 1H), 3.12-2.76 (m, 2H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.32-2.17 (m, 1H), 1.92-1.78 (m, 1H), 1.62-1.52 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.9a. R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrimidin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-22.2a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00069
  • To a stirred solution of (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrimidin-2-ylamino)methyl)-piperidine-1-carboxylate (123 mg, 0.33 mmol) in MeOH (2.0 mL) was added CH3SO3H (32 mg, 0.33 mmol) at rt. After stirring for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as an off-white powder (150 mg, 97%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H22F2N4O2: 376.2; found: 377.4[M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.90-8.40 (m, 2H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.00 (t, J=5.6 Hz, 1H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.39-4.25 (m, 1H), 4.21-4.12 (m, 1H), 3.91 (dd, J=5.6 and 14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.57 (dd, J=7.6 and 14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.27-3.08 (m, 1H), 3.06-2.87 (m, 1H), 2.71 (s, 3H), 2.54-2.39 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.97-1.89 (m, 1H), 1.60-1.48 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.10. R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-21.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00070
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl) piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00071
  • A mixture of R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (200 mg, 0.80 mmol), 2-bromopyrazine (140 mg, 0.88 mmol) and DIPEA (0.42 mL, 2.40 mmol) in NMP (6 mL) was heated with stirring overnight at 130° C. The mixture was allowed to cool to rt, and diluted with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was washed with water and brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated under vacuum. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (hexane/ethyl acetate=1/1) to afford the title compound as a yellow oil (196 mg, 50%). MS (ESI) calcd for C15H22F2N4O2: 328.2; found: 329.2[M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.98 (dd, J=2.8 and 1.2 Hz, 1H), 7.89 (d, J=1.2 Hz, 1H), 7.81 (d, J=2.8 Hz, 1H), 4.80-4.70 (m, 1H), 4.45-4.10 (m, 2H), 3.76-3.69 (m, 1H), 3.57-3.49 (m, 1H), 3.04-2.70 (m, 2H), 2.31-2.16 (m, 1H), 1.87-1.79 (m, 1H), 1.63-1.53 (m, 1H), 1.47 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00072
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)-piperidine-1-carboxylate (196 mg, 0.59 mmol) in DCM (3 mL) was added TFA (2 mL) at room temperature. After stirring for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated to afford crude product R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)pyrazin-2-amine trifluoroacetate as a yellow oil which was directly used in the next step without further purification. To a solution of the crude R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)pyrazin-2-amine trifluoroacetate in MeCN (6 mL) were added triethylamine (0.8 mL, 5.8 mmol) and 2,5-dioxocyclopentyl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate (386 mg, 1.44 mmol) at room temperature. After stirring for 1 hr, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc. The organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated under vacuum. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (100% EtOAc) to afford the title compound as a yellow oil (167 mg, 52%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H22F2N4O2:376.2; found: 377.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 7.97 (dd, J=2.8 and 1.2 Hz, 1H), 7.88 (d, J=1.2 Hz, 1H), 7.64 (d, J=2.8 Hz, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.31-4.21 (m, 1H), 4.17-4.07 (m, 1H), 3.76 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.2 Hz, 1H), 3.35 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.2 Hz, 1H), 3.27-2.85 (m, 2H), 2.44-2.34 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.96-1.85 (m, 1H), 1.54-1.43 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.10a. R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-21.2a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00073
  • To a solution of R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((pyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (118 mg, 0.31 mmol) in MeOH (2 mL) was added methanesulfonic acid (27 mg, 0.28 mmol). After stirring for 1 h at rt, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as a yellow powder (127 mg, 87%). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H22F2N4O2:376.2; found: 377.4 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.6 (dd, J=2.8 and 1.2 Hz, 1H), 8.23 (d, J=1.2 Hz, 1H), 7.85 (d, J=2.8 Hz, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.40-4.27 (m, 1H), 4.22-4.14 (m, 1H), 3.85 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.2 Hz, 1H), 3.49 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.2 Hz, 1H), 3.30-2.90 (m, 2H), 2.72 (s, 3H), 2.55-2.36 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.99-1.89 (m, 1H), 1.60-1.47 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.11. R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)-methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-21.26)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00074
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)-piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00075
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (188 mg, 0.75 mmol) in dioxane (3 mL) were added 2-chloro-5-methylpyrazine (100 mg, 0.78 mmol), Pd2(dba)3.CHCl3 (21 mg, 0.02 mmol), Xantphos (23 mg, 0.04 mmol) and Cs2CO3 (329 mg, 1.0 mmol). The mixture was heated to 90° C. under N2. After stirring overnight, the reaction solution was treated with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate/hexane=1/1) to afford the title compound as a pale-yellow powder (115 mg, 45%). MS (ESI) calcd for C16H24F2N4O2: 342.2; found: 343.4[M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.86 (s, 1H), 7.83 (s, 1H), 4.63-4.53 (m, 1H), 4.48-4.04 (m, 2H), 3.73-3.67 (m, 1H), 3.52-3.45 (m, 1H), 3.00-2.89 (m, 1H), 2.79-2.70 (m, 1H), 2.38 (s, 3H), 2.28-2.15 (m, 1H), 1.85-1.80 (m, 1H), 1.47 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)-methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00076
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (115 mg, 0.34 mmol) in DCM (3 mL) was added TFA (1 mL) at room temperature. After stirring for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated to afford R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-5-methylpyrazin-2-amine trifluoroacetate as a yellow oil which was directly used in the next step without further purification. To a solution of the crude R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-5-methylpyrazin-2-amine trifluoroacetate in MeCN (4 mL) were added triethylamine (1 mL) and 2,5-dioxocyclopentyl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate (98 mg, 0.37 mmol) at room temperature. After stirring for 1 hr, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc. The organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated under vacuum. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate/hexane=2/1) to afford the title compound as pale-yellow powder (61 mg, 46%). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H24F2N4O2:390.2; found: 391.2 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.86 (s, 1H), 7.82 (s, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.10 (s, 2H), 4.66-4.60 (m, 1H), 4.49-4.16 (m, 2H), 3.73-3.67 (m, 1H), 3.51-3.44 (m, 1H), 3.07-2.95 (m, 1H), 2.87-2.79 (m, 1H), 2.38 (s, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.30-2.18 (m, 1H), 1.85-1.81 (m, 1H), 1.63-1.53 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.11a. R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)methyl)-piperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-21.26a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00077
  • To a solution of R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((5-methylpyrazin-2-ylamino)-methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (54 mg, 0.138 mmol) in DCM (2 mL) was added methylsulfonic acid in MeOH (0.14 mL, 1.0 M, 0.14 mmol). After stirring for 15 min at rt, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as a pale-yellow powder (127 mg, 87%). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H24F2N4O2:390.2; found: 391.2 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.22 (s, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.37-4.26 (m, 1H), 4.19-4.15 (m, 1H), 3.82 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.6 Hz, 1H), 3.46 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.6 Hz, 1H), 3.30-3.12 (m, 1H), 3.02-2.91 (m, 1H), 2.71 (s, 3H), 2.48 (s, 3H), 2.46-2.36 (m, 1H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.95-1.91 (m, 1H), 1.58-1.48 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.12. R-4-fluorobenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-8.4)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00078
  • Step 1: R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-amine trifluoroacetate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00079
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (340 mg, 0.92 mmol) in DCM (5 mL) was added TFA (3 mL) at room temperature. After stirring for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated to afford the title compound as a pale-yellow oil which was used in the next step without further purification.
  • Step 2: R-4-fluorobenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00080
  • To a solution of R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-6-amine trifluoroacetate salt from the previous step (ca. 0.92 mmol) in MeCN (5 mL) was added triethylamine (0.6 mL, 4.6 mmol), followed by addition of 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl 4-fluorobenzyl carbonate (296 mg, 1.10 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hour at room temperature. Then the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate/hexane=1/1) to afford the title compound as an off white powder (160 mg, 41% for two steps). MS (ESI) calcd for C19H19F3N6O2: 420.2; found: 421.4 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.77 (s, 1H), 7.92 (s, 1H), 7.42-7.36 (m, 2H), 7.12-7.05 (m, 2H), 5.12 (s, 2H), 4.33-4.21 (m, 1H), 4.16-4.10 (m, 1H), 3.86 (dd, J=13.6 and 4.4 Hz, 1H), 3.50-3.43 (m, 1H), 3.25-2.85 (m, 2H), 2.54-2.40 (m, 1H), 1.95-1.88 (m, 1H), 1.58-1.47 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.13. R-4-methylbenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-6.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00081
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00082
  • To a stirred solution of R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (600 mg, 2.4 mmol) in n-BuOH (5 mL) were added 4-chloro-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidine (571 mg, 2.4 mmol) and DIPEA (0.84 mL, 4.8 mmol). The mixture was heated to 100° C. under nitrogen for 13 hours. The reaction mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate and the organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The concentrate was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate/hexane=1/1) to afford the title compound as a yellow powder (800 mg, 80%). MS (ESI) calcd for C21H30F2N6O3: 452.2; found: 453.6 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.42 (s, 1H), 7.95 (s, 1H), 5.98-5.95 (m, 1H), 5.81-5.60 (brs, 1H), 4.49-4.09 (m, 3H), 3.99-3.87 (m, 1H), 3.83-3.76 (m, 2H), 3.06-2.67 (m, 2H), 2.63-2.53 (m, 1H), 2.40-2.23 (m, 1H), 2.16-2.08 (m, 1H), 1.96-1.92 (m, 1H), 1.93-1.54 (m, 6H), 1.47 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-amine dihydrochloride salt
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00083
  • R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]-pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (0.80 g, 1.76 mmol) was dissolved in methanolic HCl solution (2N, 15 mL) at room temperature. After stirring overnight, the resulting reaction mixture was concentrated under reduce pressure to afford the title compound as a yellow solid (600 mg, 99%) which was used in the next step without further purification. MS (ESI) calcd for C11H14F2N6: 268.1; found: 269.2 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.72 (s, 1H), 8.64 (s, 1H), 4.19 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.6 Hz, 1H), 3.90 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.6 Hz, 1H), 3.83-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.61-3.48 (m, 2H), 3.24-3.18 (m, 1H), 2.93-2.78 (m, 1H), 2.35-2.29 (m, 1H), 1.94-1.84 (m, 1H).
  • Step 3: R-4-methylbenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00084
  • To a stirred solution of R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-amine dihydrochloride (400 mg, 1.17 mmol) and TEA (0.37 mL, 2.6 mmol) in a MeCN (15 mL) and DMF (4 mL) solvent mixture was added 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate (307 mg, 1.17 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hour at room temperature and then diluted with ethyl acetate (50 mL). The organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (DCM/MeOH=35/1) to afford the title compound as a yellow powder (250 mg, 51%). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O6: 416.2; found: 417.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.09 (s, 1H), 7.26 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.18 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.11 (s, 2H), 4.38-4.26 (brs, 1H), 4.18-4.12 (m, 1H), 3.99-3.95 (m, 1H), 3.67-3.61 (m, 1H), 3.28-3.10 (m, 1H), 3.03-2.89 (m, 1H), 2.60-2.44 (m, 1H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 1.96-1.93 (m, 1H), 1.60-1.49 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.13a. (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-6.2a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00085
  • To a stirred solution of R-4-methylbenzyl 4-((1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (230 mg, 0.55 mmol) in DCM (3 mL) was added a solution of methanesulfonic acid (53 mg, 0.55 mmol) in methanol (3 mL). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. The solvent was evaporated, and the solid thus obtained was triturated with ether (10 mL) and filtered to give the title compound as yellow powder (270 mg, 95%). [α]D=+13.5 (c=10 mg/mL, MeOH, 20° C.). MS (ESI) calcd for C20H22F2N6O6: 416.2; found: 417.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.55 (s, 1H), 8.50 (s, 1H), 7.26 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.19 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.11 (s, 2H), 4.41-4.29 (m, 1H), 4.23-4.15 (m, 1H), 4.11-4.06 (m, 1H), 3.84-3.78 (m, 1H), 3.26-3.14 (m, 1H), 3.07-2.91 (m, 1H), 2.72 (s, 3H), 2.63-2.50 (m, 1H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.00-1.92 (m, 1H), 1.64-1.53 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.14. (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-((7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-7.2)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00086
  • Step 1: R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00087
  • A mixture of 4-chloro-7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidine (615 mg, 1.99 mmol), R-tert-butyl 4-(aminomethyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (600 mg, 2.39 mmol) and DIPEA (0.66 mL, 3.99 mmol) in n-BuOH (8 mL) was heated to 130° C. under nitrogen atmosphere overnight. The mixture was allowed to cool to rt and concentrated under vacuum. The concentrate was partitioned into ethyl acetate and water. The organic layer was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (hexane/EtOAc=3/2) to afford the title compound as an off-white powder (850 mg, 82%). MS (ESI) calcd for C24H29F2N5O4S: 521.2; found: 522.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.44 (s, 1H), 8.07 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.47 (d, J=4.0 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 6.41 (d, J=4.0 Hz, 1H), 5.23-5.16 (m, 1H), 4.45-4.25 (m, 2H), 3.88-3.70 (m, 2H), 3.02-2.67 (m, 2H), 2.39 (s, 3H), 2.35-2.19 (m, 1H), 1.85-1.77 (m, 1H), 1.62-1.50 (m, 1H), 1.46 (s, 9H).
  • Step 2: R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-amine trifluoroacetate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00088
  • To a solution of R-tert-butyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (850 mg, 1.63 mmol) in DCM (8 mL) was added TFA (4 mL). The resulting solution was stirred for 30 min at room temperature and then concentrated under vacuum to give the title compound (2.19 g) which was directly used in the next step without further purification. MS (ESI) calcd for C19H21F2N5O2S: 421.1; found: 422.7 [M+H].
  • Step 3: R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00089
  • The crude R—N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-amine trifluoroacetate salt (2.19 g, ca. 1.6 mmol) was dissolved in acetonitrile (9 mL), followed by addition of triethylamine (1.2 mL, 8.16 mmol). Then 2,5-dioxocyclopentyl 4-methylbenzyl carbonate (515 mg, 1.95 mmol) was added and the resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The mixture was concentrated, and the concentrate was dissolved in ethyl acetate. The organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (hexane/EtOAc=3/2) to afford the title compound as a white powder (847 mg, 80%). MS (ESI) calcd for C28H29F2N5O4S: 569.2; found: 570.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.43 (s, 1H), 8.06 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.47 (d, J=4.0 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.24 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.16 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 6.40 (d, J=4.0 Hz, 1H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.13-5.05 (m, 2H), 4.55-4.10 (m, 2H), 3.87-3.71 (m, 1H), 3.07-2.90 (m, 1H), 2.87-2.74 (m, 1H), 2.39 (s, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.37-2.22 (m, 2H), 1.87-1.77 (m, 1H), 1.64-1.51 (m, 1H).
  • Step 4: (+)-R-4-methylbenzyl 4-((7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylat
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00090
  • To a solution of R-4-methylbenzyl 3,3-difluoro-4-((7-tosyl-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-4-ylamino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (777 mg, 1.36 mmol) in THF (8 mL) was added 50% aqueous NaOH (2 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred overnight at ambient temperature and concentrated under vacuum to remove the THF solvent. The residual solution was adjusted to pH=9 with HCl (6N) under ice-water bath cooling. The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. The combined organic phases were washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (hexane/acetone=1/1) to afford the title compound as a pale brown powder (390 mg, 70%). [α]D=+22.5° (c=10 mg/mL, MeOH, 26° C.). MS (ESI) calcd for C21H23F2N5O2: 415.2; found: 416.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 10.08-9.98 (brs, 1H), 8.34 (s, 1H), 7.25 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.07 (d, J=2.7 Hz, 1H), 6.37 (d, J=2.7 Hz, 1H), 5.31-5.25 (m, 1H), 5.14-5.07 (s, 2H), 4.56-4.10 (m, 2H), 3.98-3.89 (m, 1H), 3.88-3.77 (m, 1H), 3.12-2.93 (m, 1H), 2.91-2.77 (m, 1H), 2.45-2.28 (m, 1H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 1.95-1.85 (m, 1H), 1.70-1.56 (m, 1H).
  • Example 1.15. R-4-ethylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (E1-1.5)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00091
  • To a solution of previously described crude N-((3,3-difluoropiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-amine trifluoroacetate (373 mg, ca. 1.0 mmol) in MeCN (5 mL) was added TEA (0.7 mL, 5.05 mmol), followed by 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl 4-ethylbenzyl carbonate (335.8 mg, 1.21 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hour at room temperature. The mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate and the organic phase was washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by column chromatography over silica gel (ethyl acetate/hexane=1/1) to afford the title compound as an off white powder (302 mg). MS (ESI) calcd for C21H24F2N6O2: 430.2; found: 431.4 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.08 (s, 1H), 7.69 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.32 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 7.26 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.19 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.10 (s, 2H), 4.37-4.26 (m, 1H), 4.19-4.11 (m, 1H), 3.98 (dd, J=14.0 and 5.2 Hz, 1H), 3.62 (dd, J=14.0 and 8.4 Hz, 1H), 3.27-3.07 (m, 1H), 3.07-2.88 (m, 1H), 2.64 (q, J=7.6 Hz, 2H), 2.59-2.48 (m, 1H), 1.98-1.93 (m, 1H), 1.61-1.51 (m, 1H), 1.22 (t, J=7.6 Hz, 3H).
  • Example 1.15a. (+)-R-4-ethylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate methanesulfonate (E1-1.5a)
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00092
  • To a stirred solution of R-4-ethylbenzyl 4-(([1,2,4]triazolo[4,3-a]pyrazin-8-ylamino)-methyl)-3,3-difluoropiperidine-1-carboxylate (302 mg, 0.70 mmol) in MeOH/DCM (4.0 mL, v/v=1:1) was added a solution of CH3SO3H (68 mg, 0.70 mmol) in methanol (1 mL) at rt. After stirred for 30 min, the mixture was concentrated to afford the product as off-white powder (335 mg, 90.6%). [α]D=+2.40 (c=10 mg/mL, MeOH, 23° C.). MS (ESI) calcd for C21H24F2N6O2: 430.2; found: 431.5 [M+H]. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 9.32 (s, 1H), 7.95 (d, J=5.6 Hz, 1H), 7.27 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.24 (d, J=5.6 Hz, 1H), 7.19 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.10 (s, 2H), 4.45-4.36 (m, 1H), 4.24-4.20 (m, 1H), 4.04-3.99 (m, 1H), 3.71-3.66 (m, 1H), 3.25-2.93 (m, 2H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.68-2.60 (m, 3H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.65-1.55 (m, 1H), 1.22 (t, J=7.6 Hz, 3H).
  • Example 1.16 Single Crystal X-Ray Diffraction (SCXRD) of (R)-XVIa
  • Data were collected on a Oxford Diffraction Supernova Dual Source, Cu at Zero, Atlas CCD diffractometer equipped with an Oxford Cryosystems Cobra cooling device. The data was collected using CuKα radiation. Structures were typically solved using either the SHELXS or SHELXD programs and refined with the SHELXL program as part of the Bruker AXS SHELXTL suite (V6.10). Unless otherwise stated, hydrogen atoms attached to carbon were placed geometrically and allowed to refine with a riding isotropic displacement parameter. Hydrogen atoms attached to a heteroatom were located in a difference Fourier synthesis and were allowed to refine freely with an isotropic displacement parameter.
  • A sample of (R)-XVIa was re-crystallized (ca. 10 mg) from 2-methyl-1-propanol (400 μL, 40 vol.) by slow evaporation at room temperature. A crystal of sufficient size and quality for analysis by single crystal X-ray diffraction was isolated with approximate dimensions 0.20×0.15×0.10 mm.
  • The structure was determined at 100 K in the orthorhombic system, space group P2 12121 with the final R1 [I>σ2(I)]=4.52%. A summary of all structural data can be found in Tables A through D. The compound was identified as a non-solvated form of (R)-XVIa.
  • TABLE A
    Sample and crystal data for (R)-XVIa.
    Crystallisation solvents 2-methyl-1-propanol
    Crystallisation method Slow evaporation
    Empirical formula C22H28F2N2O5
    Formula weight 438.46
    Temperature 100(2) K
    Wavelength 1.54178 Å
    Crystal size 0.200 × 0.150 × 0.100 mm
    Crystal habit Colourless Prism
    Crystal system Orthorhombic
    Space group P2 12121
    Unit cell dimensions a = 5.47256(9) Å α = 90°
    b = 11.73866(17) Å β = 90°
    c = 34.1360(5) Å γ = 90+
    Volume 2192.91(6) Å3
    Z 4
    Density (calculated) 1.328 Mg/m3
    Absorption coefficient 0.886 mm−1
    F(000) 928
  • TABLE B
    Data collection and structure refinement for (R)-XVIa.
    Diffractometer SuperNova, Dual, Cu at zero, Atlas
    Radiation source SuperNova (Cu) X-ray Source, CuKα
    Data collection method Omega scans
    Theta range for data 8.941 to 74.419°
    collection
    Index ranges −6 ≤ h ≤ 6, −14 ≤ k ≤14, −42 ≤/≤ 42
    Reflections collected 43577
    Independent reflections 4457 [R(int) = 0.0698]
    Coverage of independent 99.4%
    reflections
    Variation in check n/a
    reflections
    Absorption correction Semi-empirical from equivalents
    Max. and min. transmission 1.00000 and 0.56116
    Structure solution technique Direct methods
    Structure solution program SHELXTL (Sheldrick, 2013)
    Refinement technique Full-matrix least-squares on F2
    Refinement program SHELXTL (Sheldrick, 2013)
    Function minimized Σ w(Fo 2 − Fc 2)2
    Data/restraints/parameters 4457/0/283
    Goodness-of-fit on F2 1.082
    Δ/σmax 0.001
    Final R indices
    4253 data; I>2 
    Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-P00001
     (I)
    R1 = 0.0452, wR2 = 0.1191
    all data R1 = 0.0469, wR2 = 0.1207
    Weighting scheme w = 1/[σ2 (Fo 2) + (0.0637P)2 + 0.8591P]
    where P = (Fo 2 + 2Fc 2)/3
    Absolute structure −0.04(6)
    parameter
    Extinction coefficient n/a
    Largest diff. peak and hole 0.259 and −0.189 eÅ−3
  • TABLE C
    Atomic coordinates and equivalent isotropic atomic
    displacement parameters, (Å2), for (R)-XVIa.
    U(eq) is defined as one third of the trace of the
    orthogonalized Uij tensor.
    x/a y/b z/c U(eq)
    F1 0.7976(4)   0.47723(15) 0.84220(6) 0.0440(4)
    F2 1.1649(4)   0.49906(16) 0.86598(5) 0.0464(5)
    O1 0.7099(5)   0.31705(19) 0.73129(6) 0.0410(5)
    O2 0.8636(4)   0.49684(18) 0.73493(6) 0.0395(5)
    O3 1.0565(4)   0.12527(18) 0.91034(6) 0.0345(5)
    O4 0.4735(4)   0.32754(17) 0.95057(7) 0.0388(5)
    O5 0.4084(4)   0.17168(17) 0.98667(6) 0.0344(4)
    N1 0.9942(6)   0.3583(2) 0.77608(7) 0.0429(7)
    N2 0.7173(4)   0.16508(18) 0.94441(6) 0.0262(4)
    C1 0.5884(6)   0.3317(3) 0.69316(8) 0.0376(7)
    C2 0.4246(6)   0.4362(3) 0.69245(12) 0.0496(8)
    C3 0.7802(6)   0.3375(5) 0.66140(10) 0.0594(11)
    C4 0.4369(8)   0.2240(3) 0.68976(11) 0.0523(9)
    C5 0.8538(6)   0.3995(2) 0.74621(8) 0.0339(6)
    C6 1.1272(7)   0.4357(3) 0.80100(9) 0.0390(7)
    C7 1.0279(6)   0.4298(2) 0.84224(8) 0.0341(6)
    C8 1.0144(5)   0.3107(2) 0.85927(8) 0.0299(5)
    C9 0.8847(7)   0.2319(2) 0.83005(9) 0.0381(7)
    C10 0.9968(8)   0.2401(3) 0.78948(9) 0.0468(9)
    C11 0.8919(6)   0.3113(2) 0.89942(8) 0.0346(6)
    C12 0.9000(5)   0.1951(2) 0.91797(7) 0.0287(5)
    C13 0.5282(5)   0.2322(2) 0.95928(8) 0.0299(6)
    C14 0.5338(5)   0.0654(2) 0.99436(8) 0.0311(6)
    C15 0.6961(5)   0.0475(2) 0.95830(7) 0.0258(5)
    C16 0.5776(5) −0.0257(2) 0.92593(7) 0.0278(5)
    C17 0.5697(5) −0.1508(2) 0.93511(7) 0.0251(5)
    C18 0.7557(5) −0.2228(2) 0.92237(7) 0.0289(5)
    C19 0.7448(5) −0.3390(2) 0.92911(9) 0.0350(6)
    C20 0.5484(6) −0.3857(2) 0.94909(9) 0.0366(7)
    C21 0.3642(5) −0.3151(3) 0.96252(9) 0.0351(6)
    C22 0.3740(5) −0.1989(2) 0.95534(8) 0.0299(5)
  • TABLE D
    Anisotropic atomic displacement parameters, (Å2), for (R)-XVIa.
    The anisotropic atomic displacement factor exponent takes the form:
    −2π2 [h2a*2 U11 + . . . + 2hka* b* U12]
    U11 U22 U33 U23 U13 U12
    F1 0.0490(11) 0.0289(9) 0.0540(10) 0.0059(7) 0.0020(9) 0.0083(8)
    F2 0.0640(13) 0.0364(9) 0.0388(9) −0.0027(7) −0.0061(9) −0.0202(9)
    O1 0.0562(13) 0.0333(11) 0.0336(10) 0.0030(8) −0.0078(10) −0.0040(10)
    O2 0.0410(12) 0.0331(11) 0.0443(11) 0.0104(9) −0.0017(9) 0.0000(9)
    O3 0.0300(10) 0.0330(10) 0.0404(10) 0.0050(8) 0.0049(8) 0.0074(8)
    O4 0.0386(11) 0.0234(9) 0.0545(12) −0.0019(9) 0.0059(10) 0.0071(9)
    O5 0.0357(10) 0.0268(10) 0.0407(10) −0.0032(8) 0.0088(8) 0.0023(9)
    N1 0.069(2) 0.0284(12) 0.0314(12) 0.0003(9) −0.0113(12) −0.0010(13)
    N2 0.0277(10) 0.0208(10) 0.0302(10) −0.0009(8) 0.0004(8) 0.0033(9)
    C1 0.0307(14) 0.0498(18) 0.0324(13) 0.0041(12) −0.0014(11) 0.0035(14)
    C2 0.0293(16) 0.054(2) 0.066(2) 0.0023(17) −0.0032(15) 0.0043(15)
    C3 0.0282(15) 0.115(4) 0.0351(16) −0.0011(19) −0.0024(12) 0.008(2)
    C4 0.058(2) 0.049(2) 0.0497(18) −0.0038(15) −0.0136(17) −0.0017(18)
    C5 0.0416(16) 0.0313(14) 0.0289(13) 0.0023(10) 0.0036(11) 0.0043(12)
    C6 0.0492(18) 0.0319(15) 0.0357(14) 0.0021(11) −0.0038(13) −0.0055(14)
    C7 0.0411(16) 0.0257(13) 0.0356(14) −0.0023(11) −0.0062(12) −0.0054(12)
    C8 0.0338(13) 0.0253(12) 0.0306(12) 0.0002(10) −0.0041(10) 0.0006(11)
    C9 0.0512(18) 0.0211(13) 0.0421(15) 0.0027(11) −0.0147(13) −0.0042(13)
    C10 0.078(2) 0.0274(14) 0.0349(14) −0.0014(11) −0.0172(16) 0.0040(16)
    C11 0.0420(15) 0.0245(13) 0.0371(14) 0.0017(10) 0.0039(12) 0.0027(12)
    C12 0.0282(12) 0.0276(13) 0.0303(12) −0.0008(10) −0.0018(10) 0.0021(11)
    C13 0.0298(13) 0.0234(13) 0.0366(13) −0.0062(10) 0.0025(10) −0.0001(11)
    C14 0.0363(14) 0.0260(12) 0.0311(12) −0.0032(10) 0.0016(11) −0.0003(11)
    C15 0.0285(12) 0.0214(12) 0.0277(11) −0.0018(9) −0.0026(10) 0.0031(10)
    C16 0.0313(13) 0.0246(12) 0.0277(11) −0.0017(10) −0.0038(10) 0.0026(11)
    C17 0.0260(12) 0.0251(12) 0.0242(11) −0.0035(9) −0.0039(9) 0.0006(10)
    C18 0.0263(13) 0.0302(13) 0.0303(12) −0.0040(10) 0.0006(10) 0.0001(11)
    C19 0.0334(15) 0.0282(14) 0.0433(15) −0.0058(12) −0.0059(12) 0.0078(11)
    C20 0.0428(16) 0.0230(13) 0.0441(16) 0.0014(11) −0.0124(13) −0.0023(12)
    C21 0.0308(13) 0.0342(14) 0.0404(14) 0.0004(11) −0.0018(11) −0.0086(12)
    C22 0.0238(12) 0.0316(14) 0.0342(13) −0.0045(10) −0.0010(10) −0.0006(11)
  • The asymmetric unit contains a single fully ordered molecule of (R)-XVIa. Anisotropic atomic displacement ellipsoids for the non-hydrogen atoms are shown at the 50% probability level. Hydrogen atoms are displayed with an arbitrarily small radius (FIG. 11). For the structure as presented with C8 and C15 in the R configuration, the Flack parameter=−0.04(6) (Parsons and Flack, Acta Cryst. 2004, A60, s61). For the inverted structure with C8 and C15 in the S configuration, the Flack parameter=1.04(6). Determination of the absolute structure using Bayesian statistics on Bijvoet differences (Hooft et al., J. Appl. Cryst., 2008, 41, 96-103), reveals that the probability of the absolute structure as presented being correct is 1.000, while the probabilities of the absolute structure being a racemic twin or false are both 0.000. The Flack equivalent and its uncertainty are calculated through this program to be −0.01(5). The calculation was based on 1853 Bijvoet pairs with a coverage of 100%. Based on the Flack parameter, the bayesian statistic analysis and the a priori knowledge that the chirality at C15 is R the absolute stereochemistry.
  • Example 2. Assays Example 2.1. NR2B Antagonist Activity
  • HEK293 cell lines stably expressing cloned human NR1/NR2B and NR1/NR2A, respectively, were established according to standard previously described methods (Hansen et al., Comb. Chem High Throughput Screen. 11:304, 2008). Activation of the NR2A or NR2B subtype of NMDA receptor with glutamate as an agonist and glycine co-agonist on these cells results in calcium influx, which can be monitored with fluorescent indicator Fluo-4. A cell based assay has been implemented to evaluate the effect of a compound on NR2A and NR2B receptors by measuring the fluorescent changes (Hansen et al., Comb. Chem High Throughput Screen. 11:304, 2008).
  • HEK293 cells stably expressing NR2A or NR2B receptors were cultured at 37° C. in a humidified CO2 incubator in DMEM supplemented with 10% fetal bovine serum (FBS) (Hyclone), 10 μM MK801 (Sigma-Aldrich) and 50 μM AP-5 (Tocris). For experiments, the cells were seeded onto poly-D-lysine-coated 96-well black plates with clear bottom (Corning) at a density of ˜50,000 cells/well. After overnight culture, the growth medium was removed from the wells and the cells were incubated at 37° C. for 60 min in Hanks buffer containing 4 μM fluo-4-AM (Invitrogen) and 0.1% bovine serum albumin (BSA). After dye-loading, the cells were washed three times with Hanks buffer and incubated for 10 min at room temperature with various concentrations of test compounds prepared in Hanks buffer with 0.1% BSA. The cell plates were placed onto FDSS μCell fluorescence reader (Hamamatsu). After 20 sec reading of background fluorescence, agonist glutamate at final 100 μM and co-agonist glycine at final 50 μM were added to the cells to activate the receptor, and the resulting fluorescence changes were recorded and quantified. Based on the changes in fluorescence intensity, the pharmacological effect of test compounds were analyzed and the IC50 values derived from a non-linear least squares fitting of the concentration-dependent response to a standard logistic equation using Prism (Graphpad, Inc):

  • Amplitude=Max Amplitude/(1+(IC50/[antagonist])n).
  • Results are shown in the Table 2.1.
  • TABLE 2.1
    Cmpd. No. NR2B IC50 (nM) NR2A IC50
    E1-1.2  21.0 >10 μM
    E2-1.2 156 >10 μM
    E1-2.2  10.4 >10 μM
    E1-9.2  48.2 >10 μM
    E1-8.2  17 >10 μM
    E1-1.3  14.8 >10 μM
    E1-1.4  20.5 >10 μM
    E1-22.2  42.4 >10 μM
    E1-21.2  14.4 >10 μM
    E1-21.26  38.7 >10 μM
  • Example 2.1.1. Radioligand Binding Assay
  • This example describes NMDA receptor binding assays using two different radioligands, [3H] MK-801 and [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine (see below). An established binding assay using the non-selective NMDA receptor ligand [3H] MK-801 serves as a measure of total NMDA receptor binding activity across all NMD receptor subtypes in native rat brain receptors. The binding assay method using the NR2B selective receptor ligand [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine was adapted from a previously described cellular human NR2B cloned receptor assay (Kiss et al., Neurochemistry International. 46, p 453-464, 2005) to rat brain tissue. This assay serves as a selective measure of NR2B receptor binding activity in native rat brain receptors. Briefly, the brains of Male Wistar rats were homogenized (Polytron) before centrifugation at 40,000×g for 15 minutes at 4° C. After 2 washes, the final pellet was homogenized and stored at −80° C. The protein concentration was determined by Bradford assay.
  • Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00093
  • [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine
  • [3H] MK-801 was used at one concentration, 2 nM, with 400 μg of membrane proteins. Non-specific binding (NS) was assessed in presence of excess (10 μM) unlabelled MK-801. A single binding site was observed with a K1 value of 5.75 nM.
  • [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine was used at 2 different concentrations, 0.5 and 30 nM, with 30 μg of membrane proteins. Non-specific binding (NS) was assessed in presence of excess (10 μM) (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine. A high affinity site was identified, for which a Ki value of 0.18 nM was determined for (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine. Thus, using [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine as the NR2B receptor radioligand (Kiss et al., Neurochemistry International. 46, p 453-464, 2005), a Ki value of 1.0 nM at cloned NR2B receptors was determined. (Clairborne, C. F. Bioorganic and Medicinal Chemistry Letters, 13, 697-700, 2003) while using [3H]-ifenprodil as the NR2B receptor radioligand Ki value of 0.7 nM at cloned NR2B receptors (Curtis N. R. et al., Bioorganic and Medicinal Chemistry Letters, 13, 693-696, 2003).
  • Test compounds were solubilized at 10 mM in DMSO. Then the dilutions were performed with a constant solvent concentration (1% DMSO) in the assay.
  • After incubation for 4.5 h at room temperature, the assays were filtered on GF/B filters pretreated with 0.3% (v/v) PEI with a Brandel system for [3H] MK-801, and with a Packard system for [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine. The experiment was performed in duplicate (n=2).
  • Compound E1-1.2 exhibited only a partial effect (40%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-1.2 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (96%; Ki=5.23 nM).
  • Compound E2-1.2 exhibited only a partial effect (36%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E2-1.2 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (98%; Ki=74.3 nM).
  • Compound E1-1.3 exhibited only a partial effect (41%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-1.3 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (97%; Ki=2.34 nM).
  • Compound E1-1.4 exhibited only a partial effect (32%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-1.4 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (98%; Ki=18.2 nM).
  • Compound E1-1.5 exhibited only a partial effect (48%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-1.5 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (97%; Ki=0.854 nM).
  • Compound E1-8.2 exhibited only a partial effect (33%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-8.2 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (95%; Ki=1.71 nM).
  • Compound E1-9.2 exhibited only a partial effect (34%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-9.2 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (97%; Ki=11.3 nM).
  • Compound E1-21.2 exhibited only a partial effect (49%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-21.2 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (98%; Ki=0. 716 nM).
  • Compound E1-21.26 exhibited only a partial effect (41%) on [3H] MK-801 binding consistent with selective binding to the NR2B receptor subtype. Compound E1-21.26 exhibited a complete displacement of [3H] (E)-N1-(2-methoxybenzyl)-cinnamidine at the NR2B receptor high affinity site (99%; Ki=1. 02 nM).
  • Example 2.2. hERG Channel Inhibition
  • The assay was performed on hERG channel stably expressed in HEK293 cells. The cells were cultured at 37° C. in a humidified CO2 incubator in the growth medium consisting of DMEM, 10% fetal bovine serum and antibiotics. Prior to the assay, the cells were seeded onto a 12 mm PDL-coated glass coverslip and cultured in a 35 mm Petri dish. After 16 to 40 hr culture, the cover slip was transferred into the chamber of OctaFlow perfusion system (ALA Instrument) and under a constant flow of extracellular solution (140 mM NaCl, 4 mM KCl, 1 mM MgCl2, 2 mM CaCl2, 10 mM HEPES, 10 mM D-glucose, pH 7.35, osmolarity 290). Whole cell patch clamping was performed with a glass micropipette filled with intracellular solution (120 mM KCl, 1.75 mM MgCl2, 5.4 mM CaCl2, 10 mM HEPES, 10 mM EGTA, and 4 mM ATP-K2, PH 7.2, osmolarity 310). Giga-seal was maintained during the test. The voltage control and current measurement were carried out using Axon amplifier 700B, Digidata 1440A and CLAMPEX10 software (Molecular Devices). Whole-cell hERG currents were recorded following the Petroski protocol: the cell was held at −80 mV, and the voltage step jumped from −80 to 30 mV and stay for 2 sec with a 20 ms prepulse at −40 mV. After depolarization, the voltage was decreased to −40 mV and stay for 2 sec, and returned back to −80 mV. Test compound was applied by quartz capillary tubes tip (200 μm inner diameter), and the flow rate was controlled at 2-3 ml/min with OctaFlow perfusion system. Different concentrations of the compound were applied to the cells for 5 min and the hERG current was measured three times before, during and after compound treatment. The data were analyzed using Clampfit 10 software (Molecular Devices) to generate IC50 values. Results are shown in Table 2.2.
  • TABLE 2.2
    Cmpd. NR2B IC50 hERG IC50 hERG @
    No. (nM) (μM) 10 μM (%)
    LX-1  24    4.5 61
    E1-1.2  21.0   40 17
    E2-1.2 156 22
    E1-2.2  10.4 32
    E1-9.2  48.2 38
    E1-8.2  17    6.8 57
    E1-1.3  14.8 19
    E1-1.4  20.5 11
    E1-22.2  42.4 >10
    E1-21.2  14.4 27
    E1-21.26  38.7 39
  • Example 2.3. CYP P450 Enzyme Inhibition
  • Inhibitory activities of test compounds on 5 major isoforms of CYP P450 were evaluated by using pooled human liver microsome (HLM, purchased from BD Gentest) and selective substrates for those isoforms. Those CYP isoforms and their corresponding probe substrates are as follows: CYP1A2 (phenacetin, 30 μM), CYP2C9 (tolutamide, 100 μM), CYP2C19 (S-mephenytoin, 40 μM), CYP2D6 (dextromethorphan, 5 μM) and CYP3A4 (midazolam, 1 μM). All probe substrates were used at concentrations near or below their Kms. For experiment, a reaction mixture of test compound at 10 μM or in serial dilution, CYP probe substrate described above and 0.2 mg/mL pooled HLM in phosphate buffer, pH 7.4 in a final volume of 200 μL was pre-incubated at 37° C. for 10 minutes in triplicate. The reaction was initiated by addition of NADPH at final concentration of 1 mM. The reaction was terminated after 10 minutes (CYP1A2, CYP2D6 and CYP3A4) or 30 minutes (CYP2C9 and CYP2C19) by addition of 100 μL ice-cold acetonitrile with internal standard (IS). The samples were then centrifuged at 13,000 rpm and the supernatants were injected to LC-MS/MS (Agilent Technologies) to quantify the concentration of the specific metabolites of the probe substrates formed by individual CYP450 isoforms. The inhibition ratio is calculated as:

  • (M t −M 0)/M water×100%
  • in which Mt and M0 represent the concentrations of the specific probe substrate metabolite, which was formed by individual CYP450 isoform, at the beginning and end of the reaction in the presence of test compound; while Mwater represents the concentration of the specific metabolite at the end of the reaction in the absence of test compound. Test compound concentration-dependent response data experiments performed in triplicate. Mean CYP2D6 IC50 values were derived from non-linear, least-squares fitting of dose-dependent response data to a standard logistic equation (Prism, GraphPad Software, Inc) to generate the CYP2D6 IC50 results shown in Table 2.3
  • TABLE 2.3
    Cmpd. NR2B CYP2D6 CYP2D6 @
    No. IC50 (nM) IC50 (μM) 10 μM (%)
    LX-1  24 1.0 93
    E1-1.2  21.0 14
    E2-1.2 156
    E1-2.2  10.4 18
    E1-9.2  48.2 14
    E1-8.2  17 5.9 83
    E1-1.3  14.8 37
    E1-1.4  20.5 19
    E1-22.2  42.4
    E1-21.2  14.4 97
    E1-21.26  38.7 32
  • Example 2.4. Forced Swim Test (FST)
  • The forced swim test (FST) also known at the behavioural despair test was used to evaluate antidepressant activity (Porsolt et al., 1977 Arch. Int. Pharmacodyn. 229: 327-336, Porsolt et al., 1977, Eur. J. Pharmacol. 47:379-391). Mice or rats that are forced to swim in a situation from which they cannot escape, rapidly become immobile. Drugs with antidepressant activity, such as imipramine, reduce the amount of time spent in the immobile state. Therefore, the amount of immobility time during a test conducted after drug administration represents a useful indicator of antidepressant activity (Lucki et al 2001 Psychopharmacology 155:315-322; Porsolt et al., 1977, Nature 266:730-732).
  • Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base). Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • Testing for antidepressant activity was conducted in rats or mice according to the general procedures below.
  • Mice were evaluated in a single swimming test session of 6 minutes. Mice were placed in a transparent plastic cylinder 24 cm high with a diameter of 13 cm containing 10 cm of water with ambient temperature control generally from 22±2° C. Mice were placed in the water for 6 minutes and the duration of immobility during the last 4 minutes was measured.
  • Male Wistar rats weighing 197-251 g were used for the rat test. Rats were evaluated according to a two-session procedure with a swimming session of 15 minutes on the first day of the experiment (Session 1) followed 24 hours later by a 5-minute swimming test (Session 2). Rats were individually forced to swim inside 40 cm×18 cm vertical transparent plexiglass cylinders containing 15 cm of water maintained at 25° C. (Session 1). After 15 min in the water, the rats were removed and allowed to dry for 15 min in a heated enclosure (32° C.) before being returned to their cages. Rats were placed in the water 24 h later for 5 minutes (Session 2) and the duration of immobility was measured.
  • Animals were observed by a blinded observer. The observer judged the animal to be immobile when it ceased all activity (struggling, swimming, jumping etc.) and floated passively atop the water. The amount of time each animal spent in the immobile state (and the latency to the first bout of immobility) was recorded and used for statistical analysis of compound effect. Group differences were evaluated by student's t-test (reference substance) or one-way ANOVA followed by post-hoc Dunnett's test (test substances).
  • In a given experiment (for both mouse and rat experiments) a test compound, vehicle control solution and positive control reference compound imipramine were administered. Test compounds were administered in one or more doses by either oral gavage (p.o.) or by intraperitoneal injection (i.p.) dosing routes after dissolving in 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle. Test compound doses ranged from 1 to 30 milligrams per kilogram (expressed in the accompanying Figures either as mpk or mg/kg).
  • Imipramine control compound was dissolved in physiological saline solution. Imipramine was dosed as indicated in the particular Examples.
  • Test compound dose solutions and vehicle control solutions were administered 20 minutes before placing the animals in the water cylinder for both oral and intraperitoneal experiments. Imipramine was dosed as indicated in the particular Examples below.
  • Male mice (strain NLMN) weighing 25-35 g were used for testing. All animals were housed in a temperature (22-24° C.) and humidity (50-60%) controlled environment with free access to food and water on a 12-hour light-dark cycle. Test compounds were dissolved in 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water to generate the appropriate dosing solution. Drugs were administered by intraperitoneal injection at a dose volume of 10 mL/kg. Testing was initiated 20-60 minutes after dosing. Testing for antidepressant activity was conducted as described by Darci et al. (Darci et al., 2004, Eur. J. Pharmacol. 499:135-146). Mice were placed in a white plastic cylinder 20 cm high with a diameter of 21 cm containing 10 cm of water at 25±2° C. The mice were videotaped for 6 minutes, and the last 4 minutes of video were analyzed by a blinded observer off-line. The observer judged the animal to be immobile when it ceased all activity (struggling, swimming, jumping etc.) and floated passively atop the water. The amount of time each animal spent in the immobile state was recorded and used for statistical analysis of compound effect. Group differences were evaluated by student's t-test or one-way ANOVA followed by post-hoc Dunnett's test.
  • Example 2.4.1. Compound E1-1.2 in Mice
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1A. Bars represent the mean±SEM immobility time for each dose group (n=10, ***: different from vehicle group, p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). Doses are given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of imipramine was 32 mpk.
  • Example 2.4.2. Compound E1-8.2 Administered by Intraperitoneal Injection in Mice
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1B. Bars represent the mean±SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). In the present Example the positive control compound, imipramine (32 mpk i.p.) administered once 30 min before the test, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Example 2.4.3. Compound E1-21.26 Administered by Intraperitoneal Injection in Mice
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1C. Bars represent the mean±SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). In the present Example the positive control compound, imipramine (32 mpk i.p.) administered once 30 min before the test, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Example 2.4.4. Compound E1-1.2 Administered Orally in Mice
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1D. Bars represent the mean±SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). In the present Example the positive control compound, imipramine (64 mpk p.o.) administered once 60 min before the test, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Example 2.4.5. Compound E1-1.2 Administered by Intraperitoneal Injection in Rats
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1E. Bars represent the mean±SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).). In the present Example the positive control compound, imipramine (32 mpk i.p.) administered 3 times: at 24 h, 4 h and 30 min before the test (Session 2), showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Example 2.4.6. Compound E1-21.26 Administered Orally in Rats
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1F. Bars represent the mean±SEM immobility time for each dose group (***: different from vehicle group, p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). In the present Example the positive control compound, imipramine (64 mpk p.o.) administered 3 times: at 24 h, 4 h and 60 min before the test (Session 2), showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • Example 2.4.7. Chronic Dosing of Mice in Forced Swim Test
  • Mice were individually placed in a cylinder (height=24 cm; diameter=13 cm) containing 10 cm water (22° C.) from which they cannot escape. The mice were placed in the water for 6 minutes and the duration of immobility during the last 4 minutes was measured. The latency to the first bout of immobility was also recorded starting from the beginning of the test.
  • The compound was evaluated at 2 doses (3 and 10 mg/kg), administered either acutely p.o. 20 minutes before the test on Day 7 or daily during 7 days with the last administration 20 minutes before the test on Day 7, and compared with a vehicle control group. Vehicle was administered daily when a drug was not due. Imipramine (128 mg/kg p.o.), administered once 60 minutes before the test on Day 7, was used as reference substance.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 1G. Bars represent the mean±SEM immobility time for each dose group (**/***: different from vehicle group, p<0.01/p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). In the present Example the positive control compound, imipramine (128 mpk p.o.) administered once 60 minutes before the test on Day 7, showed the expected antidepressant activity.
  • These results indicate that provided compounds exhibit antidepressant activity when tested in standard models for human depression. These data demonstrate that the test compounds exhibit antidepressant activity when dosed chronically. Furthermore these results indicate that provided compounds exhibit antidepressant activity when dosed acutely and chronically.
  • Example 2.5. Electroconvulsive Threshold Test (ECT)
  • The Electroconvulsive Threshold Test, which detects proconvulsant or anticonvulsant activity, was generally conducted as described by Swinyard et al., (J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 106, 319-330, 1952). Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base). Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • Rats were administered ECS (rectangular current: 0.6 ms pulse width, 1.5 s duration, 200 Hz) via earclip electrodes connected to a constant current shock generator (Ugo Basile: type 7801). Test compounds were administered by oral gavage (p.o.) 1 hour before the test at a dose volume of 5 m L/kg.
  • Treatment groups of 20 rats were exposed to ECS as follows: The first animal was exposed to 30 mA of ECS. If this animal did not convulse (tonic convulsions) within 5 seconds maximum, animal n° 2 is exposed to 35 mA, etc. . . . (increases of 5 mA) until the first tonic convulsion was observed. Once the first tonic convulsion was observed, the intensity of ECS was decreased by 2 mA for the next animal and then decreased or increased by 2 mA from animal to animal depending on whether the previous animal convulsed or not. If the first animal did convulse (tonic convulsions) within 5 seconds, animal n° 2 is exposed to 25 mA, etc. . . . (decreases of 5 mA) until the absence of tonic convulsions was observed. At this point, the intensity of ECS was increased by 2 mA for the next animal and then decreased or increased by 2 mA from animal to animal depending on whether the previous animal convulsed or not. The minimum current intensity applied is 5 mA and the maximum 95 mA. The first 5 animals serve to approach threshold current and were not included in the analysis. The results are presented as the mean current intensity administered to the final 15 animals of a group. The test was performed blind. A positive percent change indicates an anticonvulsant effect. A negative percent change indicates a proconvulsant effect. The test substance was evaluated at 4 doses, typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle, and administered p.o. 60 minutes before ECS, and compared with a vehicle control group. Diazepam (16 mg/kg p.o.), administered under the same experimental conditions, was used as reference substance. The experiment included 6 groups. Data with the test substance was analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using one-way ANOVA followed by Dunnett's t tests.
  • In Example 2.5.1 the anticonvulsant positive control compound diazepam (16 mpk p.o.) showed the expected anticonvulsant activity. The proconvulsant positive control compound theophylline (128 mpk p.o.) showed the expected proconvulsant activity. In Example 2.5.2 only the anticonvulsant positive control was included in the study.
  • Example 2.5.1. Compound E1-1.2
  • The results are shown in FIG. 2. Bars represent the mean±SEM electroconvulsive threshold for each dose group (n=15, ***: different from vehicle group, p<0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). Doses are given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of diazepam was 16 mpk. The dose of theophylline was 128 mpk.
  • Compound E1-1.2 showed robust anticonvulsant activity at doses tested, 3, 10 and 30 mpk.
  • Example 2.5.2. Compound E1-8.2
  • The results are shown in FIG. 3. Bars represent the mean±SEM electroconvulsive threshold for each dose group (n=15, ***/*: different from vehicle group, p<0.001/0.05 respectively, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). Doses are given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of diazepam was 16 mpk.
  • Compound E1-8.2 showed modest proconvulsant activity after administration of 0.5 and 2 mpk, and anticonvulsant activity at 10 and 20 mpk doses.
  • Example 2.5.3. Compound E1-21.26
  • The results are shown in FIG. 4. Bars represent the mean±SEM electroconvulsive threshold for each dose group (n=15, ***/*: different from vehicle group, p<0.001/0.05 respectively, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test).
  • Compound E1-21.26 showed anticonvulsant activity at 3 and 10 mpk doses.
  • Example 2.6. Pentylenetetrazole (PTZ) Seizure Test
  • The method, which detects proconvulsant or anticonvulsant activity related to a GABAergic mechanism, follows that described by Krall (Epilepsia, 19, 409-428, 1978). Rats, placed in individual macrolon cages (25×19×13 cm), were injected with pentylenetetrazole (PTZ) (100 mg/kg s.c.). The occurrence and latency of clonic and tonic convulsions and death were noted over a 30 minute period. 15 rats were studied per group. The test was performed blind.
  • Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base). Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • Compounds were evaluated typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle at 1 or more doses (e.g., 1, 3 and 10 mg/kg), administered p.o. 30 minutes before PTZ, and compared with a vehicle control group. Diazepam (16 mg/kg p.o.), administered 60 minutes before PTZ, was used as reference substance. The experiment was performed over 2 separate sub-experiments with N=7 to 8 animals per group and per sub-experiment. Quantitative data (latencies) with the test substance was analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using Kruskal-Wallis test followed by Mann-Whitney U test. Quantitative data with the reference substance was analyzed using Mann-Whitney U test. Quantal data (frequencies) was analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using Fisher's Exact Probability tests (*=p<0.05; **=p<0.01; ***=p<0.001).
  • Example 2.6.1. Compound E1-1.2
  • The results are shown in FIG. 5A, FIG. 5B, FIG. 5C, FIG. 5D, FIG. 5E, and FIG. 5F.
  • Compound E1-1.2 at a 10 mg/kg p.o. dose decreased the number of rats showing tonic convulsions (−82%, p<0.01) and the number of deaths (−91%, p<0.001) as compared with vehicle controls. Compound E1-1.2 also increased the latencies to induce clonic and tonic convulsions and the latency to death (+72%, p<0.05; +39%, p<0.01 and +35%, p<0.001, respectively). These results confirm the anticonvulsant activity for compound E1-1.2 at 10 mg/kg p.o. in the Pentylenetetrazole Seizure Test in the rat.
  • Example 2.6.2. Compound E1-21.26
  • The results are shown in FIG. 6A, FIG. 6B, FIG. 6C, FIG. 6D, FIG. 6E, and FIG. 6F.
  • Compound E1-21.26 at a 10 mg/kg p.o. dose decreased the number of rats showing tonic convulsions (−82%, p<0.01) and the number of deaths (−82%, p<0.01) as compared with vehicle controls. Compound E1-21.26 also increased the latencies to induce clonic and tonic convulsions and the latency to death (+45%, p<0.05; +40%, p<0.01 and +31%, p<0.01, respectively). These results confirm the anticonvulsant activity for compound E1-21.26 at 10 mg/kg p.o. in the Pentylenetetrazole Seizure Test in the rat.
  • Example 2.7. 6 Hz Seizure Test
  • The 6 Hz seizure test, which detects anticonvulsant activity of test compounds, was conducted according to methods described by Brown et al. (J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 107, 273-283, 1953) and Barton et al. (Epilepsy Res. 47, 217-227, 2001). Mice were administered a rectangular current (44 mA, rectangular pulse: 0.2 ms pulse width, 3 s duration, 6 Hz) via corneal electrodes connected to a constant current shock generator (Ugo Basile: type 7801). The results for the number of seizures as reflected by forelimb clonus were recorded during the first minute following current administration. Forelimb clonus was scored as absent (0), mild (1) and strong (2). 15 mice were studied per group. The test was performed partially blind (test substance vs vehicle). Test substances were administered typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle p.o. 30 minutes before the test and compared with a vehicle control group. Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base). Test compound E1-8.2 was administered as the free base.
  • Diazepam, administered 60 minutes before the test, was used as a positive control reference substance. Quantitative data (scores) with the test substance was analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using Kruskall-Wallis test followed by Mann-Whitney U tests.
  • Example 2.7.1. Compound E1-1.2
  • Results are shown in FIG. 7A. Bars represent the mean±SEM forelimb clonus score (arbitrary units) for each dose group (*/**/***: different from vehicle group, p<0.05/0.01/0.001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). Doses are given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of diazepam was 8 mpk (p.o.). Compound E1-1.2 showed a dose-response reduction in forelimb clonus. (10 and 30 mg/kg), administered p.o. 30 minutes before the test, significantly and dose-dependently decreased the forelimb seizure score, as compared with vehicle control (−50%, p<0.05 and −70%, p<0.01, respectively). It also dose-dependently decreased the number of mice with Straub tail with a significant effect observed at 30 mg/kg (10 mg/kg: −13%, NS and 30 mg/kg: −40%, p<0.05) (FIG. 7B).
  • Example 2.8. Haloperidol-Induced Catalepsy (HIC) Model
  • The Haloperidol-induced Catalepsy (HIC) model detects antipsychotic activity and the action of NR2B selective antagonists (Steece-Collier et al. Exp. Neurol. 163: 239, 2000) and was based on methods described by Chermat and Simon (J. Pharmacol., 6, 493-496, 1975). The capacity to induce catalepsy serves as an index of the liability of a test substance to induce extrapyramidal side-effects, in particular Parkinsonism. Antagonism of antipsychotic-induced catalepsy can thus serve to detect anti-Parkinson potential.
  • Rats were injected with haloperidol (1 mg/kg i.p.) and were examined for catalepsy at 30 minute intervals up to 360 minutes. Presence (+) or absence (−) of catalepsy was assessed by three procedures: 1) imposed crossing of the ipsilateral fore- and hind-limbs; 2) placing the animal in the Buddha position; 3) the tilting board, an automatic device that, 5 seconds after positioning the rat, displaces the rat from a horizontal to vertical position and back while it clings to a wire grid with its front paws. Akinesia and catalepsy were assessed depending on whether or not the animal moves before (akinesia) or during operation of the board (catalepsy).
  • The 4 scores were cumulated over time to give a global catalepsy score per animal. Six rats were studied per group. The test was performed blind (test substances versus vehicle). Test substances were evaluated at 1 or more doses, administered typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle p.o. 15 minutes before haloperidol (i.e. 45 minutes before the first measurement), and compared with a vehicle control group. Test compounds E1-1.2 and E1-21.26 were administered as mesylate salts (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base).
  • Amphetamine (8 mg/kg p.o.), administered 60 minutes before the test (i.e. 90 minutes before the first measurement), was used as reference substance. Data with the test substances were analyzed by comparing treated groups with vehicle control using Kruskal-Wallis Test followed by Mann-Whitney U tests at each time and for cumulated score. Data with the reference substance were analyzed using Mann-Whitney U tests.
  • Example 2.8.1. Compound E1-1.2
  • The results are shown in FIG. 8A. Doses were given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of amphetamine was 8 mpk (FIG. 8B).
  • The positive control compound amphetamine (8 mg/kg p.o.) showed the expected robust anticataleptic activity (FIG. 8B). Compound E1-1.2 significantly decreased the cumulated score of catalepsy over 360 mins, as compared with vehicle controls (2.0, p<0.01). At 1 and 3 mg/kg, Compound E1-1.2 tended to decrease the cumulated score of catalepsy over 360 mins (17.0, p=0.0898 and 15.8, p=0.0526, respectively) with significant effects at 2.5 hours at 1 mg/kg (p<0.05) and at 2.5 and 3.5 hours at 3 mg/kg (p<0.05 and p<0.01, respectively). Catalepsy was observed between 4 and 6 hours at 10 mg/kg. These results suggest the presence of significant anti-cataleptic activity for compound E1-1.2 in the Haloperidol-induced Catalepsy test in the rat.
  • Example 2.8.2. Compound E1-21.26
  • The results are shown in FIG. 8C. Doses were given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The positive control compound amphetamine (8 mg/kg p.o.) showed the expected robust anticataleptic activity (FIG. 8B). Compound E1-21.26 at 3 mg/kg and 10 mg/kg significantly and dose-dependently decreased the cumulated score of catalepsy over 360 mins, as compared with vehicle controls (11.7 and 1.0, respectively, p<0.01). Catalepsy was observed between 1.5 and 6 hours at 3 mg/kg. Catalepsy was also observed between 5 and 6 hours at 10 mg/kg. These results suggest the presence of significant anti-cataleptic activity for compound E1-21.26 in the Haloperidol-induced Catalepsy test in the rat.
  • Example 2.9. Rat Formalin Model
  • The rat formalin model is a tonic model of continuous pain resulting from formalin-induced spontaneous nociceptive behaviors. Intra-paw injection of formalin is a commonly used model to measure spontaneous nociceptive behaviors in rodents (Dubuisson, D. and Dennis, S. G. Pain 4:161, 1977). Subcutaneous plantar injection of formalin causes a bi-phasic nocifensive behavioral response in rodents. The early phase (phase-1) lasts for about 5-10 min following which an interphase occurs without any discernible nociceptive reactions after which the late phase (phase-II) nociceptive reaction ensues continuing from about 20-60 min following formalin injection. Formalin model is a model of tonic, persistent pain, and is widely used for rapid screening of novel analgesic compounds. The model encompasses inflammatory, neurogenic and central mechanisms of nociception, and the late phase in particular is considered as a pharmacodynamic surrogate of central sensitization. In the present example, effects of test item were assessed in 0-5 minutes from the early phase (phase-1) and 20-35 minutes from the late phase (phase-II) of formalin-induced nociceptive behavior. 20 mins before injection of formalin, the animals were administered with vehicle, test compound (10, 30, 60 mpk i.p.) typically using 0.5% dimethylsulfoxide, 4% hydroxypropyl-b-cyclodextrin water as a vehicle and positive control Duloxetine (30 mpk).
  • For all groups, animals were acclimated to the observation chamber for 15 minutes immediately prior to formalin injection. All animals received an intraplantar subcutaneous injection of 50 μL of 5% formalin into the left hind paw and then placed immediately into an observation chamber and formalin-evoked spontaneous nociceptive behaviors in the rats were continuously recorded for 0-60 min using a commercial camcorder.
  • Scoring from the recorded video files was performed off-line using a PC by an observer who was validated to score such nociceptive behavior in rodents. The total time spent in a 5 min bin was recorded using a stop-watch for the following nociceptive behavior: flinching, shaking, biting and licking of the injected paw.
  • Test compound E1-1.2 was administered as a mesylate salt (mpk based on molecular weight of the free base).
  • Effects of the test compound was assessed in the following bins: 0-5 minutes from early phase (phase-1) and 20-35 minutes from late phase (phase-II).
  • The results are shown in FIGS. 9A and 9B. Bars represent the mean±SEM for each dose group (n=8, ****: different from vehicle group, p<0.0001, One-way ANOVA, Dunnett's post-test). Doses are given as milligram per kilogram (mpk).
  • At each of the doses (10, 30 and 60 mpk i.p.), Compound E1-1.2 decreased the cumulative time spent on nociceptive behavior in phase I (0-5 mins) (FIG. 9A) and phase II (20-35 mins) (FIG. 9B).
  • Example 2.10. Cortical Spreading Depression (CSD), Aura Phase of Migraine Model
  • The cortical spreading depression model is utilized to investigate whether treatment with compounds of the present invention affect electrophysiological and hemodynamic events in a rat model of migraine.
  • Rats were anesthetized with 5% isoflurane (in 70% N2O and 30% O2; flow 300 ml/min) and placed in a stereotactic frame. During the operation and CSD the concentration of anesthetic was reduced to 1-1.5%. The rectal temperature was maintained at 37.0±1.0° C. with a homeothermic blanket system. The skin was opened by a medial incision and retracted laterally. Three burr holes were drilled under saline cooling over the right hemisphere at the following coordinates (mm from bregma): (1) posterior 4.5, lateral, 2.0 (occipital cortex): KCl application site; (2) posterior 0.5, lateral 2.0 (parietal cortex): LDF recording site; (3) anterior 2, lateral 2 (frontal cortex): DC potential recording site. A laser-Doppler flow probe (Oxyflow, Oxford Optronics, UK) to monitor CBF and an invasive Ag/AgCl electrode for measuring direct current (DC) potential shifts were placed in the parietal and frontal cortex burr holes on the intact dura and in the cortex, respectively. The laser-Doppler flow probe was positioned in an area free of large pial and dural vessels to minimize a large-vessel contribution to the signal. For the DC-potential measurement, a reference electrode was fixed in the neck. Dura overlying the occipital cortex was gently removed and care was taken to avoid bleeding. After surgical preparation, the cortex was allowed to recover for 15 minutes under saline irrigation. A cotton ball (2 mm diameter) soaked with 1M KCl was placed on the pial surface and kept moist by placing 5 μl of KCl solution every 15 minutes. Test compound or vehicle was administered ten (10) minutes prior to CSD initiation. Positive control MK-801 was administrated 30 min prior to CSD initiation. The number of KCl-induced CSDs was counted for 2 hours. The CBF and DC-potentials were monitored continuously starting from 5 minutes before KCl exposure.
  • Test compound E1-1.2 was administered as a mesylate salt (mpk based on molecular weight of the mesylate salt).
  • The data was collected in Windaq acquisition software (Dataq Instruments, USA) at 20 kHz. The raw data was analyzed in Clampfit program (Axon Instruments, USA). The signals were low pass filtered (cut off range 5-10000 Hz) that CSD episodes in DC and CBF could be confirmed. The following parameters were analyzed: i) the number, duration and amplitude of DC-potentials, and ii) the number and amplitude of CBF events.
  • The results for number of DC potentials is shown in FIG. 10. Doses were given as milligram per kilogram (mpk). The dose of MK-801, the positive control, was 1.25 mg/kg. Bars represent mean±Standard Error of Mean (SEM), and differences were considered to be statistically significant at the P<0.05 level (n=8, * different from vehicle group). Statistical analysis was performed using StatsDirect statistical software. Differences between groups were analyzed by using 1-way ANOVA and Dunnett's post hoc test.
  • Amplitude of DC potentials for compound E1-1.2 at various doses and MK-801 was not statistically different compared to vehicle (not shown). Duration of DC potentials for compound E1-1.2 at various doses was not statistically different compared to vehicle (not shown). Duration of DC potentials for MK-801 was increased compared to vehicle (p<0.05, not shown).
  • The magnitude of CBF was unchanged for compound E1-1.2 compared to vehicle. The number of CBF events was decreased for compound E1-1.2 at 10 mg/kg and for MK-801 at 1.25 mg/kg with a statistically significant difference from vehicle (* p<0.05 vs vehicle group) (not shown).
  • Compound E1-1.2 (at 3 mpk, 10 mpk and 30 mpk) significantly decreased the number of DC potentials when compared to the vehicle group (* p<0.05 for all doses vs vehicle group, data presented as mean±SEM). The present data demonstrate that compound E1-1.2 was effective in a model of migraine.

Claims (25)

What is claimed is:
1. A chemical entity, which is a compound of formula I:
Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00094
wherein:
R1 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, (cycloalkyl)alkyl, heterocyclyl, (heterocyclyl)alkyl, aryl, (aryl)alkyl, heteroaryl or (heteroaryl)alkyl,
wherein each of cycloalkyl, (cycloalkyl)alkyl, heterocyclyl, (heterocyclyl)alkyl, aryl, (aryl)alkyl, heteroaryl and (heteroaryl)alkyl is independently optionally substituted with 1 to 3 groups independently selected from —F, —Cl, C1-C4 alkyl, cyclopropyl, —C≡CH, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, C1-C4 alkoxy, —OCFH2, —OCF2H, —OCF3, —CN, —N(R2)(R3), —NO2, C1-C4 alkylthio, C1-C4alkylsulfonyl and —S(O)2CF3;
wherein each instance of R2 and R3 independently is —H or C1-C4 alkyl, or —N(R2)(R3) is
Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00095
Z is 5- or 6-membered monocyclic or 9- or 10-membered bicyclic heteroaryl having ring carbon atoms, 1 nitrogen ring atom and 0-3 additional ring heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S, which is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups and optionally substituted with 1 Ra group, wherein each Rx is attached to a ring carbon atom and Ra is attached to a ring nitrogen atom;
wherein:
each instance of Rx independently is —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —OH, —OCH3, —OCF3 or —CN; and
Ra is C1-4 alkyl, C3-4 cycloalkyl or —S(O)2—C1-4 alkyl.
2. The chemical entity of claim 1, wherein Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
3. The chemical entity of claim 1, wherein Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 3 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
4. The chemical entity of claim 1, wherein Z is a 9-membered optionally substituted bicyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 4 ring nitrogen heteroatoms.
5. The chemical entity of claim 1, wherein Z is a 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms, 1 ring nitrogen atom and 0 or 1 additional ring nitrogen atoms.
6. The chemical entity of claim 5, wherein Z is a 6-membered optionally substituted monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms.
7. The chemical entity of claim 6, wherein Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is optionally substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups.
8. The chemical entity of claim 7, wherein Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is substituted with 1 or 2 Rx groups.
9. The chemical entity of claim 8, wherein Z is a 6-membered monocyclic heteraromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 2 ring nitrogen atoms, wherein Z is substituted with 1 Rx group.
10. The chemical entity of any one of claims 7-9, wherein Rx is selected from —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, or —CF3.
11. The chemical entity of claims 1-10, wherein R1 is optionally substituted (aryl)alkyl.
12. The chemical entity of claim 11, wherein R1 is optionally substituted benzyl.
13. The chemical entity of claim 12 of formula (II):
Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00096
wherein R5, R6 and R7 independently are —H, —F, —Cl, C1-C4 alkyl, cyclopropyl, —C≡CH, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, C1-C4 alkoxy, —OCFH2, —OCF2H, —OCF3, —CN, —N(R2)(R3), —NO2, C1-C4 alkylthio, C1-C4alkylsulfonyl or —S(O)2CF3;
wherein each instance of R2 and R3 independently is —H or C1-C4 alkyl, or —N(R2)(R3) is
Figure US20220024937A1-20220127-C00097
14. The chemical entity of claim 13, wherein each of R5, R6 and R7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, isopropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —SCH2CH3, —S(O)2CH3, —S(O)2CH2CH3, —S(O)2CF3 or —C≡CH.
15. The chemical entity of claim 14, wherein each of R5, R6 and R7 independently is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —S(O)2CH3 or —C≡CH.
16. The chemical entity of claim 15, wherein:
R5 is —H, —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CFH2, —CF2H, —CF3, —CH2CH3, —CF2CH3, —CH2CF3, cyclopropyl, —OCF3, —OCF2H, —SCH3, —S(O)2CH3 or —C≡CH;
R6 is —H or —F; and
R7is —H, —F, —Cl or —CH3.
17. The chemical entity of any of claims 13-16, wherein Z is Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, Z5, Z6, Z7, Z8, Z9, Z10, Z11, Z12, Z13, Z14, Z15, Z16, Z17, Z18, Z19, or Z20.
18. The chemical entity of claim 17, wherein Z is Z1, Z2, Z5, Z6, Z8, Z17 or Z19.
19. The chemical entity of any of claims 13-16, wherein Z is Z21, Z22, Z23, Z24, Z25, Z26, Z27, Z28, Z29, Z30, Z31, Z32, Z33, Z34, Z35 or Z36.
20. The chemical entity of claim 19, wherein Z is Z21, Z22, Z24, Z29, Z30, Z35 or Z36.
21. A pharmaceutical composition comprising the chemical entity of any one of claims 1-20 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
22. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 21, which is suitable for oral administration.
23. A method of treating a disease or disorder responsive to NR2B antagonism in a subject in need of such treatment, comprising administering an effective amount of the chemical entity of any one of claims 1-20.
24. The method of claim 23, wherein the disease or disorder is depression, pain, Parkinson's disease, Huntington's disease, Alzheimer's disease, cerebral ischaemia, traumatic brain injury, epilepsy or migraine.
25. The method of claim 24, wherein the disease or disorder is depression.
US17/491,676 2015-06-01 2021-10-01 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists Pending US20220024937A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US17/491,676 US20220024937A1 (en) 2015-06-01 2021-10-01 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists

Applications Claiming Priority (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201562169107P 2015-06-01 2015-06-01
PCT/US2016/035098 WO2016196513A1 (en) 2015-06-01 2016-05-31 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
US201715578460A 2017-11-30 2017-11-30
US16/810,258 US11136328B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2020-03-05 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
US17/491,676 US20220024937A1 (en) 2015-06-01 2021-10-01 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/810,258 Continuation US11136328B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2020-03-05 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20220024937A1 true US20220024937A1 (en) 2022-01-27

Family

ID=57441824

Family Applications (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/578,460 Active US10584127B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2016-05-31 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
US16/100,596 Active US10294230B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2018-08-10 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
US16/810,258 Active US11136328B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2020-03-05 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
US17/491,676 Pending US20220024937A1 (en) 2015-06-01 2021-10-01 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists

Family Applications Before (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/578,460 Active US10584127B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2016-05-31 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
US16/100,596 Active US10294230B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2018-08-10 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
US16/810,258 Active US11136328B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2020-03-05 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists

Country Status (18)

Country Link
US (4) US10584127B2 (en)
EP (1) EP3303323B1 (en)
JP (1) JP6876625B2 (en)
KR (1) KR102613179B1 (en)
CN (1) CN107849010B (en)
AR (1) AR104837A1 (en)
AU (1) AU2016270677B2 (en)
BR (1) BR112017025023B1 (en)
CA (1) CA2987606C (en)
DK (1) DK3303323T3 (en)
ES (1) ES2784398T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1253023A1 (en)
IL (1) IL255937B (en)
MX (1) MX2017015370A (en)
RU (1) RU2735277C2 (en)
TW (1) TWI721987B (en)
WO (1) WO2016196513A1 (en)
ZA (1) ZA201708006B (en)

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11752155B2 (en) 2016-11-22 2023-09-12 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited Treatment of autism spectrum disorders, obsessive-compulsive disorder and anxiety disorders

Families Citing this family (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
RU2017107558A (en) 2014-09-15 2018-10-18 Руджен Холдингс (Кайман) Лимитед Pyrrolopyrimidine Derivatives as Antagonists of the NMR NR2B Receptor
WO2016126869A1 (en) 2015-02-04 2016-08-11 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited 3,3-difluoro-piperidine derivatives as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
KR102613179B1 (en) 2015-06-01 2023-12-14 뤼겐 홀딩스 (케이맨) 리미티드 3,3-Difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
CN106986874B (en) * 2016-01-20 2019-09-24 西华大学 (1H-pyrazolo [3,4-d ] pyrimidine) -4-amino derivatives and their use as IDO inhibitors in the manufacture of medicaments
AU2021255701A1 (en) 2020-04-17 2022-12-08 Honeybrains, Llc Compositions and methods for treating neuropsychiatric disorders

Family Cites Families (38)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE3717867A1 (en) 1987-05-26 1988-12-15 Schiepe Stapelautomaten Gmbh STACKING DEVICE
RO120134B1 (en) 1995-08-11 2005-09-30 Pfizer Inc. (1s, 2s)-1-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-2-(4-hydroxy-4-phenylpiperidin-1-yl)-1-propanol methane sulphonate trihydrate and pharmaceutical composition
GB9805977D0 (en) * 1998-03-19 1998-05-20 Silver Joshua D Improvements in variable focus optical devices
US6476041B1 (en) 1999-10-29 2002-11-05 Merck & Co., Inc. 1,4 substituted piperidinyl NMDA/NR2B antagonists
HU227197B1 (en) 2000-10-24 2010-10-28 Richter Gedeon Nyrt Nmda receptor antagonist carboxylic acid amide derivatives and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
US7217716B2 (en) 2001-02-23 2007-05-15 Merck & Co., Inc. N-substituted nonaryl-heterocyclic NMDA/NR2B antagonists
WO2004108705A1 (en) * 2003-06-04 2004-12-16 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-fluoro-piperidines as nmda/nr2b antagonists
US7592360B2 (en) 2003-06-04 2009-09-22 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-fluoro-piperidines as NMDA/NR2B antagonists
WO2005102390A2 (en) 2004-04-22 2005-11-03 Pfizer Japan, Inc. Combinations comprising alpha-2-delta ligands and nmda receptor antagonists
AU2005271669A1 (en) 2004-08-03 2006-02-16 Merck & Co., Inc. 1,3-disubstituted heteroaryl NMDA/NR2B antagonists
AU2005319071A1 (en) * 2004-12-22 2006-06-29 Merck & Co., Inc. Process for making substituted piperidines
EP1874318A2 (en) 2005-04-19 2008-01-09 Merck & Co., Inc. N-alkyl-azacycloalkyl nmda/nr2b antagonists
WO2007061868A2 (en) 2005-11-17 2007-05-31 Trustees Of Tufts College Treatment of stereotypic, self-injurious and compulsive behaviors using specific serotonin reuptake inhibitors and antagonists of nmda receptors
WO2007099828A1 (en) 2006-02-23 2007-09-07 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Nirogenous heterocyclic derivatives substituted with cyclic groups
JP2010502704A (en) * 2006-09-07 2010-01-28 メルク エンド カムパニー インコーポレーテッド Piperidine difluoride for treating Alzheimer's disease and related conditions
KR20090094338A (en) 2006-12-27 2009-09-04 사노피-아벤티스 Substituted isoquinoline and isoquinolinone derivatives
CA2719749A1 (en) 2008-03-27 2009-10-01 Evotec Neurosciences Gmbh Methods for treating disorders using nmda nr2b-subtype selective antagonist
US20100010565A1 (en) * 2008-07-09 2010-01-14 Samuel Victor Lichtenstein Extended range wireless muscular and neural stimulation
WO2010015637A1 (en) 2008-08-06 2010-02-11 Novartis Ag New antiviral modified nucleosides
US20130096115A1 (en) 2009-12-28 2013-04-18 Afraxis, Inc. Methods for treating autism
JP5911470B2 (en) * 2010-04-16 2016-04-27 エーシー・イミューン・エス・アー Novel compounds for treating diseases associated with amyloid or amyloid-like proteins
WO2011156640A2 (en) 2010-06-09 2011-12-15 Afraxis, Inc. 8-(HETEROARYLMETHYL)PYRIDO[2,3-d]PYRIMIDIN-7(8H)-ONES FOR THE TREATMENT OF CNS DISORDERS
US20130225575A1 (en) 2010-06-16 2013-08-29 Afraxis, Inc. Methods for treating neurological conditions
US9737531B2 (en) 2012-07-12 2017-08-22 Glytech, Llc Composition and method for treatment of depression and psychosis in humans
EP2683716A1 (en) * 2011-03-11 2014-01-15 Glaxo Group Limited Pyrido[3,4-b]pyrazine derivatives as syk inhibitors
US9278910B2 (en) * 2011-05-31 2016-03-08 Receptos, Inc. GLP-1 receptor stabilizers and modulators
JP6042968B2 (en) * 2012-04-20 2016-12-14 ユセベ ファルマ ソシエテ アノニム How to treat Parkinson's disease
SG11201504516PA (en) * 2012-12-11 2015-07-30 Takeda Pharmaceutical Heterocyclic compound
EP2951185B1 (en) 2013-01-29 2016-12-21 Aptinyx Inc. Spiro-lactam nmda receptor modulators and uses thereof
AU2014347026A1 (en) * 2013-11-06 2016-06-23 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Substituted pyridine derivatives useful as GSK-3 inhibitors
RU2721948C2 (en) 2014-05-06 2020-05-25 Нортвестерн Юниверсити Combinations of compounds modulating the nmda receptor
EP3152213B1 (en) 2014-06-04 2018-10-31 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited Difluoroethylpyridine derivatives as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
RU2017107558A (en) 2014-09-15 2018-10-18 Руджен Холдингс (Кайман) Лимитед Pyrrolopyrimidine Derivatives as Antagonists of the NMR NR2B Receptor
EP3197440A4 (en) 2014-09-22 2018-04-18 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited Treatment of anxiety disorders and autism spectrum disorders
WO2016100349A2 (en) 2014-12-16 2016-06-23 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited Bicyclic azaheterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
WO2016126869A1 (en) 2015-02-04 2016-08-11 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited 3,3-difluoro-piperidine derivatives as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
KR102613179B1 (en) 2015-06-01 2023-12-14 뤼겐 홀딩스 (케이맨) 리미티드 3,3-Difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
WO2018098128A1 (en) 2016-11-22 2018-05-31 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited Treatment of autism spectrum disorders, obsessive-compulsive disorder and anxiety disorders

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11752155B2 (en) 2016-11-22 2023-09-12 Rugen Holdings (Cayman) Limited Treatment of autism spectrum disorders, obsessive-compulsive disorder and anxiety disorders

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
TWI721987B (en) 2021-03-21
TW201710248A (en) 2017-03-16
CN107849010B (en) 2021-11-09
AU2016270677A1 (en) 2017-12-14
EP3303323A4 (en) 2019-01-02
US20180170935A1 (en) 2018-06-21
RU2735277C2 (en) 2020-10-29
IL255937A (en) 2018-01-31
US20200299300A1 (en) 2020-09-24
ES2784398T3 (en) 2020-09-24
EP3303323A1 (en) 2018-04-11
HK1253023A1 (en) 2019-06-06
DK3303323T3 (en) 2020-03-23
NZ737780A (en) 2024-04-26
US20180346476A1 (en) 2018-12-06
ZA201708006B (en) 2021-07-28
CN107849010A (en) 2018-03-27
US11136328B2 (en) 2021-10-05
KR20180032533A (en) 2018-03-30
WO2016196513A1 (en) 2016-12-08
US10294230B2 (en) 2019-05-21
BR112017025023B1 (en) 2024-01-30
IL255937B (en) 2021-06-30
JP2018522831A (en) 2018-08-16
KR102613179B1 (en) 2023-12-14
RU2017142005A (en) 2019-07-09
EP3303323B1 (en) 2020-01-08
CA2987606A1 (en) 2016-12-08
US10584127B2 (en) 2020-03-10
RU2017142005A3 (en) 2019-11-19
MX2017015370A (en) 2018-03-15
AU2016270677B2 (en) 2020-11-12
CA2987606C (en) 2024-02-20
AR104837A1 (en) 2017-08-16
BR112017025023A2 (en) 2018-08-07
JP6876625B2 (en) 2021-05-26

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US11136328B2 (en) 3,3-difluoropiperidine carbamate heterocyclic compounds as NR2B NMDA receptor antagonists
JP2023545507A (en) Tricyclic heterobifunctional compounds that degrade targeted proteins
CA3045745A1 (en) [1,2,4]-triazolo [1,5-a]-pyrimidinyl derivatives substituted with piperidine, morpholine or piperazin as oga inhibitors
CA2957898C (en) Pyrrolopyrimidine derivatives as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
JP2011503120A (en) Indole compounds and methods for treating visceral pain
JP5808020B2 (en) 2-Oxo-1-pyrrolidinylimidazothiadiazole derivatives
WO2015187845A1 (en) Difluoroethylpyridine derivatives as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
WO2016100349A2 (en) Bicyclic azaheterocyclic compounds as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
WO2018098128A1 (en) Treatment of autism spectrum disorders, obsessive-compulsive disorder and anxiety disorders
EP3253761A1 (en) 3,3-difluoro-piperidine derivatives as nr2b nmda receptor antagonists
US8669255B2 (en) Substituted octahydropyrrolo[1,2-a]pyrazines as calcium channel blockers
EP1736474A1 (en) Piperidine derivative
TW202204343A (en) Substituted 3-phenoxyazetidin-1-yl-pyrazines
JP2023519603A (en) Compounds active against nuclear receptors
BR112017004868B1 (en) PYRROLOPYRIMIDINE DERIVATIVES AS NMDA NR2B RECEPTOR ANTAGONISTS AND PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION COMPRISING THEM

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION